Remove _bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line addr_size parameter
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elfxx-mips.c
1 /* MIPS-specific support for ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1993-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3
4 Most of the information added by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support,
5 <ian@cygnus.com>.
6 N32/64 ABI support added by Mark Mitchell, CodeSourcery, LLC.
7 <mark@codesourcery.com>
8 Traditional MIPS targets support added by Koundinya.K, Dansk Data
9 Elektronik & Operations Research Group. <kk@ddeorg.soft.net>
10
11 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
12
13 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
14 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
15 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
16 (at your option) any later version.
17
18 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
19 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
20 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
21 GNU General Public License for more details.
22
23 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
24 along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
25 Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor, Boston,
26 MA 02110-1301, USA. */
27
28
29 /* This file handles functionality common to the different MIPS ABI's. */
30
31 #include "sysdep.h"
32 #include "bfd.h"
33 #include "libbfd.h"
34 #include "libiberty.h"
35 #include "elf-bfd.h"
36 #include "elfxx-mips.h"
37 #include "elf/mips.h"
38 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
39 #include "dwarf2.h"
40
41 /* Get the ECOFF swapping routines. */
42 #include "coff/sym.h"
43 #include "coff/symconst.h"
44 #include "coff/ecoff.h"
45 #include "coff/mips.h"
46
47 #include "hashtab.h"
48
49 /* Types of TLS GOT entry. */
50 enum mips_got_tls_type {
51 GOT_TLS_NONE,
52 GOT_TLS_GD,
53 GOT_TLS_LDM,
54 GOT_TLS_IE
55 };
56
57 /* This structure is used to hold information about one GOT entry.
58 There are four types of entry:
59
60 (1) an absolute address
61 requires: abfd == NULL
62 fields: d.address
63
64 (2) a SYMBOL + OFFSET address, where SYMBOL is local to an input bfd
65 requires: abfd != NULL, symndx >= 0, tls_type != GOT_TLS_LDM
66 fields: abfd, symndx, d.addend, tls_type
67
68 (3) a SYMBOL address, where SYMBOL is not local to an input bfd
69 requires: abfd != NULL, symndx == -1
70 fields: d.h, tls_type
71
72 (4) a TLS LDM slot
73 requires: abfd != NULL, symndx == 0, tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM
74 fields: none; there's only one of these per GOT. */
75 struct mips_got_entry
76 {
77 /* One input bfd that needs the GOT entry. */
78 bfd *abfd;
79 /* The index of the symbol, as stored in the relocation r_info, if
80 we have a local symbol; -1 otherwise. */
81 long symndx;
82 union
83 {
84 /* If abfd == NULL, an address that must be stored in the got. */
85 bfd_vma address;
86 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx != -1, the addend of the relocation
87 that should be added to the symbol value. */
88 bfd_vma addend;
89 /* If abfd != NULL && symndx == -1, the hash table entry
90 corresponding to a symbol in the GOT. The symbol's entry
91 is in the local area if h->global_got_area is GGA_NONE,
92 otherwise it is in the global area. */
93 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
94 } d;
95
96 /* The TLS type of this GOT entry. An LDM GOT entry will be a local
97 symbol entry with r_symndx == 0. */
98 unsigned char tls_type;
99
100 /* True if we have filled in the GOT contents for a TLS entry,
101 and created the associated relocations. */
102 unsigned char tls_initialized;
103
104 /* The offset from the beginning of the .got section to the entry
105 corresponding to this symbol+addend. If it's a global symbol
106 whose offset is yet to be decided, it's going to be -1. */
107 long gotidx;
108 };
109
110 /* This structure represents a GOT page reference from an input bfd.
111 Each instance represents a symbol + ADDEND, where the representation
112 of the symbol depends on whether it is local to the input bfd.
113 If it is, then SYMNDX >= 0, and the symbol has index SYMNDX in U.ABFD.
114 Otherwise, SYMNDX < 0 and U.H points to the symbol's hash table entry.
115
116 Page references with SYMNDX >= 0 always become page references
117 in the output. Page references with SYMNDX < 0 only become page
118 references if the symbol binds locally; in other cases, the page
119 reference decays to a global GOT reference. */
120 struct mips_got_page_ref
121 {
122 long symndx;
123 union
124 {
125 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
126 bfd *abfd;
127 } u;
128 bfd_vma addend;
129 };
130
131 /* This structure describes a range of addends: [MIN_ADDEND, MAX_ADDEND].
132 The structures form a non-overlapping list that is sorted by increasing
133 MIN_ADDEND. */
134 struct mips_got_page_range
135 {
136 struct mips_got_page_range *next;
137 bfd_signed_vma min_addend;
138 bfd_signed_vma max_addend;
139 };
140
141 /* This structure describes the range of addends that are applied to page
142 relocations against a given section. */
143 struct mips_got_page_entry
144 {
145 /* The section that these entries are based on. */
146 asection *sec;
147 /* The ranges for this page entry. */
148 struct mips_got_page_range *ranges;
149 /* The maximum number of page entries needed for RANGES. */
150 bfd_vma num_pages;
151 };
152
153 /* This structure is used to hold .got information when linking. */
154
155 struct mips_got_info
156 {
157 /* The number of global .got entries. */
158 unsigned int global_gotno;
159 /* The number of global .got entries that are in the GGA_RELOC_ONLY area. */
160 unsigned int reloc_only_gotno;
161 /* The number of .got slots used for TLS. */
162 unsigned int tls_gotno;
163 /* The first unused TLS .got entry. Used only during
164 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
165 unsigned int tls_assigned_gotno;
166 /* The number of local .got entries, eventually including page entries. */
167 unsigned int local_gotno;
168 /* The maximum number of page entries needed. */
169 unsigned int page_gotno;
170 /* The number of relocations needed for the GOT entries. */
171 unsigned int relocs;
172 /* The first unused local .got entry. */
173 unsigned int assigned_low_gotno;
174 /* The last unused local .got entry. */
175 unsigned int assigned_high_gotno;
176 /* A hash table holding members of the got. */
177 struct htab *got_entries;
178 /* A hash table holding mips_got_page_ref structures. */
179 struct htab *got_page_refs;
180 /* A hash table of mips_got_page_entry structures. */
181 struct htab *got_page_entries;
182 /* In multi-got links, a pointer to the next got (err, rather, most
183 of the time, it points to the previous got). */
184 struct mips_got_info *next;
185 };
186
187 /* Structure passed when merging bfds' gots. */
188
189 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg
190 {
191 /* The output bfd. */
192 bfd *obfd;
193 /* The link information. */
194 struct bfd_link_info *info;
195 /* A pointer to the primary got, i.e., the one that's going to get
196 the implicit relocations from DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO and
197 DT_MIPS_GOTSYM. */
198 struct mips_got_info *primary;
199 /* A non-primary got we're trying to merge with other input bfd's
200 gots. */
201 struct mips_got_info *current;
202 /* The maximum number of got entries that can be addressed with a
203 16-bit offset. */
204 unsigned int max_count;
205 /* The maximum number of page entries needed by each got. */
206 unsigned int max_pages;
207 /* The total number of global entries which will live in the
208 primary got and be automatically relocated. This includes
209 those not referenced by the primary GOT but included in
210 the "master" GOT. */
211 unsigned int global_count;
212 };
213
214 /* A structure used to pass information to htab_traverse callbacks
215 when laying out the GOT. */
216
217 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg
218 {
219 struct bfd_link_info *info;
220 struct mips_got_info *g;
221 int value;
222 };
223
224 struct _mips_elf_section_data
225 {
226 struct bfd_elf_section_data elf;
227 union
228 {
229 bfd_byte *tdata;
230 } u;
231 };
232
233 #define mips_elf_section_data(sec) \
234 ((struct _mips_elf_section_data *) elf_section_data (sec))
235
236 #define is_mips_elf(bfd) \
237 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
238 && elf_tdata (bfd) != NULL \
239 && elf_object_id (bfd) == MIPS_ELF_DATA)
240
241 /* The ABI says that every symbol used by dynamic relocations must have
242 a global GOT entry. Among other things, this provides the dynamic
243 linker with a free, directly-indexed cache. The GOT can therefore
244 contain symbols that are not referenced by GOT relocations themselves
245 (in other words, it may have symbols that are not referenced by things
246 like R_MIPS_GOT16 and R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE).
247
248 GOT relocations are less likely to overflow if we put the associated
249 GOT entries towards the beginning. We therefore divide the global
250 GOT entries into two areas: "normal" and "reloc-only". Entries in
251 the first area can be used for both dynamic relocations and GP-relative
252 accesses, while those in the "reloc-only" area are for dynamic
253 relocations only.
254
255 These GGA_* ("Global GOT Area") values are organised so that lower
256 values are more general than higher values. Also, non-GGA_NONE
257 values are ordered by the position of the area in the GOT. */
258 #define GGA_NORMAL 0
259 #define GGA_RELOC_ONLY 1
260 #define GGA_NONE 2
261
262 /* Information about a non-PIC interface to a PIC function. There are
263 two ways of creating these interfaces. The first is to add:
264
265 lui $25,%hi(func)
266 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
267
268 immediately before a PIC function "func". The second is to add:
269
270 lui $25,%hi(func)
271 j func
272 addiu $25,$25,%lo(func)
273
274 to a separate trampoline section.
275
276 Stubs of the first kind go in a new section immediately before the
277 target function. Stubs of the second kind go in a single section
278 pointed to by the hash table's "strampoline" field. */
279 struct mips_elf_la25_stub {
280 /* The generated section that contains this stub. */
281 asection *stub_section;
282
283 /* The offset of the stub from the start of STUB_SECTION. */
284 bfd_vma offset;
285
286 /* One symbol for the original function. Its location is available
287 in H->root.root.u.def. */
288 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
289 };
290
291 /* Macros for populating a mips_elf_la25_stub. */
292
293 #define LA25_LUI(VAL) (0x3c190000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
294 #define LA25_J(VAL) (0x08000000 | (((VAL) >> 2) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
295 #define LA25_BC(VAL) (0xc8000000 | (((VAL) >> 2) & 0x3ffffff)) /* bc VAL */
296 #define LA25_ADDIU(VAL) (0x27390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
297 #define LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
298 (0x41b90000 | (VAL)) /* lui t9,VAL */
299 #define LA25_J_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
300 (0xd4000000 | (((VAL) >> 1) & 0x3ffffff)) /* j VAL */
301 #define LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
302 (0x33390000 | (VAL)) /* addiu t9,t9,VAL */
303
304 /* This structure is passed to mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f when sorting
305 the dynamic symbols. */
306
307 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data
308 {
309 /* The symbol in the global GOT with the lowest dynamic symbol table
310 index. */
311 struct elf_link_hash_entry *low;
312 /* The least dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a non-TLS
313 symbol with a GOT entry. */
314 bfd_size_type min_got_dynindx;
315 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a symbol
316 with a GOT entry that is not referenced (e.g., a dynamic symbol
317 with dynamic relocations pointing to it from non-primary GOTs). */
318 bfd_size_type max_unref_got_dynindx;
319 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to a local
320 symbol. */
321 bfd_size_type max_local_dynindx;
322 /* The greatest dynamic symbol table index corresponding to an external
323 symbol without a GOT entry. */
324 bfd_size_type max_non_got_dynindx;
325 /* If non-NULL, output BFD for .MIPS.xhash finalization. */
326 bfd *output_bfd;
327 /* If non-NULL, pointer to contents of .MIPS.xhash for filling in
328 real final dynindx. */
329 bfd_byte *mipsxhash;
330 };
331
332 /* We make up to two PLT entries if needed, one for standard MIPS code
333 and one for compressed code, either a MIPS16 or microMIPS one. We
334 keep a separate record of traditional lazy-binding stubs, for easier
335 processing. */
336
337 struct plt_entry
338 {
339 /* Traditional SVR4 stub offset, or -1 if none. */
340 bfd_vma stub_offset;
341
342 /* Standard PLT entry offset, or -1 if none. */
343 bfd_vma mips_offset;
344
345 /* Compressed PLT entry offset, or -1 if none. */
346 bfd_vma comp_offset;
347
348 /* The corresponding .got.plt index, or -1 if none. */
349 bfd_vma gotplt_index;
350
351 /* Whether we need a standard PLT entry. */
352 unsigned int need_mips : 1;
353
354 /* Whether we need a compressed PLT entry. */
355 unsigned int need_comp : 1;
356 };
357
358 /* The MIPS ELF linker needs additional information for each symbol in
359 the global hash table. */
360
361 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry
362 {
363 struct elf_link_hash_entry root;
364
365 /* External symbol information. */
366 EXTR esym;
367
368 /* The la25 stub we have created for ths symbol, if any. */
369 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *la25_stub;
370
371 /* Number of R_MIPS_32, R_MIPS_REL32, or R_MIPS_64 relocs against
372 this symbol. */
373 unsigned int possibly_dynamic_relocs;
374
375 /* If there is a stub that 32 bit functions should use to call this
376 16 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
377 asection *fn_stub;
378
379 /* If there is a stub that 16 bit functions should use to call this
380 32 bit function, this points to the section containing the stub. */
381 asection *call_stub;
382
383 /* This is like the call_stub field, but it is used if the function
384 being called returns a floating point value. */
385 asection *call_fp_stub;
386
387 /* If non-zero, location in .MIPS.xhash to write real final dynindx. */
388 bfd_vma mipsxhash_loc;
389
390 /* The highest GGA_* value that satisfies all references to this symbol. */
391 unsigned int global_got_area : 2;
392
393 /* True if all GOT relocations against this symbol are for calls. This is
394 a looser condition than no_fn_stub below, because there may be other
395 non-call non-GOT relocations against the symbol. */
396 unsigned int got_only_for_calls : 1;
397
398 /* True if one of the relocations described by possibly_dynamic_relocs
399 is against a readonly section. */
400 unsigned int readonly_reloc : 1;
401
402 /* True if there is a relocation against this symbol that must be
403 resolved by the static linker (in other words, if the relocation
404 cannot possibly be made dynamic). */
405 unsigned int has_static_relocs : 1;
406
407 /* True if we must not create a .MIPS.stubs entry for this symbol.
408 This is set, for example, if there are relocations related to
409 taking the function's address, i.e. any but R_MIPS_CALL*16 ones.
410 See "MIPS ABI Supplement, 3rd Edition", p. 4-20. */
411 unsigned int no_fn_stub : 1;
412
413 /* Whether we need the fn_stub; this is true if this symbol appears
414 in any relocs other than a 16 bit call. */
415 unsigned int need_fn_stub : 1;
416
417 /* True if this symbol is referenced by branch relocations from
418 any non-PIC input file. This is used to determine whether an
419 la25 stub is required. */
420 unsigned int has_nonpic_branches : 1;
421
422 /* Does this symbol need a traditional MIPS lazy-binding stub
423 (as opposed to a PLT entry)? */
424 unsigned int needs_lazy_stub : 1;
425
426 /* Does this symbol resolve to a PLT entry? */
427 unsigned int use_plt_entry : 1;
428 };
429
430 /* MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
431
432 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table
433 {
434 struct elf_link_hash_table root;
435
436 /* The number of .rtproc entries. */
437 bfd_size_type procedure_count;
438
439 /* The size of the .compact_rel section (if SGI_COMPAT). */
440 bfd_size_type compact_rel_size;
441
442 /* This flag indicates that the value of DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP dynamic entry
443 is set to the address of __rld_obj_head as in IRIX5 and IRIX6. */
444 bfd_boolean use_rld_obj_head;
445
446 /* The __rld_map or __rld_obj_head symbol. */
447 struct elf_link_hash_entry *rld_symbol;
448
449 /* This is set if we see any mips16 stub sections. */
450 bfd_boolean mips16_stubs_seen;
451
452 /* True if we can generate copy relocs and PLTs. */
453 bfd_boolean use_plts_and_copy_relocs;
454
455 /* True if we can only use 32-bit microMIPS instructions. */
456 bfd_boolean insn32;
457
458 /* True if we suppress checks for invalid branches between ISA modes. */
459 bfd_boolean ignore_branch_isa;
460
461 /* True if we are targetting R6 compact branches. */
462 bfd_boolean compact_branches;
463
464 /* True if we're generating code for VxWorks. */
465 bfd_boolean is_vxworks;
466
467 /* True if we already reported the small-data section overflow. */
468 bfd_boolean small_data_overflow_reported;
469
470 /* True if we use the special `__gnu_absolute_zero' symbol. */
471 bfd_boolean use_absolute_zero;
472
473 /* True if we have been configured for a GNU target. */
474 bfd_boolean gnu_target;
475
476 /* Shortcuts to some dynamic sections, or NULL if they are not
477 being used. */
478 asection *srelplt2;
479 asection *sstubs;
480
481 /* The master GOT information. */
482 struct mips_got_info *got_info;
483
484 /* The global symbol in the GOT with the lowest index in the dynamic
485 symbol table. */
486 struct elf_link_hash_entry *global_gotsym;
487
488 /* The size of the PLT header in bytes. */
489 bfd_vma plt_header_size;
490
491 /* The size of a standard PLT entry in bytes. */
492 bfd_vma plt_mips_entry_size;
493
494 /* The size of a compressed PLT entry in bytes. */
495 bfd_vma plt_comp_entry_size;
496
497 /* The offset of the next standard PLT entry to create. */
498 bfd_vma plt_mips_offset;
499
500 /* The offset of the next compressed PLT entry to create. */
501 bfd_vma plt_comp_offset;
502
503 /* The index of the next .got.plt entry to create. */
504 bfd_vma plt_got_index;
505
506 /* The number of functions that need a lazy-binding stub. */
507 bfd_vma lazy_stub_count;
508
509 /* The size of a function stub entry in bytes. */
510 bfd_vma function_stub_size;
511
512 /* The number of reserved entries at the beginning of the GOT. */
513 unsigned int reserved_gotno;
514
515 /* The section used for mips_elf_la25_stub trampolines.
516 See the comment above that structure for details. */
517 asection *strampoline;
518
519 /* A table of mips_elf_la25_stubs, indexed by (input_section, offset)
520 pairs. */
521 htab_t la25_stubs;
522
523 /* A function FN (NAME, IS, OS) that creates a new input section
524 called NAME and links it to output section OS. If IS is nonnull,
525 the new section should go immediately before it, otherwise it
526 should go at the (current) beginning of OS.
527
528 The function returns the new section on success, otherwise it
529 returns null. */
530 asection *(*add_stub_section) (const char *, asection *, asection *);
531
532 /* Small local sym cache. */
533 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
534
535 /* Is the PLT header compressed? */
536 unsigned int plt_header_is_comp : 1;
537 };
538
539 /* Get the MIPS ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
540
541 #define mips_elf_hash_table(p) \
542 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
543 == MIPS_ELF_DATA ? ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
544
545 /* A structure used to communicate with htab_traverse callbacks. */
546 struct mips_htab_traverse_info
547 {
548 /* The usual link-wide information. */
549 struct bfd_link_info *info;
550 bfd *output_bfd;
551
552 /* Starts off FALSE and is set to TRUE if the link should be aborted. */
553 bfd_boolean error;
554 };
555
556 /* MIPS ELF private object data. */
557
558 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata
559 {
560 /* Generic ELF private object data. */
561 struct elf_obj_tdata root;
562
563 /* Input BFD providing Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attribute for output. */
564 bfd *abi_fp_bfd;
565
566 /* Input BFD providing Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA attribute for output. */
567 bfd *abi_msa_bfd;
568
569 /* The abiflags for this object. */
570 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 abiflags;
571 bfd_boolean abiflags_valid;
572
573 /* The GOT requirements of input bfds. */
574 struct mips_got_info *got;
575
576 /* Used by _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line. The structure could be
577 included directly in this one, but there's no point to wasting
578 the memory just for the infrequently called find_nearest_line. */
579 struct mips_elf_find_line *find_line_info;
580
581 /* An array of stub sections indexed by symbol number. */
582 asection **local_stubs;
583 asection **local_call_stubs;
584
585 /* The Irix 5 support uses two virtual sections, which represent
586 text/data symbols defined in dynamic objects. */
587 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
588 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
589 asection *elf_data_section;
590 asection *elf_text_section;
591 };
592
593 /* Get MIPS ELF private object data from BFD's tdata. */
594
595 #define mips_elf_tdata(bfd) \
596 ((struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
597
598 #define TLS_RELOC_P(r_type) \
599 (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32 \
600 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 \
601 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32 \
602 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 \
603 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD \
604 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM \
605 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
606 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
607 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
608 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32 \
609 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 \
610 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
611 || r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16 \
612 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GD \
613 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM \
614 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
615 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
616 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL \
617 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
618 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16 \
619 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD \
620 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM \
621 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16 \
622 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16 \
623 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL \
624 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16 \
625 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16)
626
627 /* Structure used to pass information to mips_elf_output_extsym. */
628
629 struct extsym_info
630 {
631 bfd *abfd;
632 struct bfd_link_info *info;
633 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug;
634 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
635 bfd_boolean failed;
636 };
637
638 /* The names of the runtime procedure table symbols used on IRIX5. */
639
640 static const char * const mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[] =
641 {
642 "_procedure_table",
643 "_procedure_string_table",
644 "_procedure_table_size",
645 NULL
646 };
647
648 /* These structures are used to generate the .compact_rel section on
649 IRIX5. */
650
651 typedef struct
652 {
653 unsigned long id1; /* Always one? */
654 unsigned long num; /* Number of compact relocation entries. */
655 unsigned long id2; /* Always two? */
656 unsigned long offset; /* The file offset of the first relocation. */
657 unsigned long reserved0; /* Zero? */
658 unsigned long reserved1; /* Zero? */
659 } Elf32_compact_rel;
660
661 typedef struct
662 {
663 bfd_byte id1[4];
664 bfd_byte num[4];
665 bfd_byte id2[4];
666 bfd_byte offset[4];
667 bfd_byte reserved0[4];
668 bfd_byte reserved1[4];
669 } Elf32_External_compact_rel;
670
671 typedef struct
672 {
673 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
674 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
675 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
676 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
677 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
678 unsigned long vaddr; /* VADDR to be relocated. */
679 } Elf32_crinfo;
680
681 typedef struct
682 {
683 unsigned int ctype : 1; /* 1: long 0: short format. See below. */
684 unsigned int rtype : 4; /* Relocation types. See below. */
685 unsigned int dist2to : 8;
686 unsigned int relvaddr : 19; /* (VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry)/ 4 */
687 unsigned long konst; /* KONST field. See below. */
688 } Elf32_crinfo2;
689
690 typedef struct
691 {
692 bfd_byte info[4];
693 bfd_byte konst[4];
694 bfd_byte vaddr[4];
695 } Elf32_External_crinfo;
696
697 typedef struct
698 {
699 bfd_byte info[4];
700 bfd_byte konst[4];
701 } Elf32_External_crinfo2;
702
703 /* These are the constants used to swap the bitfields in a crinfo. */
704
705 #define CRINFO_CTYPE (0x1)
706 #define CRINFO_CTYPE_SH (31)
707 #define CRINFO_RTYPE (0xf)
708 #define CRINFO_RTYPE_SH (27)
709 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO (0xff)
710 #define CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH (19)
711 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR (0x7ffff)
712 #define CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH (0)
713
714 /* A compact relocation info has long (3 words) or short (2 words)
715 formats. A short format doesn't have VADDR field and relvaddr
716 fields contains ((VADDR - vaddr of the previous entry) >> 2). */
717 #define CRF_MIPS_LONG 1
718 #define CRF_MIPS_SHORT 0
719
720 /* There are 4 types of compact relocation at least. The value KONST
721 has different meaning for each type:
722
723 (type) (konst)
724 CT_MIPS_REL32 Address in data
725 CT_MIPS_WORD Address in word (XXX)
726 CT_MIPS_GPHI_LO GP - vaddr
727 CT_MIPS_JMPAD Address to jump
728 */
729
730 #define CRT_MIPS_REL32 0xa
731 #define CRT_MIPS_WORD 0xb
732 #define CRT_MIPS_GPHI_LO 0xc
733 #define CRT_MIPS_JMPAD 0xd
734
735 #define mips_elf_set_cr_format(x,format) ((x).ctype = (format))
736 #define mips_elf_set_cr_type(x,type) ((x).rtype = (type))
737 #define mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to(x,v) ((x).dist2to = (v))
738 #define mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr(x,d) ((x).relvaddr = (d)<<2)
739 \f
740 /* The structure of the runtime procedure descriptor created by the
741 loader for use by the static exception system. */
742
743 typedef struct runtime_pdr {
744 bfd_vma adr; /* Memory address of start of procedure. */
745 long regmask; /* Save register mask. */
746 long regoffset; /* Save register offset. */
747 long fregmask; /* Save floating point register mask. */
748 long fregoffset; /* Save floating point register offset. */
749 long frameoffset; /* Frame size. */
750 short framereg; /* Frame pointer register. */
751 short pcreg; /* Offset or reg of return pc. */
752 long irpss; /* Index into the runtime string table. */
753 long reserved;
754 struct exception_info *exception_info;/* Pointer to exception array. */
755 } RPDR, *pRPDR;
756 #define cbRPDR sizeof (RPDR)
757 #define rpdNil ((pRPDR) 0)
758 \f
759 static struct mips_got_entry *mips_elf_create_local_got_entry
760 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, bfd *, bfd_vma, unsigned long,
761 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, int);
762 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f
763 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, void *);
764 static bfd_vma mips_elf_high
765 (bfd_vma);
766 static bfd_boolean mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
767 (bfd *, struct bfd_link_info *, const Elf_Internal_Rela *,
768 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *, asection *, bfd_vma,
769 bfd_vma *, asection *);
770 static bfd_vma mips_elf_adjust_gp
771 (bfd *, struct mips_got_info *, bfd *);
772
773 /* This will be used when we sort the dynamic relocation records. */
774 static bfd *reldyn_sorting_bfd;
775
776 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs with load interlocking that include
777 non-MIPS1 CPUs and R3900. */
778 #define LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P(abfd) \
779 ( ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) != E_MIPS_ARCH_1) \
780 || ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_3900))
781
782 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JAL is converted to BAL.
783 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate
784 for RM9000 for now. */
785 #define JAL_TO_BAL_P(abfd) \
786 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == E_MIPS_MACH_9000)
787
788 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JALR is converted to BAL.
789 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
790 all CPUs. */
791 #define JALR_TO_BAL_P(abfd) 1
792
793 /* True if ABFD is for CPUs that are faster if JR is converted to B.
794 This should be safe for all architectures. We enable this predicate for
795 all CPUs. */
796 #define JR_TO_B_P(abfd) 1
797
798 /* True if ABFD is a PIC object. */
799 #define PIC_OBJECT_P(abfd) \
800 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC) != 0)
801
802 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the O32 ABI. */
803 #define ABI_O32_P(abfd) \
804 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
805
806 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N32 ABI. */
807 #define ABI_N32_P(abfd) \
808 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI2) != 0)
809
810 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using the N64 ABI. */
811 #define ABI_64_P(abfd) \
812 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->elfclass == ELFCLASS64)
813
814 /* Nonzero if ABFD is using NewABI conventions. */
815 #define NEWABI_P(abfd) (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
816
817 /* Nonzero if ABFD has microMIPS code. */
818 #define MICROMIPS_P(abfd) \
819 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS) != 0)
820
821 /* Nonzero if ABFD is MIPS R6. */
822 #define MIPSR6_P(abfd) \
823 ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6 \
824 || (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6)
825
826 /* The IRIX compatibility level we are striving for. */
827 #define IRIX_COMPAT(abfd) \
828 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_irix_compat (abfd))
829
830 /* Whether we are trying to be compatible with IRIX at all. */
831 #define SGI_COMPAT(abfd) \
832 (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) != ict_none)
833
834 /* The name of the options section. */
835 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME(abfd) \
836 (NEWABI_P (abfd) ? ".MIPS.options" : ".options")
837
838 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section.
839 Some IRIX system files do not use MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME. */
840 #define MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
841 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.options") == 0 || strcmp (NAME, ".options") == 0)
842
843 /* True if NAME is the recognized name of any SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS section. */
844 #define MIPS_ELF_ABIFLAGS_SECTION_NAME_P(NAME) \
845 (strcmp (NAME, ".MIPS.abiflags") == 0)
846
847 /* Whether the section is readonly. */
848 #define MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION(sec) \
849 ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY)) \
850 == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY))
851
852 /* The name of the stub section. */
853 #define MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME(abfd) ".MIPS.stubs"
854
855 /* The size of an external REL relocation. */
856 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE(abfd) \
857 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rel)
858
859 /* The size of an external RELA relocation. */
860 #define MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE(abfd) \
861 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_rela)
862
863 /* The size of an external dynamic table entry. */
864 #define MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE(abfd) \
865 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn)
866
867 /* The size of a GOT entry. */
868 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE(abfd) \
869 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
870
871 /* The size of the .rld_map section. */
872 #define MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE(abfd) \
873 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->arch_size / 8)
874
875 /* The size of a symbol-table entry. */
876 #define MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE(abfd) \
877 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_sym)
878
879 /* The default alignment for sections, as a power of two. */
880 #define MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN(abfd) \
881 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->log_file_align)
882
883 /* Get word-sized data. */
884 #define MIPS_ELF_GET_WORD(abfd, ptr) \
885 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? bfd_get_64 (abfd, ptr) : bfd_get_32 (abfd, ptr))
886
887 /* Put out word-sized data. */
888 #define MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD(abfd, val, ptr) \
889 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
890 ? bfd_put_64 (abfd, val, ptr) \
891 : bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, ptr))
892
893 /* The opcode for word-sized loads (LW or LD). */
894 #define MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD(abfd) \
895 (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 0xdc000000 : 0x8c000000)
896
897 /* Add a dynamic symbol table-entry. */
898 #define MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY(info, tag, val) \
899 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, tag, val)
900
901 #define MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO(abfd, rtype, rela) \
902 (get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_mips_rtype_to_howto (abfd, rtype, rela))
903
904 /* The name of the dynamic relocation section. */
905 #define MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME(INFO) \
906 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? ".rela.dyn" : ".rel.dyn")
907
908 /* In case we're on a 32-bit machine, construct a 64-bit "-1" value
909 from smaller values. Start with zero, widen, *then* decrement. */
910 #define MINUS_ONE (((bfd_vma)0) - 1)
911 #define MINUS_TWO (((bfd_vma)0) - 2)
912
913 /* The value to write into got[1] for SVR4 targets, to identify it is
914 a GNU object. The dynamic linker can then use got[1] to store the
915 module pointer. */
916 #define MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK(abfd) \
917 ((bfd_vma) 1 << (ABI_64_P (abfd) ? 63 : 31))
918
919 /* The offset of $gp from the beginning of the .got section. */
920 #define ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET(INFO) \
921 (mips_elf_hash_table (INFO)->is_vxworks ? 0x0 : 0x7ff0)
922
923 /* The maximum size of the GOT for it to be addressable using 16-bit
924 offsets from $gp. */
925 #define MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE(INFO) (ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (INFO) + 0x7fff)
926
927 /* Instructions which appear in a stub. */
928 #define STUB_LW(abfd) \
929 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
930 ? 0xdf998010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
931 : 0x8f998010)) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
932 #define STUB_MOVE 0x03e07825 /* or t7,ra,zero */
933 #define STUB_LUI(VAL) (0x3c180000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
934 #define STUB_JALR 0x0320f809 /* jalr ra,t9 */
935 #define STUB_JALRC 0xf8190000 /* jalrc ra,t9 */
936 #define STUB_ORI(VAL) (0x37180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
937 #define STUB_LI16U(VAL) (0x34180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
938 #define STUB_LI16S(abfd, VAL) \
939 ((ABI_64_P (abfd) \
940 ? (0x64180000 + (VAL)) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
941 : (0x24180000 + (VAL)))) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
942
943 /* Likewise for the microMIPS ASE. */
944 #define STUB_LW_MICROMIPS(abfd) \
945 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
946 ? 0xdf3c8010 /* ld t9,0x8010(gp) */ \
947 : 0xff3c8010) /* lw t9,0x8010(gp) */
948 #define STUB_MOVE_MICROMIPS 0x0dff /* move t7,ra */
949 #define STUB_MOVE32_MICROMIPS 0x001f7a90 /* or t7,ra,zero */
950 #define STUB_LUI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
951 (0x41b80000 + (VAL)) /* lui t8,VAL */
952 #define STUB_JALR_MICROMIPS 0x45d9 /* jalr t9 */
953 #define STUB_JALR32_MICROMIPS 0x03f90f3c /* jalr ra,t9 */
954 #define STUB_ORI_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
955 (0x53180000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,t8,VAL */
956 #define STUB_LI16U_MICROMIPS(VAL) \
957 (0x53000000 + (VAL)) /* ori t8,zero,VAL unsigned */
958 #define STUB_LI16S_MICROMIPS(abfd, VAL) \
959 (ABI_64_P (abfd) \
960 ? 0x5f000000 + (VAL) /* daddiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */ \
961 : 0x33000000 + (VAL)) /* addiu t8,zero,VAL sign extended */
962
963 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
964 #define MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
965 #define MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 12
966 #define MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 16
967 #define MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE 16
968 #define MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE 20
969
970 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
971 section. */
972
973 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER(abfd) \
974 (ABI_N32_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib32/libc.so.1" \
975 : ABI_64_P (abfd) ? "/usr/lib64/libc.so.1" \
976 : "/usr/lib/libc.so.1")
977
978 #ifdef BFD64
979 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) \
980 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? CONCAT4 (pre,64,_,pos) : CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos))
981 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
982 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_SYM (i) : ELF32_R_SYM (i))
983 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
984 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_MIPS_R_TYPE (i) : ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
985 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
986 (ABI_64_P (bfd) ? ELF64_R_INFO (s, t) : ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
987 #else
988 #define MNAME(bfd,pre,pos) CONCAT4 (pre,32,_,pos)
989 #define ELF_R_SYM(bfd, i) \
990 (ELF32_R_SYM (i))
991 #define ELF_R_TYPE(bfd, i) \
992 (ELF32_R_TYPE (i))
993 #define ELF_R_INFO(bfd, s, t) \
994 (ELF32_R_INFO (s, t))
995 #endif
996 \f
997 /* The mips16 compiler uses a couple of special sections to handle
998 floating point arguments.
999
1000 Section names that look like .mips16.fn.FNNAME contain stubs that
1001 copy floating point arguments from the fp regs to the gp regs and
1002 then jump to FNNAME. If any 32 bit function calls FNNAME, the
1003 call should be redirected to the stub instead. If no 32 bit
1004 function calls FNNAME, the stub should be discarded. We need to
1005 consider any reference to the function, not just a call, because
1006 if the address of the function is taken we will need the stub,
1007 since the address might be passed to a 32 bit function.
1008
1009 Section names that look like .mips16.call.FNNAME contain stubs
1010 that copy floating point arguments from the gp regs to the fp
1011 regs and then jump to FNNAME. If FNNAME is a 32 bit function,
1012 then any 16 bit function that calls FNNAME should be redirected
1013 to the stub instead. If FNNAME is not a 32 bit function, the
1014 stub should be discarded.
1015
1016 .mips16.call.fp.FNNAME sections are similar, but contain stubs
1017 which call FNNAME and then copy the return value from the fp regs
1018 to the gp regs. These stubs store the return value in $18 while
1019 calling FNNAME; any function which might call one of these stubs
1020 must arrange to save $18 around the call. (This case is not
1021 needed for 32 bit functions that call 16 bit functions, because
1022 16 bit functions always return floating point values in both
1023 $f0/$f1 and $2/$3.)
1024
1025 Note that in all cases FNNAME might be defined statically.
1026 Therefore, FNNAME is not used literally. Instead, the relocation
1027 information will indicate which symbol the section is for.
1028
1029 We record any stubs that we find in the symbol table. */
1030
1031 #define FN_STUB ".mips16.fn."
1032 #define CALL_STUB ".mips16.call."
1033 #define CALL_FP_STUB ".mips16.call.fp."
1034
1035 #define FN_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, FN_STUB)
1036 #define CALL_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_STUB)
1037 #define CALL_FP_STUB_P(name) CONST_STRNEQ (name, CALL_FP_STUB)
1038 \f
1039 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an O32 executable. */
1040 static const bfd_vma mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1041 {
1042 0x3c1c0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1043 0x8f990000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
1044 0x279c0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1045 0x031cc023, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
1046 0x03e07825, /* or t7, ra, zero */
1047 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1048 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
1049 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1050 };
1051
1052 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an O32 executable using compact
1053 jumps. */
1054 static const bfd_vma mipsr6_o32_exec_plt0_entry_compact[] =
1055 {
1056 0x3c1c0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1057 0x8f990000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
1058 0x279c0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1059 0x031cc023, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
1060 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 # 32-bit move (addu) */
1061 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1062 0x2718fffe, /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1063 0xf8190000 /* jalrc $25 */
1064 };
1065
1066 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N32 executable. Different
1067 because gp ($28) is not available; we use t2 ($14) instead. */
1068 static const bfd_vma mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1069 {
1070 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1071 0x8dd90000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
1072 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1073 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
1074 0x03e07825, /* or t7, ra, zero */
1075 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1076 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
1077 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1078 };
1079
1080 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N32 executable using compact
1081 jumps. Different because gp ($28) is not available; we use t2 ($14)
1082 instead. */
1083 static const bfd_vma mipsr6_n32_exec_plt0_entry_compact[] =
1084 {
1085 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1086 0x8dd90000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
1087 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1088 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
1089 0x03e07821, /* move $15, $31 # 32-bit move (addu) */
1090 0x0018c082, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1091 0x2718fffe, /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1092 0xf8190000 /* jalrc $25 */
1093 };
1094
1095 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N64 executable. Different
1096 from N32 because of the increased size of GOT entries. */
1097 static const bfd_vma mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1098 {
1099 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1100 0xddd90000, /* ld $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
1101 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1102 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
1103 0x03e07825, /* or t7, ra, zero */
1104 0x0018c0c2, /* srl $24, $24, 3 */
1105 0x0320f809, /* jalr $25 */
1106 0x2718fffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1107 };
1108
1109 /* The format of the first PLT entry in an N64 executable using compact
1110 jumps. Different from N32 because of the increased size of GOT
1111 entries. */
1112 static const bfd_vma mipsr6_n64_exec_plt0_entry_compact[] =
1113 {
1114 0x3c0e0000, /* lui $14, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1115 0xddd90000, /* ld $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($14) */
1116 0x25ce0000, /* addiu $14, $14, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1117 0x030ec023, /* subu $24, $24, $14 */
1118 0x03e0782d, /* move $15, $31 # 64-bit move (daddu) */
1119 0x0018c0c2, /* srl $24, $24, 3 */
1120 0x2718fffe, /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1121 0xf8190000 /* jalrc $25 */
1122 };
1123
1124
1125 /* The format of the microMIPS first PLT entry in an O32 executable.
1126 We rely on v0 ($2) rather than t8 ($24) to contain the address
1127 of the GOTPLT entry handled, so this stub may only be used when
1128 all the subsequent PLT entries are microMIPS code too.
1129
1130 The trailing NOP is for alignment and correct disassembly only. */
1131 static const bfd_vma micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1132 {
1133 0x7980, 0x0000, /* addiupc $3, (&GOTPLT[0]) - . */
1134 0xff23, 0x0000, /* lw $25, 0($3) */
1135 0x0535, /* subu $2, $2, $3 */
1136 0x2525, /* srl $2, $2, 2 */
1137 0x3302, 0xfffe, /* subu $24, $2, 2 */
1138 0x0dff, /* move $15, $31 */
1139 0x45f9, /* jalrs $25 */
1140 0x0f83, /* move $28, $3 */
1141 0x0c00 /* nop */
1142 };
1143
1144 /* The format of the microMIPS first PLT entry in an O32 executable
1145 in the insn32 mode. */
1146 static const bfd_vma micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1147 {
1148 0x41bc, 0x0000, /* lui $28, %hi(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1149 0xff3c, 0x0000, /* lw $25, %lo(&GOTPLT[0])($28) */
1150 0x339c, 0x0000, /* addiu $28, $28, %lo(&GOTPLT[0]) */
1151 0x0398, 0xc1d0, /* subu $24, $24, $28 */
1152 0x001f, 0x7a90, /* or $15, $31, zero */
1153 0x0318, 0x1040, /* srl $24, $24, 2 */
1154 0x03f9, 0x0f3c, /* jalr $25 */
1155 0x3318, 0xfffe /* subu $24, $24, 2 */
1156 };
1157
1158 /* The format of subsequent standard PLT entries. */
1159 static const bfd_vma mips_exec_plt_entry[] =
1160 {
1161 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1162 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1163 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1164 0x03200008 /* jr $25 */
1165 };
1166
1167 static const bfd_vma mipsr6_exec_plt_entry[] =
1168 {
1169 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1170 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1171 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1172 0x03200009 /* jr $25 */
1173 };
1174
1175 static const bfd_vma mipsr6_exec_plt_entry_compact[] =
1176 {
1177 0x3c0f0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1178 0x01f90000, /* l[wd] $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1179 0x25f80000, /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1180 0xd8190000 /* jic $25, 0 */
1181 };
1182
1183 /* The format of subsequent MIPS16 o32 PLT entries. We use v0 ($2)
1184 and v1 ($3) as temporaries because t8 ($24) and t9 ($25) are not
1185 directly addressable. */
1186 static const bfd_vma mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry[] =
1187 {
1188 0xb203, /* lw $2, 12($pc) */
1189 0x9a60, /* lw $3, 0($2) */
1190 0x651a, /* move $24, $2 */
1191 0xeb00, /* jr $3 */
1192 0x653b, /* move $25, $3 */
1193 0x6500, /* nop */
1194 0x0000, 0x0000 /* .word (.got.plt entry) */
1195 };
1196
1197 /* The format of subsequent microMIPS o32 PLT entries. We use v0 ($2)
1198 as a temporary because t8 ($24) is not addressable with ADDIUPC. */
1199 static const bfd_vma micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry[] =
1200 {
1201 0x7900, 0x0000, /* addiupc $2, (.got.plt entry) - . */
1202 0xff22, 0x0000, /* lw $25, 0($2) */
1203 0x4599, /* jr $25 */
1204 0x0f02 /* move $24, $2 */
1205 };
1206
1207 /* The format of subsequent microMIPS o32 PLT entries in the insn32 mode. */
1208 static const bfd_vma micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry[] =
1209 {
1210 0x41af, 0x0000, /* lui $15, %hi(.got.plt entry) */
1211 0xff2f, 0x0000, /* lw $25, %lo(.got.plt entry)($15) */
1212 0x0019, 0x0f3c, /* jr $25 */
1213 0x330f, 0x0000 /* addiu $24, $15, %lo(.got.plt entry) */
1214 };
1215
1216 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks executable. */
1217 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry[] =
1218 {
1219 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
1220 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_) */
1221 0x8f390008, /* lw t9, 8(t9) */
1222 0x00000000, /* nop */
1223 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1224 0x00000000 /* nop */
1225 };
1226
1227 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
1228 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry[] =
1229 {
1230 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
1231 0x24180000, /* li t8, <pltindex> */
1232 0x3c190000, /* lui t9, %hi(<.got.plt slot>) */
1233 0x27390000, /* addiu t9, t9, %lo(<.got.plt slot>) */
1234 0x8f390000, /* lw t9, 0(t9) */
1235 0x00000000, /* nop */
1236 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1237 0x00000000 /* nop */
1238 };
1239
1240 /* The format of the first PLT entry in a VxWorks shared object. */
1241 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[] =
1242 {
1243 0x8f990008, /* lw t9, 8(gp) */
1244 0x00000000, /* nop */
1245 0x03200008, /* jr t9 */
1246 0x00000000, /* nop */
1247 0x00000000, /* nop */
1248 0x00000000 /* nop */
1249 };
1250
1251 /* The format of subsequent PLT entries. */
1252 static const bfd_vma mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry[] =
1253 {
1254 0x10000000, /* b .PLT_resolver */
1255 0x24180000 /* li t8, <pltindex> */
1256 };
1257 \f
1258 /* microMIPS 32-bit opcode helper installer. */
1259
1260 static void
1261 bfd_put_micromips_32 (const bfd *abfd, bfd_vma opcode, bfd_byte *ptr)
1262 {
1263 bfd_put_16 (abfd, (opcode >> 16) & 0xffff, ptr);
1264 bfd_put_16 (abfd, opcode & 0xffff, ptr + 2);
1265 }
1266
1267 /* microMIPS 32-bit opcode helper retriever. */
1268
1269 static bfd_vma
1270 bfd_get_micromips_32 (const bfd *abfd, const bfd_byte *ptr)
1271 {
1272 return (bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr) << 16) | bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr + 2);
1273 }
1274 \f
1275 /* Look up an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1276
1277 #define mips_elf_link_hash_lookup(table, string, create, copy, follow) \
1278 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) \
1279 elf_link_hash_lookup (&(table)->root, (string), (create), \
1280 (copy), (follow)))
1281
1282 /* Traverse a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1283
1284 #define mips_elf_link_hash_traverse(table, func, info) \
1285 (elf_link_hash_traverse \
1286 (&(table)->root, \
1287 (bfd_boolean (*) (struct elf_link_hash_entry *, void *)) (func), \
1288 (info)))
1289
1290 /* Find the base offsets for thread-local storage in this object,
1291 for GD/LD and IE/LE respectively. */
1292
1293 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
1294 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
1295
1296 static bfd_vma
1297 dtprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1298 {
1299 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1300 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1301 return 0;
1302 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
1303 }
1304
1305 static bfd_vma
1306 tprel_base (struct bfd_link_info *info)
1307 {
1308 /* If tls_sec is NULL, we should have signalled an error already. */
1309 if (elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec == NULL)
1310 return 0;
1311 return elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
1312 }
1313
1314 /* Create an entry in a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
1315
1316 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
1317 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
1318 struct bfd_hash_table *table, const char *string)
1319 {
1320 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *ret =
1321 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) entry;
1322
1323 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
1324 subclass. */
1325 if (ret == NULL)
1326 ret = bfd_hash_allocate (table, sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry));
1327 if (ret == NULL)
1328 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1329
1330 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
1331 ret = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
1332 _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc ((struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret,
1333 table, string));
1334 if (ret != NULL)
1335 {
1336 /* Set local fields. */
1337 memset (&ret->esym, 0, sizeof (EXTR));
1338 /* We use -2 as a marker to indicate that the information has
1339 not been set. -1 means there is no associated ifd. */
1340 ret->esym.ifd = -2;
1341 ret->la25_stub = 0;
1342 ret->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
1343 ret->fn_stub = NULL;
1344 ret->call_stub = NULL;
1345 ret->call_fp_stub = NULL;
1346 ret->mipsxhash_loc = 0;
1347 ret->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
1348 ret->got_only_for_calls = TRUE;
1349 ret->readonly_reloc = FALSE;
1350 ret->has_static_relocs = FALSE;
1351 ret->no_fn_stub = FALSE;
1352 ret->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
1353 ret->has_nonpic_branches = FALSE;
1354 ret->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
1355 ret->use_plt_entry = FALSE;
1356 }
1357
1358 return (struct bfd_hash_entry *) ret;
1359 }
1360
1361 /* Allocate MIPS ELF private object data. */
1362
1363 bfd_boolean
1364 _bfd_mips_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1365 {
1366 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_elf_obj_tdata),
1367 MIPS_ELF_DATA);
1368 }
1369
1370 bfd_boolean
1371 _bfd_mips_elf_new_section_hook (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1372 {
1373 if (!sec->used_by_bfd)
1374 {
1375 struct _mips_elf_section_data *sdata;
1376 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*sdata);
1377
1378 sdata = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1379 if (sdata == NULL)
1380 return FALSE;
1381 sec->used_by_bfd = sdata;
1382 }
1383
1384 return _bfd_elf_new_section_hook (abfd, sec);
1385 }
1386 \f
1387 /* Read ECOFF debugging information from a .mdebug section into a
1388 ecoff_debug_info structure. */
1389
1390 bfd_boolean
1391 _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (bfd *abfd, asection *section,
1392 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1393 {
1394 HDRR *symhdr;
1395 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1396 char *ext_hdr;
1397
1398 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1399 memset (debug, 0, sizeof (*debug));
1400
1401 ext_hdr = bfd_malloc (swap->external_hdr_size);
1402 if (ext_hdr == NULL && swap->external_hdr_size != 0)
1403 goto error_return;
1404
1405 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, section, ext_hdr, 0,
1406 swap->external_hdr_size))
1407 goto error_return;
1408
1409 symhdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1410 (*swap->swap_hdr_in) (abfd, ext_hdr, symhdr);
1411
1412 /* The symbolic header contains absolute file offsets and sizes to
1413 read. */
1414 #define READ(ptr, offset, count, size, type) \
1415 if (symhdr->count == 0) \
1416 debug->ptr = NULL; \
1417 else \
1418 { \
1419 bfd_size_type amt = (bfd_size_type) size * symhdr->count; \
1420 debug->ptr = bfd_malloc (amt); \
1421 if (debug->ptr == NULL) \
1422 goto error_return; \
1423 if (bfd_seek (abfd, symhdr->offset, SEEK_SET) != 0 \
1424 || bfd_bread (debug->ptr, amt, abfd) != amt) \
1425 goto error_return; \
1426 }
1427
1428 READ (line, cbLineOffset, cbLine, sizeof (unsigned char), unsigned char *);
1429 READ (external_dnr, cbDnOffset, idnMax, swap->external_dnr_size, void *);
1430 READ (external_pdr, cbPdOffset, ipdMax, swap->external_pdr_size, void *);
1431 READ (external_sym, cbSymOffset, isymMax, swap->external_sym_size, void *);
1432 READ (external_opt, cbOptOffset, ioptMax, swap->external_opt_size, void *);
1433 READ (external_aux, cbAuxOffset, iauxMax, sizeof (union aux_ext),
1434 union aux_ext *);
1435 READ (ss, cbSsOffset, issMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1436 READ (ssext, cbSsExtOffset, issExtMax, sizeof (char), char *);
1437 READ (external_fdr, cbFdOffset, ifdMax, swap->external_fdr_size, void *);
1438 READ (external_rfd, cbRfdOffset, crfd, swap->external_rfd_size, void *);
1439 READ (external_ext, cbExtOffset, iextMax, swap->external_ext_size, void *);
1440 #undef READ
1441
1442 debug->fdr = NULL;
1443
1444 return TRUE;
1445
1446 error_return:
1447 if (ext_hdr != NULL)
1448 free (ext_hdr);
1449 if (debug->line != NULL)
1450 free (debug->line);
1451 if (debug->external_dnr != NULL)
1452 free (debug->external_dnr);
1453 if (debug->external_pdr != NULL)
1454 free (debug->external_pdr);
1455 if (debug->external_sym != NULL)
1456 free (debug->external_sym);
1457 if (debug->external_opt != NULL)
1458 free (debug->external_opt);
1459 if (debug->external_aux != NULL)
1460 free (debug->external_aux);
1461 if (debug->ss != NULL)
1462 free (debug->ss);
1463 if (debug->ssext != NULL)
1464 free (debug->ssext);
1465 if (debug->external_fdr != NULL)
1466 free (debug->external_fdr);
1467 if (debug->external_rfd != NULL)
1468 free (debug->external_rfd);
1469 if (debug->external_ext != NULL)
1470 free (debug->external_ext);
1471 return FALSE;
1472 }
1473 \f
1474 /* Swap RPDR (runtime procedure table entry) for output. */
1475
1476 static void
1477 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (bfd *abfd, const RPDR *in, struct rpdr_ext *ex)
1478 {
1479 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, in->adr, ex->p_adr);
1480 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regmask, ex->p_regmask);
1481 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->regoffset, ex->p_regoffset);
1482 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregmask, ex->p_fregmask);
1483 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->fregoffset, ex->p_fregoffset);
1484 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->frameoffset, ex->p_frameoffset);
1485
1486 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->framereg, ex->p_framereg);
1487 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->pcreg, ex->p_pcreg);
1488
1489 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->irpss, ex->p_irpss);
1490 }
1491
1492 /* Create a runtime procedure table from the .mdebug section. */
1493
1494 static bfd_boolean
1495 mips_elf_create_procedure_table (void *handle, bfd *abfd,
1496 struct bfd_link_info *info, asection *s,
1497 struct ecoff_debug_info *debug)
1498 {
1499 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap;
1500 HDRR *hdr = &debug->symbolic_header;
1501 RPDR *rpdr, *rp;
1502 struct rpdr_ext *erp;
1503 void *rtproc;
1504 struct pdr_ext *epdr;
1505 struct sym_ext *esym;
1506 char *ss, **sv;
1507 char *str;
1508 bfd_size_type size;
1509 bfd_size_type count;
1510 unsigned long sindex;
1511 unsigned long i;
1512 PDR pdr;
1513 SYMR sym;
1514 const char *no_name_func = _("static procedure (no name)");
1515
1516 epdr = NULL;
1517 rpdr = NULL;
1518 esym = NULL;
1519 ss = NULL;
1520 sv = NULL;
1521
1522 swap = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
1523
1524 sindex = strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1525 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1526 if (count > 0)
1527 {
1528 size = swap->external_pdr_size;
1529
1530 epdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1531 if (epdr == NULL)
1532 goto error_return;
1533
1534 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_pdr (handle, (bfd_byte *) epdr))
1535 goto error_return;
1536
1537 size = sizeof (RPDR);
1538 rp = rpdr = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1539 if (rpdr == NULL)
1540 goto error_return;
1541
1542 size = sizeof (char *);
1543 sv = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1544 if (sv == NULL)
1545 goto error_return;
1546
1547 count = hdr->isymMax;
1548 size = swap->external_sym_size;
1549 esym = bfd_malloc (size * count);
1550 if (esym == NULL)
1551 goto error_return;
1552
1553 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_sym (handle, (bfd_byte *) esym))
1554 goto error_return;
1555
1556 count = hdr->issMax;
1557 ss = bfd_malloc (count);
1558 if (ss == NULL)
1559 goto error_return;
1560 if (! _bfd_ecoff_get_accumulated_ss (handle, (bfd_byte *) ss))
1561 goto error_return;
1562
1563 count = hdr->ipdMax;
1564 for (i = 0; i < (unsigned long) count; i++, rp++)
1565 {
1566 (*swap->swap_pdr_in) (abfd, epdr + i, &pdr);
1567 (*swap->swap_sym_in) (abfd, &esym[pdr.isym], &sym);
1568 rp->adr = sym.value;
1569 rp->regmask = pdr.regmask;
1570 rp->regoffset = pdr.regoffset;
1571 rp->fregmask = pdr.fregmask;
1572 rp->fregoffset = pdr.fregoffset;
1573 rp->frameoffset = pdr.frameoffset;
1574 rp->framereg = pdr.framereg;
1575 rp->pcreg = pdr.pcreg;
1576 rp->irpss = sindex;
1577 sv[i] = ss + sym.iss;
1578 sindex += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1579 }
1580 }
1581
1582 size = sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2) + sindex;
1583 size = BFD_ALIGN (size, 16);
1584 rtproc = bfd_alloc (abfd, size);
1585 if (rtproc == NULL)
1586 {
1587 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = 0;
1588 goto error_return;
1589 }
1590
1591 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count = count + 2;
1592
1593 erp = rtproc;
1594 memset (erp, 0, sizeof (struct rpdr_ext));
1595 erp++;
1596 str = (char *) rtproc + sizeof (struct rpdr_ext) * (count + 2);
1597 strcpy (str, no_name_func);
1598 str += strlen (no_name_func) + 1;
1599 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1600 {
1601 ecoff_swap_rpdr_out (abfd, rpdr + i, erp + i);
1602 strcpy (str, sv[i]);
1603 str += strlen (sv[i]) + 1;
1604 }
1605 H_PUT_S32 (abfd, -1, (erp + count)->p_adr);
1606
1607 /* Set the size and contents of .rtproc section. */
1608 s->size = size;
1609 s->contents = rtproc;
1610
1611 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
1612 matters, but someday it might). */
1613 s->map_head.link_order = NULL;
1614
1615 if (epdr != NULL)
1616 free (epdr);
1617 if (rpdr != NULL)
1618 free (rpdr);
1619 if (esym != NULL)
1620 free (esym);
1621 if (ss != NULL)
1622 free (ss);
1623 if (sv != NULL)
1624 free (sv);
1625
1626 return TRUE;
1627
1628 error_return:
1629 if (epdr != NULL)
1630 free (epdr);
1631 if (rpdr != NULL)
1632 free (rpdr);
1633 if (esym != NULL)
1634 free (esym);
1635 if (ss != NULL)
1636 free (ss);
1637 if (sv != NULL)
1638 free (sv);
1639 return FALSE;
1640 }
1641 \f
1642 /* We're going to create a stub for H. Create a symbol for the stub's
1643 value and size, to help make the disassembly easier to read. */
1644
1645 static bfd_boolean
1646 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1647 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1648 const char *prefix, asection *s, bfd_vma value,
1649 bfd_vma size)
1650 {
1651 bfd_boolean micromips_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other);
1652 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1653 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1654 char *name;
1655 bfd_boolean res;
1656
1657 if (micromips_p)
1658 value |= 1;
1659
1660 /* Create a new symbol. */
1661 name = concat (prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL);
1662 bh = NULL;
1663 res = _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1664 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1665 TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
1666 free (name);
1667 if (! res)
1668 return FALSE;
1669
1670 /* Make it a local function. */
1671 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1672 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, STT_FUNC);
1673 elfh->size = size;
1674 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1675 if (micromips_p)
1676 elfh->other = ELF_ST_SET_MICROMIPS (elfh->other);
1677 return TRUE;
1678 }
1679
1680 /* We're about to redefine H. Create a symbol to represent H's
1681 current value and size, to help make the disassembly easier
1682 to read. */
1683
1684 static bfd_boolean
1685 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1686 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
1687 const char *prefix)
1688 {
1689 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
1690 struct elf_link_hash_entry *elfh;
1691 char *name;
1692 asection *s;
1693 bfd_vma value;
1694 bfd_boolean res;
1695
1696 /* Read the symbol's value. */
1697 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1698 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak);
1699 s = h->root.root.u.def.section;
1700 value = h->root.root.u.def.value;
1701
1702 /* Create a new symbol. */
1703 name = concat (prefix, h->root.root.root.string, NULL);
1704 bh = NULL;
1705 res = _bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, s->owner, name,
1706 BSF_LOCAL, s, value, NULL,
1707 TRUE, FALSE, &bh);
1708 free (name);
1709 if (! res)
1710 return FALSE;
1711
1712 /* Make it local and copy the other attributes from H. */
1713 elfh = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
1714 elfh->type = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_LOCAL, ELF_ST_TYPE (h->root.type));
1715 elfh->other = h->root.other;
1716 elfh->size = h->root.size;
1717 elfh->forced_local = 1;
1718 return TRUE;
1719 }
1720
1721 /* Return TRUE if relocations in SECTION can refer directly to a MIPS16
1722 function rather than to a hard-float stub. */
1723
1724 static bfd_boolean
1725 section_allows_mips16_refs_p (asection *section)
1726 {
1727 const char *name;
1728
1729 name = bfd_get_section_name (section->owner, section);
1730 return (FN_STUB_P (name)
1731 || CALL_STUB_P (name)
1732 || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name)
1733 || strcmp (name, ".pdr") == 0);
1734 }
1735
1736 /* [RELOCS, RELEND) are the relocations against SEC, which is a MIPS16
1737 stub section of some kind. Return the R_SYMNDX of the target
1738 function, or 0 if we can't decide which function that is. */
1739
1740 static unsigned long
1741 mips16_stub_symndx (const struct elf_backend_data *bed,
1742 asection *sec ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1743 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
1744 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
1745 {
1746 int int_rels_per_ext_rel = bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
1747 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
1748
1749 /* Trust the first R_MIPS_NONE relocation, if any, but not a subsequent
1750 one in a compound relocation. */
1751 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; rel += int_rels_per_ext_rel)
1752 if (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info) == R_MIPS_NONE)
1753 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, rel->r_info);
1754
1755 /* Otherwise trust the first relocation, whatever its kind. This is
1756 the traditional behavior. */
1757 if (relocs < relend)
1758 return ELF_R_SYM (sec->owner, relocs->r_info);
1759
1760 return 0;
1761 }
1762
1763 /* Check the mips16 stubs for a particular symbol, and see if we can
1764 discard them. */
1765
1766 static void
1767 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1768 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1769 {
1770 /* Dynamic symbols must use the standard call interface, in case other
1771 objects try to call them. */
1772 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1773 && h->root.dynindx != -1)
1774 {
1775 mips_elf_create_shadow_symbol (info, h, ".mips16.");
1776 h->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
1777 }
1778
1779 if (h->fn_stub != NULL
1780 && ! h->need_fn_stub)
1781 {
1782 /* We don't need the fn_stub; the only references to this symbol
1783 are 16 bit calls. Clobber the size to 0 to prevent it from
1784 being included in the link. */
1785 h->fn_stub->size = 0;
1786 h->fn_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1787 h->fn_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1788 h->fn_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1789 h->fn_stub->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1790 }
1791
1792 if (h->call_stub != NULL
1793 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1794 {
1795 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1796 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1797 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1798 h->call_stub->size = 0;
1799 h->call_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1800 h->call_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1801 h->call_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1802 h->call_stub->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1803 }
1804
1805 if (h->call_fp_stub != NULL
1806 && ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other))
1807 {
1808 /* We don't need the call_stub; this is a 16 bit function, so
1809 calls from other 16 bit functions are OK. Clobber the size
1810 to 0 to prevent it from being included in the link. */
1811 h->call_fp_stub->size = 0;
1812 h->call_fp_stub->flags &= ~SEC_RELOC;
1813 h->call_fp_stub->reloc_count = 0;
1814 h->call_fp_stub->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1815 h->call_fp_stub->output_section = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
1816 }
1817 }
1818
1819 /* Hashtable callbacks for mips_elf_la25_stubs. */
1820
1821 static hashval_t
1822 mips_elf_la25_stub_hash (const void *entry_)
1823 {
1824 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry;
1825
1826 entry = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry_;
1827 return entry->h->root.root.u.def.section->id
1828 + entry->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1829 }
1830
1831 static int
1832 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
1833 {
1834 const struct mips_elf_la25_stub *entry1, *entry2;
1835
1836 entry1 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry1_;
1837 entry2 = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) entry2_;
1838 return ((entry1->h->root.root.u.def.section
1839 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.section)
1840 && (entry1->h->root.root.u.def.value
1841 == entry2->h->root.root.u.def.value));
1842 }
1843
1844 /* Called by the linker to set up the la25 stub-creation code. FN is
1845 the linker's implementation of add_stub_function. Return true on
1846 success. */
1847
1848 bfd_boolean
1849 _bfd_mips_elf_init_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1850 asection *(*fn) (const char *, asection *,
1851 asection *))
1852 {
1853 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1854
1855 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1856 if (htab == NULL)
1857 return FALSE;
1858
1859 htab->add_stub_section = fn;
1860 htab->la25_stubs = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_la25_stub_hash,
1861 mips_elf_la25_stub_eq, NULL);
1862 if (htab->la25_stubs == NULL)
1863 return FALSE;
1864
1865 return TRUE;
1866 }
1867
1868 /* Return true if H is a locally-defined PIC function, in the sense
1869 that it or its fn_stub might need $25 to be valid on entry.
1870 Note that MIPS16 functions set up $gp using PC-relative instructions,
1871 so they themselves never need $25 to be valid. Only non-MIPS16
1872 entry points are of interest here. */
1873
1874 static bfd_boolean
1875 mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1876 {
1877 return ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
1878 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
1879 && h->root.def_regular
1880 && !bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section)
1881 && !bfd_is_und_section (h->root.root.u.def.section)
1882 && (!ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other)
1883 || (h->fn_stub && h->need_fn_stub))
1884 && (PIC_OBJECT_P (h->root.root.u.def.section->owner)
1885 || ELF_ST_IS_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other)));
1886 }
1887
1888 /* Set *SEC to the input section that contains the target of STUB.
1889 Return the offset of the target from the start of that section. */
1890
1891 static bfd_vma
1892 mips_elf_get_la25_target (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1893 asection **sec)
1894 {
1895 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (stub->h->root.other))
1896 {
1897 BFD_ASSERT (stub->h->need_fn_stub);
1898 *sec = stub->h->fn_stub;
1899 return 0;
1900 }
1901 else
1902 {
1903 *sec = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1904 return stub->h->root.root.u.def.value;
1905 }
1906 }
1907
1908 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1909 by inserting an LUI/ADDIU pair before the target function.
1910 Create the section and redirect the function symbol to it. */
1911
1912 static bfd_boolean
1913 mips_elf_add_la25_intro (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1914 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1915 {
1916 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1917 char *name;
1918 asection *s, *input_section;
1919 unsigned int align;
1920
1921 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1922 if (htab == NULL)
1923 return FALSE;
1924
1925 /* Create a unique name for the new section. */
1926 name = bfd_malloc (11 + sizeof (".text.stub."));
1927 if (name == NULL)
1928 return FALSE;
1929 sprintf (name, ".text.stub.%d", (int) htab_elements (htab->la25_stubs));
1930
1931 /* Create the section. */
1932 mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &input_section);
1933 s = htab->add_stub_section (name, input_section,
1934 input_section->output_section);
1935 if (s == NULL)
1936 return FALSE;
1937
1938 /* Make sure that any padding goes before the stub. */
1939 align = input_section->alignment_power;
1940 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, align))
1941 return FALSE;
1942 if (align > 3)
1943 s->size = (1 << align) - 8;
1944
1945 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1946 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 8);
1947 stub->stub_section = s;
1948 stub->offset = s->size;
1949
1950 /* Allocate room for it. */
1951 s->size += 8;
1952 return TRUE;
1953 }
1954
1955 /* STUB describes an la25 stub that we have decided to implement
1956 with a separate trampoline. Allocate room for it and redirect
1957 the function symbol to it. */
1958
1959 static bfd_boolean
1960 mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub,
1961 struct bfd_link_info *info)
1962 {
1963 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
1964 asection *s;
1965
1966 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
1967 if (htab == NULL)
1968 return FALSE;
1969
1970 /* Create a trampoline section, if we haven't already. */
1971 s = htab->strampoline;
1972 if (s == NULL)
1973 {
1974 asection *input_section = stub->h->root.root.u.def.section;
1975 s = htab->add_stub_section (".text", NULL,
1976 input_section->output_section);
1977 if (s == NULL || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s->owner, s, 4))
1978 return FALSE;
1979 htab->strampoline = s;
1980 }
1981
1982 /* Create a symbol for the stub. */
1983 mips_elf_create_stub_symbol (info, stub->h, ".pic.", s, s->size, 16);
1984 stub->stub_section = s;
1985 stub->offset = s->size;
1986
1987 /* Allocate room for it. */
1988 s->size += 16;
1989 return TRUE;
1990 }
1991
1992 /* H describes a symbol that needs an la25 stub. Make sure that an
1993 appropriate stub exists and point H at it. */
1994
1995 static bfd_boolean
1996 mips_elf_add_la25_stub (struct bfd_link_info *info,
1997 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
1998 {
1999 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2000 struct mips_elf_la25_stub search, *stub;
2001 bfd_boolean use_trampoline_p;
2002 asection *s;
2003 bfd_vma value;
2004 void **slot;
2005
2006 /* Describe the stub we want. */
2007 search.stub_section = NULL;
2008 search.offset = 0;
2009 search.h = h;
2010
2011 /* See if we've already created an equivalent stub. */
2012 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
2013 if (htab == NULL)
2014 return FALSE;
2015
2016 slot = htab_find_slot (htab->la25_stubs, &search, INSERT);
2017 if (slot == NULL)
2018 return FALSE;
2019
2020 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
2021 if (stub != NULL)
2022 {
2023 /* We can reuse the existing stub. */
2024 h->la25_stub = stub;
2025 return TRUE;
2026 }
2027
2028 /* Create a permanent copy of ENTRY and add it to the hash table. */
2029 stub = bfd_malloc (sizeof (search));
2030 if (stub == NULL)
2031 return FALSE;
2032 *stub = search;
2033 *slot = stub;
2034
2035 /* Prefer to use LUI/ADDIU stubs if the function is at the beginning
2036 of the section and if we would need no more than 2 nops. */
2037 value = mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &s);
2038 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
2039 value &= ~1;
2040 use_trampoline_p = (value != 0 || s->alignment_power > 4);
2041
2042 h->la25_stub = stub;
2043 return (use_trampoline_p
2044 ? mips_elf_add_la25_trampoline (stub, info)
2045 : mips_elf_add_la25_intro (stub, info));
2046 }
2047
2048 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback that is called before sizing
2049 sections. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info structure. */
2050
2051 static bfd_boolean
2052 mips_elf_check_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2053 {
2054 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
2055
2056 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
2057 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (hti->info))
2058 mips_elf_check_mips16_stubs (hti->info, h);
2059
2060 if (mips_elf_local_pic_function_p (h))
2061 {
2062 /* PR 12845: If H is in a section that has been garbage
2063 collected it will have its output section set to *ABS*. */
2064 if (bfd_is_abs_section (h->root.root.u.def.section->output_section))
2065 return TRUE;
2066
2067 /* H is a function that might need $25 to be valid on entry.
2068 If we're creating a non-PIC relocatable object, mark H as
2069 being PIC. If we're creating a non-relocatable object with
2070 non-PIC branches and jumps to H, make sure that H has an la25
2071 stub. */
2072 if (bfd_link_relocatable (hti->info))
2073 {
2074 if (!PIC_OBJECT_P (hti->output_bfd))
2075 h->root.other = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS_PIC (h->root.other);
2076 }
2077 else if (h->has_nonpic_branches && !mips_elf_add_la25_stub (hti->info, h))
2078 {
2079 hti->error = TRUE;
2080 return FALSE;
2081 }
2082 }
2083 return TRUE;
2084 }
2085 \f
2086 /* R_MIPS16_26 is used for the mips16 jal and jalx instructions.
2087 Most mips16 instructions are 16 bits, but these instructions
2088 are 32 bits.
2089
2090 The format of these instructions is:
2091
2092 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2093 | JALX | X| Imm 20:16 | Imm 25:21 |
2094 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2095 | Immediate 15:0 |
2096 +-----------------------------------------------+
2097
2098 JALX is the 5-bit value 00011. X is 0 for jal, 1 for jalx.
2099 Note that the immediate value in the first word is swapped.
2100
2101 When producing a relocatable object file, R_MIPS16_26 is
2102 handled mostly like R_MIPS_26. In particular, the addend is
2103 stored as a straight 26-bit value in a 32-bit instruction.
2104 (gas makes life simpler for itself by never adjusting a
2105 R_MIPS16_26 reloc to be against a section, so the addend is
2106 always zero). However, the 32 bit instruction is stored as 2
2107 16-bit values, rather than a single 32-bit value. In a
2108 big-endian file, the result is the same; in a little-endian
2109 file, the two 16-bit halves of the 32 bit value are swapped.
2110 This is so that a disassembler can recognize the jal
2111 instruction.
2112
2113 When doing a final link, R_MIPS16_26 is treated as a 32 bit
2114 instruction stored as two 16-bit values. The addend A is the
2115 contents of the targ26 field. The calculation is the same as
2116 R_MIPS_26. When storing the calculated value, reorder the
2117 immediate value as shown above, and don't forget to store the
2118 value as two 16-bit values.
2119
2120 To put it in MIPS ABI terms, the relocation field is T-targ26-16,
2121 defined as
2122
2123 big-endian:
2124 +--------+----------------------+
2125 | | |
2126 | | targ26-16 |
2127 |31 26|25 0|
2128 +--------+----------------------+
2129
2130 little-endian:
2131 +----------+------+-------------+
2132 | | | |
2133 | sub1 | | sub2 |
2134 |0 9|10 15|16 31|
2135 +----------+--------------------+
2136 where targ26-16 is sub1 followed by sub2 (i.e., the addend field A is
2137 ((sub1 << 16) | sub2)).
2138
2139 When producing a relocatable object file, the calculation is
2140 (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
2141 When producing a fully linked file, the calculation is
2142 let R = (((A < 2) | ((P + 4) & 0xf0000000) + S) >> 2)
2143 ((R & 0x1f0000) << 5) | ((R & 0x3e00000) >> 5) | (R & 0xffff)
2144
2145 The table below lists the other MIPS16 instruction relocations.
2146 Each one is calculated in the same way as the non-MIPS16 relocation
2147 given on the right, but using the extended MIPS16 layout of 16-bit
2148 immediate fields:
2149
2150 R_MIPS16_GPREL R_MIPS_GPREL16
2151 R_MIPS16_GOT16 R_MIPS_GOT16
2152 R_MIPS16_CALL16 R_MIPS_CALL16
2153 R_MIPS16_HI16 R_MIPS_HI16
2154 R_MIPS16_LO16 R_MIPS_LO16
2155
2156 A typical instruction will have a format like this:
2157
2158 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2159 | EXTEND | Imm 10:5 | Imm 15:11 |
2160 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2161 | Major | rx | ry | Imm 4:0 |
2162 +--------------+--------------------------------+
2163
2164 EXTEND is the five bit value 11110. Major is the instruction
2165 opcode.
2166
2167 All we need to do here is shuffle the bits appropriately.
2168 As above, the two 16-bit halves must be swapped on a
2169 little-endian system.
2170
2171 Finally R_MIPS16_PC16_S1 corresponds to R_MIPS_PC16, however the
2172 relocatable field is shifted by 1 rather than 2 and the same bit
2173 shuffling is done as with the relocations above. */
2174
2175 static inline bfd_boolean
2176 mips16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2177 {
2178 switch (r_type)
2179 {
2180 case R_MIPS16_26:
2181 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
2182 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
2183 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
2184 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
2185 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
2186 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
2187 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
2188 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
2189 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
2190 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
2191 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
2192 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
2193 case R_MIPS16_PC16_S1:
2194 return TRUE;
2195
2196 default:
2197 return FALSE;
2198 }
2199 }
2200
2201 /* Check if a microMIPS reloc. */
2202
2203 static inline bfd_boolean
2204 micromips_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2205 {
2206 return r_type >= R_MICROMIPS_min && r_type < R_MICROMIPS_max;
2207 }
2208
2209 /* Similar to MIPS16, the two 16-bit halves in microMIPS must be swapped
2210 on a little-endian system. This does not apply to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
2211 and R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1 relocs that apply to 16-bit instructions. */
2212
2213 static inline bfd_boolean
2214 micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (unsigned int r_type)
2215 {
2216 return (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
2217 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1
2218 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
2219 }
2220
2221 static inline bfd_boolean
2222 got16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2223 {
2224 return (r_type == R_MIPS_GOT16
2225 || r_type == R_MIPS16_GOT16
2226 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT16);
2227 }
2228
2229 static inline bfd_boolean
2230 call16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2231 {
2232 return (r_type == R_MIPS_CALL16
2233 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16
2234 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL16);
2235 }
2236
2237 static inline bfd_boolean
2238 got_disp_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2239 {
2240 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_DISP || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP;
2241 }
2242
2243 static inline bfd_boolean
2244 got_page_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2245 {
2246 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE;
2247 }
2248
2249 static inline bfd_boolean
2250 got_lo16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2251 {
2252 return r_type == R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16;
2253 }
2254
2255 static inline bfd_boolean
2256 call_hi16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2257 {
2258 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16;
2259 }
2260
2261 static inline bfd_boolean
2262 call_lo16_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2263 {
2264 return r_type == R_MIPS_CALL_LO16 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16;
2265 }
2266
2267 static inline bfd_boolean
2268 hi16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2269 {
2270 return (r_type == R_MIPS_HI16
2271 || r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16
2272 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16
2273 || r_type == R_MIPS_PCHI16);
2274 }
2275
2276 static inline bfd_boolean
2277 lo16_reloc_p (int r_type)
2278 {
2279 return (r_type == R_MIPS_LO16
2280 || r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16
2281 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
2282 || r_type == R_MIPS_PCLO16);
2283 }
2284
2285 static inline bfd_boolean
2286 mips16_call_reloc_p (int r_type)
2287 {
2288 return r_type == R_MIPS16_26 || r_type == R_MIPS16_CALL16;
2289 }
2290
2291 static inline bfd_boolean
2292 jal_reloc_p (int r_type)
2293 {
2294 return (r_type == R_MIPS_26
2295 || r_type == R_MIPS16_26
2296 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1);
2297 }
2298
2299 static inline bfd_boolean
2300 b_reloc_p (int r_type)
2301 {
2302 return (r_type == R_MIPS_PC26_S2
2303 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC21_S2
2304 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC16
2305 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2
2306 || r_type == R_MIPS16_PC16_S1
2307 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
2308 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
2309 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
2310 }
2311
2312 static inline bfd_boolean
2313 aligned_pcrel_reloc_p (int r_type)
2314 {
2315 return (r_type == R_MIPS_PC18_S3
2316 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC19_S2);
2317 }
2318
2319 static inline bfd_boolean
2320 branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2321 {
2322 return (r_type == R_MIPS_26
2323 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC26_S2
2324 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC21_S2
2325 || r_type == R_MIPS_PC16
2326 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2);
2327 }
2328
2329 static inline bfd_boolean
2330 mips16_branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2331 {
2332 return (r_type == R_MIPS16_26
2333 || r_type == R_MIPS16_PC16_S1);
2334 }
2335
2336 static inline bfd_boolean
2337 micromips_branch_reloc_p (int r_type)
2338 {
2339 return (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
2340 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
2341 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1
2342 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
2343 }
2344
2345 static inline bfd_boolean
2346 tls_gd_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2347 {
2348 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GD
2349 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GD
2350 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD);
2351 }
2352
2353 static inline bfd_boolean
2354 tls_ldm_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2355 {
2356 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_LDM
2357 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM
2358 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM);
2359 }
2360
2361 static inline bfd_boolean
2362 tls_gottprel_reloc_p (unsigned int r_type)
2363 {
2364 return (r_type == R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL
2365 || r_type == R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL
2366 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL);
2367 }
2368
2369 void
2370 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
2371 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
2372 {
2373 bfd_vma first, second, val;
2374
2375 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type) && !micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (r_type))
2376 return;
2377
2378 /* Pick up the first and second halfwords of the instruction. */
2379 first = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data);
2380 second = bfd_get_16 (abfd, data + 2);
2381 if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type) || (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
2382 val = first << 16 | second;
2383 else if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26)
2384 val = (((first & 0xf800) << 16) | ((second & 0xffe0) << 11)
2385 | ((first & 0x1f) << 11) | (first & 0x7e0) | (second & 0x1f));
2386 else
2387 val = (((first & 0xfc00) << 16) | ((first & 0x3e0) << 11)
2388 | ((first & 0x1f) << 21) | second);
2389 bfd_put_32 (abfd, val, data);
2390 }
2391
2392 void
2393 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (bfd *abfd, int r_type,
2394 bfd_boolean jal_shuffle, bfd_byte *data)
2395 {
2396 bfd_vma first, second, val;
2397
2398 if (!mips16_reloc_p (r_type) && !micromips_reloc_shuffle_p (r_type))
2399 return;
2400
2401 val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, data);
2402 if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type) || (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !jal_shuffle))
2403 {
2404 second = val & 0xffff;
2405 first = val >> 16;
2406 }
2407 else if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26)
2408 {
2409 second = ((val >> 11) & 0xffe0) | (val & 0x1f);
2410 first = ((val >> 16) & 0xf800) | ((val >> 11) & 0x1f) | (val & 0x7e0);
2411 }
2412 else
2413 {
2414 second = val & 0xffff;
2415 first = ((val >> 16) & 0xfc00) | ((val >> 11) & 0x3e0)
2416 | ((val >> 21) & 0x1f);
2417 }
2418 bfd_put_16 (abfd, second, data + 2);
2419 bfd_put_16 (abfd, first, data);
2420 }
2421
2422 bfd_reloc_status_type
2423 _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (bfd *abfd, asymbol *symbol,
2424 arelent *reloc_entry, asection *input_section,
2425 bfd_boolean relocatable, void *data, bfd_vma gp)
2426 {
2427 bfd_vma relocation;
2428 bfd_signed_vma val;
2429 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2430
2431 if (bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
2432 relocation = 0;
2433 else
2434 relocation = symbol->value;
2435
2436 relocation += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2437 relocation += symbol->section->output_offset;
2438
2439 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2440 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2441
2442 /* Set val to the offset into the section or symbol. */
2443 val = reloc_entry->addend;
2444
2445 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (val, 16);
2446
2447 /* Adjust val for the final section location and GP value. If we
2448 are producing relocatable output, we don't want to do this for
2449 an external symbol. */
2450 if (! relocatable
2451 || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2452 val += relocation - gp;
2453
2454 if (reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2455 {
2456 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2457 (bfd_byte *) data
2458 + reloc_entry->address);
2459 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2460 return status;
2461 }
2462 else
2463 reloc_entry->addend = val;
2464
2465 if (relocatable)
2466 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2467
2468 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2469 }
2470
2471 /* Used to store a REL high-part relocation such as R_MIPS_HI16 or
2472 R_MIPS_GOT16. REL is the relocation, INPUT_SECTION is the section
2473 that contains the relocation field and DATA points to the start of
2474 INPUT_SECTION. */
2475
2476 struct mips_hi16
2477 {
2478 struct mips_hi16 *next;
2479 bfd_byte *data;
2480 asection *input_section;
2481 arelent rel;
2482 };
2483
2484 /* FIXME: This should not be a static variable. */
2485
2486 static struct mips_hi16 *mips_hi16_list;
2487
2488 /* A howto special_function for REL *HI16 relocations. We can only
2489 calculate the correct value once we've seen the partnering
2490 *LO16 relocation, so just save the information for later.
2491
2492 The ABI requires that the *LO16 immediately follow the *HI16.
2493 However, as a GNU extension, we permit an arbitrary number of
2494 *HI16s to be associated with a single *LO16. This significantly
2495 simplies the relocation handling in gcc. */
2496
2497 bfd_reloc_status_type
2498 _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2499 asymbol *symbol ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, void *data,
2500 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2501 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2502 {
2503 struct mips_hi16 *n;
2504
2505 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2506 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2507
2508 n = bfd_malloc (sizeof *n);
2509 if (n == NULL)
2510 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2511
2512 n->next = mips_hi16_list;
2513 n->data = data;
2514 n->input_section = input_section;
2515 n->rel = *reloc_entry;
2516 mips_hi16_list = n;
2517
2518 if (output_bfd != NULL)
2519 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2520
2521 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2522 }
2523
2524 /* A howto special_function for REL R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations. This is just
2525 like any other 16-bit relocation when applied to global symbols, but is
2526 treated in the same as R_MIPS_HI16 when applied to local symbols. */
2527
2528 bfd_reloc_status_type
2529 _bfd_mips_elf_got16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2530 void *data, asection *input_section,
2531 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2532 {
2533 if ((symbol->flags & (BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_WEAK)) != 0
2534 || bfd_is_und_section (bfd_get_section (symbol))
2535 || bfd_is_com_section (bfd_get_section (symbol)))
2536 /* The relocation is against a global symbol. */
2537 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2538 input_section, output_bfd,
2539 error_message);
2540
2541 return _bfd_mips_elf_hi16_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2542 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
2543 }
2544
2545 /* A howto special_function for REL *LO16 relocations. The *LO16 itself
2546 is a straightforward 16 bit inplace relocation, but we must deal with
2547 any partnering high-part relocations as well. */
2548
2549 bfd_reloc_status_type
2550 _bfd_mips_elf_lo16_reloc (bfd *abfd, arelent *reloc_entry, asymbol *symbol,
2551 void *data, asection *input_section,
2552 bfd *output_bfd, char **error_message)
2553 {
2554 bfd_vma vallo;
2555 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2556
2557 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2558 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2559
2560 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2561 location);
2562 vallo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, location);
2563 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2564 location);
2565
2566 while (mips_hi16_list != NULL)
2567 {
2568 bfd_reloc_status_type ret;
2569 struct mips_hi16 *hi;
2570
2571 hi = mips_hi16_list;
2572
2573 /* R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocations are something of a special case. We
2574 want to install the addend in the same way as for a R_MIPS*_HI16
2575 relocation (with a rightshift of 16). However, since GOT16
2576 relocations can also be used with global symbols, their howto
2577 has a rightshift of 0. */
2578 if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS_GOT16)
2579 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2580 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MIPS16_GOT16)
2581 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MIPS16_HI16, FALSE);
2582 else if (hi->rel.howto->type == R_MICROMIPS_GOT16)
2583 hi->rel.howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, R_MICROMIPS_HI16, FALSE);
2584
2585 /* VALLO is a signed 16-bit number. Bias it by 0x8000 so that any
2586 carry or borrow will induce a change of +1 or -1 in the high part. */
2587 hi->rel.addend += (vallo + 0x8000) & 0xffff;
2588
2589 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, &hi->rel, symbol, hi->data,
2590 hi->input_section, output_bfd,
2591 error_message);
2592 if (ret != bfd_reloc_ok)
2593 return ret;
2594
2595 mips_hi16_list = hi->next;
2596 free (hi);
2597 }
2598
2599 return _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
2600 input_section, output_bfd,
2601 error_message);
2602 }
2603
2604 /* A generic howto special_function. This calculates and installs the
2605 relocation itself, thus avoiding the oft-discussed problems in
2606 bfd_perform_relocation and bfd_install_relocation. */
2607
2608 bfd_reloc_status_type
2609 _bfd_mips_elf_generic_reloc (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, arelent *reloc_entry,
2610 asymbol *symbol, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2611 asection *input_section, bfd *output_bfd,
2612 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2613 {
2614 bfd_signed_vma val;
2615 bfd_reloc_status_type status;
2616 bfd_boolean relocatable;
2617
2618 relocatable = (output_bfd != NULL);
2619
2620 if (reloc_entry->address > bfd_get_section_limit (abfd, input_section))
2621 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
2622
2623 /* Build up the field adjustment in VAL. */
2624 val = 0;
2625 if (!relocatable || (symbol->flags & BSF_SECTION_SYM) != 0)
2626 {
2627 /* Either we're calculating the final field value or we have a
2628 relocation against a section symbol. Add in the section's
2629 offset or address. */
2630 val += symbol->section->output_section->vma;
2631 val += symbol->section->output_offset;
2632 }
2633
2634 if (!relocatable)
2635 {
2636 /* We're calculating the final field value. Add in the symbol's value
2637 and, if pc-relative, subtract the address of the field itself. */
2638 val += symbol->value;
2639 if (reloc_entry->howto->pc_relative)
2640 {
2641 val -= input_section->output_section->vma;
2642 val -= input_section->output_offset;
2643 val -= reloc_entry->address;
2644 }
2645 }
2646
2647 /* VAL is now the final adjustment. If we're keeping this relocation
2648 in the output file, and if the relocation uses a separate addend,
2649 we just need to add VAL to that addend. Otherwise we need to add
2650 VAL to the relocation field itself. */
2651 if (relocatable && !reloc_entry->howto->partial_inplace)
2652 reloc_entry->addend += val;
2653 else
2654 {
2655 bfd_byte *location = (bfd_byte *) data + reloc_entry->address;
2656
2657 /* Add in the separate addend, if any. */
2658 val += reloc_entry->addend;
2659
2660 /* Add VAL to the relocation field. */
2661 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2662 location);
2663 status = _bfd_relocate_contents (reloc_entry->howto, abfd, val,
2664 location);
2665 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, reloc_entry->howto->type, FALSE,
2666 location);
2667
2668 if (status != bfd_reloc_ok)
2669 return status;
2670 }
2671
2672 if (relocatable)
2673 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
2674
2675 return bfd_reloc_ok;
2676 }
2677 \f
2678 /* Swap an entry in a .gptab section. Note that these routines rely
2679 on the equivalence of the two elements of the union. */
2680
2681 static void
2682 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_gptab *ex,
2683 Elf32_gptab *in)
2684 {
2685 in->gt_entry.gt_g_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2686 in->gt_entry.gt_bytes = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2687 }
2688
2689 static void
2690 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_gptab *in,
2691 Elf32_External_gptab *ex)
2692 {
2693 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_g_value, ex->gt_entry.gt_g_value);
2694 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->gt_entry.gt_bytes, ex->gt_entry.gt_bytes);
2695 }
2696
2697 static void
2698 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_compact_rel *in,
2699 Elf32_External_compact_rel *ex)
2700 {
2701 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id1, ex->id1);
2702 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->num, ex->num);
2703 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->id2, ex->id2);
2704 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->offset, ex->offset);
2705 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved0, ex->reserved0);
2706 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->reserved1, ex->reserved1);
2707 }
2708
2709 static void
2710 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_crinfo *in,
2711 Elf32_External_crinfo *ex)
2712 {
2713 unsigned long l;
2714
2715 l = (((in->ctype & CRINFO_CTYPE) << CRINFO_CTYPE_SH)
2716 | ((in->rtype & CRINFO_RTYPE) << CRINFO_RTYPE_SH)
2717 | ((in->dist2to & CRINFO_DIST2TO) << CRINFO_DIST2TO_SH)
2718 | ((in->relvaddr & CRINFO_RELVADDR) << CRINFO_RELVADDR_SH));
2719 H_PUT_32 (abfd, l, ex->info);
2720 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->konst, ex->konst);
2721 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->vaddr, ex->vaddr);
2722 }
2723 \f
2724 /* A .reginfo section holds a single Elf32_RegInfo structure. These
2725 routines swap this structure in and out. They are used outside of
2726 BFD, so they are globally visible. */
2727
2728 void
2729 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex,
2730 Elf32_RegInfo *in)
2731 {
2732 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2733 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2734 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2735 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2736 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2737 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2738 }
2739
2740 void
2741 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf32_RegInfo *in,
2742 Elf32_External_RegInfo *ex)
2743 {
2744 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2745 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2746 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2747 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2748 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2749 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2750 }
2751
2752 /* In the 64 bit ABI, the .MIPS.options section holds register
2753 information in an Elf64_Reginfo structure. These routines swap
2754 them in and out. They are globally visible because they are used
2755 outside of BFD. These routines are here so that gas can call them
2756 without worrying about whether the 64 bit ABI has been included. */
2757
2758 void
2759 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex,
2760 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in)
2761 {
2762 in->ri_gprmask = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_gprmask);
2763 in->ri_pad = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_pad);
2764 in->ri_cprmask[0] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2765 in->ri_cprmask[1] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2766 in->ri_cprmask[2] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2767 in->ri_cprmask[3] = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2768 in->ri_gp_value = H_GET_64 (abfd, ex->ri_gp_value);
2769 }
2770
2771 void
2772 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf64_Internal_RegInfo *in,
2773 Elf64_External_RegInfo *ex)
2774 {
2775 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_gprmask, ex->ri_gprmask);
2776 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_pad, ex->ri_pad);
2777 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[0], ex->ri_cprmask[0]);
2778 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[1], ex->ri_cprmask[1]);
2779 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[2], ex->ri_cprmask[2]);
2780 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ri_cprmask[3], ex->ri_cprmask[3]);
2781 H_PUT_64 (abfd, in->ri_gp_value, ex->ri_gp_value);
2782 }
2783
2784 /* Swap in an options header. */
2785
2786 void
2787 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (bfd *abfd, const Elf_External_Options *ex,
2788 Elf_Internal_Options *in)
2789 {
2790 in->kind = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->kind);
2791 in->size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->size);
2792 in->section = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->section);
2793 in->info = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->info);
2794 }
2795
2796 /* Swap out an options header. */
2797
2798 void
2799 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_out (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Options *in,
2800 Elf_External_Options *ex)
2801 {
2802 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->kind, ex->kind);
2803 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->size, ex->size);
2804 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->section, ex->section);
2805 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->info, ex->info);
2806 }
2807
2808 /* Swap in an abiflags structure. */
2809
2810 void
2811 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_in (bfd *abfd,
2812 const Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 *ex,
2813 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *in)
2814 {
2815 in->version = H_GET_16 (abfd, ex->version);
2816 in->isa_level = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->isa_level);
2817 in->isa_rev = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->isa_rev);
2818 in->gpr_size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->gpr_size);
2819 in->cpr1_size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->cpr1_size);
2820 in->cpr2_size = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->cpr2_size);
2821 in->fp_abi = H_GET_8 (abfd, ex->fp_abi);
2822 in->isa_ext = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->isa_ext);
2823 in->ases = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->ases);
2824 in->flags1 = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->flags1);
2825 in->flags2 = H_GET_32 (abfd, ex->flags2);
2826 }
2827
2828 /* Swap out an abiflags structure. */
2829
2830 void
2831 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_out (bfd *abfd,
2832 const Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *in,
2833 Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 *ex)
2834 {
2835 H_PUT_16 (abfd, in->version, ex->version);
2836 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->isa_level, ex->isa_level);
2837 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->isa_rev, ex->isa_rev);
2838 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->gpr_size, ex->gpr_size);
2839 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->cpr1_size, ex->cpr1_size);
2840 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->cpr2_size, ex->cpr2_size);
2841 H_PUT_8 (abfd, in->fp_abi, ex->fp_abi);
2842 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->isa_ext, ex->isa_ext);
2843 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->ases, ex->ases);
2844 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->flags1, ex->flags1);
2845 H_PUT_32 (abfd, in->flags2, ex->flags2);
2846 }
2847 \f
2848 /* This function is called via qsort() to sort the dynamic relocation
2849 entries by increasing r_symndx value. */
2850
2851 static int
2852 sort_dynamic_relocs (const void *arg1, const void *arg2)
2853 {
2854 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1;
2855 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2;
2856 int diff;
2857
2858 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, &int_reloc1);
2859 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, &int_reloc2);
2860
2861 diff = ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc1.r_info) - ELF32_R_SYM (int_reloc2.r_info);
2862 if (diff != 0)
2863 return diff;
2864
2865 if (int_reloc1.r_offset < int_reloc2.r_offset)
2866 return -1;
2867 if (int_reloc1.r_offset > int_reloc2.r_offset)
2868 return 1;
2869 return 0;
2870 }
2871
2872 /* Like sort_dynamic_relocs, but used for elf64 relocations. */
2873
2874 static int
2875 sort_dynamic_relocs_64 (const void *arg1 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2876 const void *arg2 ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2877 {
2878 #ifdef BFD64
2879 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc1[3];
2880 Elf_Internal_Rela int_reloc2[3];
2881
2882 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2883 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg1, int_reloc1);
2884 (*get_elf_backend_data (reldyn_sorting_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_in)
2885 (reldyn_sorting_bfd, arg2, int_reloc2);
2886
2887 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) < ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2888 return -1;
2889 if (ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc1[0].r_info) > ELF64_R_SYM (int_reloc2[0].r_info))
2890 return 1;
2891
2892 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset < int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2893 return -1;
2894 if (int_reloc1[0].r_offset > int_reloc2[0].r_offset)
2895 return 1;
2896 return 0;
2897 #else
2898 abort ();
2899 #endif
2900 }
2901
2902
2903 /* This routine is used to write out ECOFF debugging external symbol
2904 information. It is called via mips_elf_link_hash_traverse. The
2905 ECOFF external symbol information must match the ELF external
2906 symbol information. Unfortunately, at this point we don't know
2907 whether a symbol is required by reloc information, so the two
2908 tables may wind up being different. We must sort out the external
2909 symbol information before we can set the final size of the .mdebug
2910 section, and we must set the size of the .mdebug section before we
2911 can relocate any sections, and we can't know which symbols are
2912 required by relocation until we relocate the sections.
2913 Fortunately, it is relatively unlikely that any symbol will be
2914 stripped but required by a reloc. In particular, it can not happen
2915 when generating a final executable. */
2916
2917 static bfd_boolean
2918 mips_elf_output_extsym (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
2919 {
2920 struct extsym_info *einfo = data;
2921 bfd_boolean strip;
2922 asection *sec, *output_section;
2923
2924 if (h->root.indx == -2)
2925 strip = FALSE;
2926 else if ((h->root.def_dynamic
2927 || h->root.ref_dynamic
2928 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
2929 && !h->root.def_regular
2930 && !h->root.ref_regular)
2931 strip = TRUE;
2932 else if (einfo->info->strip == strip_all
2933 || (einfo->info->strip == strip_some
2934 && bfd_hash_lookup (einfo->info->keep_hash,
2935 h->root.root.root.string,
2936 FALSE, FALSE) == NULL))
2937 strip = TRUE;
2938 else
2939 strip = FALSE;
2940
2941 if (strip)
2942 return TRUE;
2943
2944 if (h->esym.ifd == -2)
2945 {
2946 h->esym.jmptbl = 0;
2947 h->esym.cobol_main = 0;
2948 h->esym.weakext = 0;
2949 h->esym.reserved = 0;
2950 h->esym.ifd = ifdNil;
2951 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2952 h->esym.asym.st = stGlobal;
2953
2954 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
2955 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
2956 {
2957 const char *name;
2958
2959 /* Use undefined class. Also, set class and type for some
2960 special symbols. */
2961 name = h->root.root.root.string;
2962 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
2963 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
2964 {
2965 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
2966 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2967 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
2968 }
2969 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
2970 {
2971 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2972 h->esym.asym.st = stLabel;
2973 h->esym.asym.value =
2974 mips_elf_hash_table (einfo->info)->procedure_count;
2975 }
2976 else
2977 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2978 }
2979 else if (h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
2980 && h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
2981 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
2982 else
2983 {
2984 const char *name;
2985
2986 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
2987 output_section = sec->output_section;
2988
2989 /* When making a shared library and symbol h is the one from
2990 the another shared library, OUTPUT_SECTION may be null. */
2991 if (output_section == NULL)
2992 h->esym.asym.sc = scUndefined;
2993 else
2994 {
2995 name = bfd_section_name (output_section->owner, output_section);
2996
2997 if (strcmp (name, ".text") == 0)
2998 h->esym.asym.sc = scText;
2999 else if (strcmp (name, ".data") == 0)
3000 h->esym.asym.sc = scData;
3001 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0)
3002 h->esym.asym.sc = scSData;
3003 else if (strcmp (name, ".rodata") == 0
3004 || strcmp (name, ".rdata") == 0)
3005 h->esym.asym.sc = scRData;
3006 else if (strcmp (name, ".bss") == 0)
3007 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
3008 else if (strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
3009 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
3010 else if (strcmp (name, ".init") == 0)
3011 h->esym.asym.sc = scInit;
3012 else if (strcmp (name, ".fini") == 0)
3013 h->esym.asym.sc = scFini;
3014 else
3015 h->esym.asym.sc = scAbs;
3016 }
3017 }
3018
3019 h->esym.asym.reserved = 0;
3020 h->esym.asym.index = indexNil;
3021 }
3022
3023 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_common)
3024 h->esym.asym.value = h->root.root.u.c.size;
3025 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3026 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3027 {
3028 if (h->esym.asym.sc == scCommon)
3029 h->esym.asym.sc = scBss;
3030 else if (h->esym.asym.sc == scSCommon)
3031 h->esym.asym.sc = scSBss;
3032
3033 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
3034 output_section = sec->output_section;
3035 if (output_section != NULL)
3036 h->esym.asym.value = (h->root.root.u.def.value
3037 + sec->output_offset
3038 + output_section->vma);
3039 else
3040 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
3041 }
3042 else
3043 {
3044 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hd = h;
3045
3046 while (hd->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
3047 hd = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)h->root.root.u.i.link;
3048
3049 if (hd->needs_lazy_stub)
3050 {
3051 BFD_ASSERT (hd->root.plt.plist != NULL);
3052 BFD_ASSERT (hd->root.plt.plist->stub_offset != MINUS_ONE);
3053 /* Set type and value for a symbol with a function stub. */
3054 h->esym.asym.st = stProc;
3055 sec = hd->root.root.u.def.section;
3056 if (sec == NULL)
3057 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
3058 else
3059 {
3060 output_section = sec->output_section;
3061 if (output_section != NULL)
3062 h->esym.asym.value = (hd->root.plt.plist->stub_offset
3063 + sec->output_offset
3064 + output_section->vma);
3065 else
3066 h->esym.asym.value = 0;
3067 }
3068 }
3069 }
3070
3071 if (! bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (einfo->abfd, einfo->debug, einfo->swap,
3072 h->root.root.root.string,
3073 &h->esym))
3074 {
3075 einfo->failed = TRUE;
3076 return FALSE;
3077 }
3078
3079 return TRUE;
3080 }
3081
3082 /* A comparison routine used to sort .gptab entries. */
3083
3084 static int
3085 gptab_compare (const void *p1, const void *p2)
3086 {
3087 const Elf32_gptab *a1 = p1;
3088 const Elf32_gptab *a2 = p2;
3089
3090 return a1->gt_entry.gt_g_value - a2->gt_entry.gt_g_value;
3091 }
3092 \f
3093 /* Functions to manage the got entry hash table. */
3094
3095 /* Use all 64 bits of a bfd_vma for the computation of a 32-bit
3096 hash number. */
3097
3098 static INLINE hashval_t
3099 mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (bfd_vma addr)
3100 {
3101 #ifdef BFD64
3102 return addr + (addr >> 32);
3103 #else
3104 return addr;
3105 #endif
3106 }
3107
3108 static hashval_t
3109 mips_elf_got_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
3110 {
3111 const struct mips_got_entry *entry = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry_;
3112
3113 return (entry->symndx
3114 + ((entry->tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM) << 18)
3115 + (entry->tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM ? 0
3116 : !entry->abfd ? mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.address)
3117 : entry->symndx >= 0 ? (entry->abfd->id
3118 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (entry->d.addend))
3119 : entry->d.h->root.root.root.hash));
3120 }
3121
3122 static int
3123 mips_elf_got_entry_eq (const void *entry1, const void *entry2)
3124 {
3125 const struct mips_got_entry *e1 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry1;
3126 const struct mips_got_entry *e2 = (struct mips_got_entry *)entry2;
3127
3128 return (e1->symndx == e2->symndx
3129 && e1->tls_type == e2->tls_type
3130 && (e1->tls_type == GOT_TLS_LDM ? TRUE
3131 : !e1->abfd ? !e2->abfd && e1->d.address == e2->d.address
3132 : e1->symndx >= 0 ? (e1->abfd == e2->abfd
3133 && e1->d.addend == e2->d.addend)
3134 : e2->abfd && e1->d.h == e2->d.h));
3135 }
3136
3137 static hashval_t
3138 mips_got_page_ref_hash (const void *ref_)
3139 {
3140 const struct mips_got_page_ref *ref;
3141
3142 ref = (const struct mips_got_page_ref *) ref_;
3143 return ((ref->symndx >= 0
3144 ? (hashval_t) (ref->u.abfd->id + ref->symndx)
3145 : ref->u.h->root.root.root.hash)
3146 + mips_elf_hash_bfd_vma (ref->addend));
3147 }
3148
3149 static int
3150 mips_got_page_ref_eq (const void *ref1_, const void *ref2_)
3151 {
3152 const struct mips_got_page_ref *ref1, *ref2;
3153
3154 ref1 = (const struct mips_got_page_ref *) ref1_;
3155 ref2 = (const struct mips_got_page_ref *) ref2_;
3156 return (ref1->symndx == ref2->symndx
3157 && (ref1->symndx < 0
3158 ? ref1->u.h == ref2->u.h
3159 : ref1->u.abfd == ref2->u.abfd)
3160 && ref1->addend == ref2->addend);
3161 }
3162
3163 static hashval_t
3164 mips_got_page_entry_hash (const void *entry_)
3165 {
3166 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
3167
3168 entry = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry_;
3169 return entry->sec->id;
3170 }
3171
3172 static int
3173 mips_got_page_entry_eq (const void *entry1_, const void *entry2_)
3174 {
3175 const struct mips_got_page_entry *entry1, *entry2;
3176
3177 entry1 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry1_;
3178 entry2 = (const struct mips_got_page_entry *) entry2_;
3179 return entry1->sec == entry2->sec;
3180 }
3181 \f
3182 /* Create and return a new mips_got_info structure. */
3183
3184 static struct mips_got_info *
3185 mips_elf_create_got_info (bfd *abfd)
3186 {
3187 struct mips_got_info *g;
3188
3189 g = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct mips_got_info));
3190 if (g == NULL)
3191 return NULL;
3192
3193 g->got_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
3194 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
3195 if (g->got_entries == NULL)
3196 return NULL;
3197
3198 g->got_page_refs = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_ref_hash,
3199 mips_got_page_ref_eq, NULL);
3200 if (g->got_page_refs == NULL)
3201 return NULL;
3202
3203 return g;
3204 }
3205
3206 /* Return the GOT info for input bfd ABFD, trying to create a new one if
3207 CREATE_P and if ABFD doesn't already have a GOT. */
3208
3209 static struct mips_got_info *
3210 mips_elf_bfd_got (bfd *abfd, bfd_boolean create_p)
3211 {
3212 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *tdata;
3213
3214 if (!is_mips_elf (abfd))
3215 return NULL;
3216
3217 tdata = mips_elf_tdata (abfd);
3218 if (!tdata->got && create_p)
3219 tdata->got = mips_elf_create_got_info (abfd);
3220 return tdata->got;
3221 }
3222
3223 /* Record that ABFD should use output GOT G. */
3224
3225 static void
3226 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g)
3227 {
3228 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *tdata;
3229
3230 BFD_ASSERT (is_mips_elf (abfd));
3231 tdata = mips_elf_tdata (abfd);
3232 if (tdata->got)
3233 {
3234 /* The GOT structure itself and the hash table entries are
3235 allocated to a bfd, but the hash tables aren't. */
3236 htab_delete (tdata->got->got_entries);
3237 htab_delete (tdata->got->got_page_refs);
3238 if (tdata->got->got_page_entries)
3239 htab_delete (tdata->got->got_page_entries);
3240 }
3241 tdata->got = g;
3242 }
3243
3244 /* Return the dynamic relocation section. If it doesn't exist, try to
3245 create a new it if CREATE_P, otherwise return NULL. Also return NULL
3246 if creation fails. */
3247
3248 static asection *
3249 mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean create_p)
3250 {
3251 const char *dname;
3252 asection *sreloc;
3253 bfd *dynobj;
3254
3255 dname = MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info);
3256 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
3257 sreloc = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, dname);
3258 if (sreloc == NULL && create_p)
3259 {
3260 sreloc = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (dynobj, dname,
3261 (SEC_ALLOC
3262 | SEC_LOAD
3263 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
3264 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
3265 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
3266 | SEC_READONLY));
3267 if (sreloc == NULL
3268 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, sreloc,
3269 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
3270 return NULL;
3271 }
3272 return sreloc;
3273 }
3274
3275 /* Return the GOT_TLS_* type required by relocation type R_TYPE. */
3276
3277 static int
3278 mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (unsigned int r_type)
3279 {
3280 if (tls_gd_reloc_p (r_type))
3281 return GOT_TLS_GD;
3282
3283 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
3284 return GOT_TLS_LDM;
3285
3286 if (tls_gottprel_reloc_p (r_type))
3287 return GOT_TLS_IE;
3288
3289 return GOT_TLS_NONE;
3290 }
3291
3292 /* Return the number of GOT slots needed for GOT TLS type TYPE. */
3293
3294 static int
3295 mips_tls_got_entries (unsigned int type)
3296 {
3297 switch (type)
3298 {
3299 case GOT_TLS_GD:
3300 case GOT_TLS_LDM:
3301 return 2;
3302
3303 case GOT_TLS_IE:
3304 return 1;
3305
3306 case GOT_TLS_NONE:
3307 return 0;
3308 }
3309 abort ();
3310 }
3311
3312 /* Count the number of relocations needed for a TLS GOT entry, with
3313 access types from TLS_TYPE, and symbol H (or a local symbol if H
3314 is NULL). */
3315
3316 static int
3317 mips_tls_got_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info, unsigned char tls_type,
3318 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3319 {
3320 int indx = 0;
3321 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
3322 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
3323
3324 if (h != NULL
3325 && h->dynindx != -1
3326 && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, bfd_link_pic (info), h)
3327 && (bfd_link_dll (info) || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)))
3328 indx = h->dynindx;
3329
3330 if ((bfd_link_dll (info) || indx != 0)
3331 && (h == NULL
3332 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT
3333 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
3334 need_relocs = TRUE;
3335
3336 if (!need_relocs)
3337 return 0;
3338
3339 switch (tls_type)
3340 {
3341 case GOT_TLS_GD:
3342 return indx != 0 ? 2 : 1;
3343
3344 case GOT_TLS_IE:
3345 return 1;
3346
3347 case GOT_TLS_LDM:
3348 return bfd_link_dll (info) ? 1 : 0;
3349
3350 default:
3351 return 0;
3352 }
3353 }
3354
3355 /* Add the number of GOT entries and TLS relocations required by ENTRY
3356 to G. */
3357
3358 static void
3359 mips_elf_count_got_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3360 struct mips_got_info *g,
3361 struct mips_got_entry *entry)
3362 {
3363 if (entry->tls_type)
3364 {
3365 g->tls_gotno += mips_tls_got_entries (entry->tls_type);
3366 g->relocs += mips_tls_got_relocs (info, entry->tls_type,
3367 entry->symndx < 0
3368 ? &entry->d.h->root : NULL);
3369 }
3370 else if (entry->symndx >= 0 || entry->d.h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE)
3371 g->local_gotno += 1;
3372 else
3373 g->global_gotno += 1;
3374 }
3375
3376 /* Output a simple dynamic relocation into SRELOC. */
3377
3378 static void
3379 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
3380 asection *sreloc,
3381 unsigned long reloc_index,
3382 unsigned long indx,
3383 int r_type,
3384 bfd_vma offset)
3385 {
3386 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
3387
3388 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
3389
3390 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, indx, r_type);
3391 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
3392
3393 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
3394 {
3395 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
3396 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
3397 (sreloc->contents
3398 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
3399 }
3400 else
3401 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
3402 (output_bfd, &rel[0],
3403 (sreloc->contents
3404 + reloc_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
3405 }
3406
3407 /* Initialize a set of TLS GOT entries for one symbol. */
3408
3409 static void
3410 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3411 struct mips_got_entry *entry,
3412 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3413 bfd_vma value)
3414 {
3415 bfd_boolean dyn = elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created;
3416 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3417 int indx;
3418 asection *sreloc, *sgot;
3419 bfd_vma got_offset, got_offset2;
3420 bfd_boolean need_relocs = FALSE;
3421
3422 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3423 if (htab == NULL)
3424 return;
3425
3426 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
3427
3428 indx = 0;
3429 if (h != NULL
3430 && h->root.dynindx != -1
3431 && WILL_CALL_FINISH_DYNAMIC_SYMBOL (dyn, bfd_link_pic (info), &h->root)
3432 && (bfd_link_dll (info) || !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root)))
3433 indx = h->root.dynindx;
3434
3435 if (entry->tls_initialized)
3436 return;
3437
3438 if ((bfd_link_dll (info) || indx != 0)
3439 && (h == NULL
3440 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
3441 || h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
3442 need_relocs = TRUE;
3443
3444 /* MINUS_ONE means the symbol is not defined in this object. It may not
3445 be defined at all; assume that the value doesn't matter in that
3446 case. Otherwise complain if we would use the value. */
3447 BFD_ASSERT (value != MINUS_ONE || (indx != 0 && need_relocs)
3448 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak);
3449
3450 /* Emit necessary relocations. */
3451 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3452 got_offset = entry->gotidx;
3453
3454 switch (entry->tls_type)
3455 {
3456 case GOT_TLS_GD:
3457 /* General Dynamic. */
3458 got_offset2 = got_offset + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
3459
3460 if (need_relocs)
3461 {
3462 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3463 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3464 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
3465 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3466
3467 if (indx)
3468 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3469 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3470 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32,
3471 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset2);
3472 else
3473 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
3474 sgot->contents + got_offset2);
3475 }
3476 else
3477 {
3478 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
3479 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3480 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - dtprel_base (info),
3481 sgot->contents + got_offset2);
3482 }
3483 break;
3484
3485 case GOT_TLS_IE:
3486 /* Initial Exec model. */
3487 if (need_relocs)
3488 {
3489 if (indx == 0)
3490 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - elf_hash_table (info)->tls_sec->vma,
3491 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3492 else
3493 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
3494 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3495
3496 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3497 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3498 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64 : R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32,
3499 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3500 }
3501 else
3502 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value - tprel_base (info),
3503 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3504 break;
3505
3506 case GOT_TLS_LDM:
3507 /* The initial offset is zero, and the LD offsets will include the
3508 bias by DTP_OFFSET. */
3509 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 0,
3510 sgot->contents + got_offset
3511 + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd));
3512
3513 if (!bfd_link_dll (info))
3514 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, 1,
3515 sgot->contents + got_offset);
3516 else
3517 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation
3518 (abfd, sreloc, sreloc->reloc_count++, indx,
3519 ABI_64_P (abfd) ? R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD64 : R_MIPS_TLS_DTPMOD32,
3520 sgot->output_offset + sgot->output_section->vma + got_offset);
3521 break;
3522
3523 default:
3524 abort ();
3525 }
3526
3527 entry->tls_initialized = TRUE;
3528 }
3529
3530 /* Return the offset from _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ of the .got.plt entry
3531 for global symbol H. .got.plt comes before the GOT, so the offset
3532 will be negative. */
3533
3534 static bfd_vma
3535 mips_elf_gotplt_index (struct bfd_link_info *info,
3536 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3537 {
3538 bfd_vma got_address, got_value;
3539 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3540
3541 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3542 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3543
3544 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.plist != NULL);
3545 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.plist->gotplt_index != MINUS_ONE);
3546
3547 /* Calculate the address of the associated .got.plt entry. */
3548 got_address = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
3549 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset
3550 + (h->plt.plist->gotplt_index
3551 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (info->output_bfd)));
3552
3553 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
3554 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
3555 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3556 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
3557
3558 return got_address - got_value;
3559 }
3560
3561 /* Return the GOT offset for address VALUE. If there is not yet a GOT
3562 entry for this value, create one. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol,
3563 create a TLS GOT entry instead. Return -1 if no satisfactory GOT
3564 offset can be found. */
3565
3566 static bfd_vma
3567 mips_elf_local_got_index (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3568 bfd_vma value, unsigned long r_symndx,
3569 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
3570 {
3571 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3572 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3573
3574 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3575 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3576
3577 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value,
3578 r_symndx, h, r_type);
3579 if (!entry)
3580 return MINUS_ONE;
3581
3582 if (entry->tls_type)
3583 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (abfd, info, entry, h, value);
3584 return entry->gotidx;
3585 }
3586
3587 /* Return the GOT index of global symbol H in the primary GOT. */
3588
3589 static bfd_vma
3590 mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3591 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
3592 {
3593 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3594 long global_got_dynindx;
3595 struct mips_got_info *g;
3596 bfd_vma got_index;
3597
3598 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3599 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3600
3601 global_got_dynindx = 0;
3602 if (htab->global_gotsym != NULL)
3603 global_got_dynindx = htab->global_gotsym->dynindx;
3604
3605 /* Once we determine the global GOT entry with the lowest dynamic
3606 symbol table index, we must put all dynamic symbols with greater
3607 indices into the primary GOT. That makes it easy to calculate the
3608 GOT offset. */
3609 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx >= global_got_dynindx);
3610 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (obfd, FALSE);
3611 got_index = ((h->dynindx - global_got_dynindx + g->local_gotno)
3612 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (obfd));
3613 BFD_ASSERT (got_index < htab->root.sgot->size);
3614
3615 return got_index;
3616 }
3617
3618 /* Return the GOT index for the global symbol indicated by H, which is
3619 referenced by a relocation of type R_TYPE in IBFD. */
3620
3621 static bfd_vma
3622 mips_elf_global_got_index (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *ibfd,
3623 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, int r_type)
3624 {
3625 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3626 struct mips_got_info *g;
3627 struct mips_got_entry lookup, *entry;
3628 bfd_vma gotidx;
3629
3630 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3631 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3632
3633 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
3634 BFD_ASSERT (g);
3635
3636 lookup.tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
3637 if (!lookup.tls_type && g == mips_elf_bfd_got (obfd, FALSE))
3638 return mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (obfd, info, h);
3639
3640 lookup.abfd = ibfd;
3641 lookup.symndx = -1;
3642 lookup.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3643 entry = htab_find (g->got_entries, &lookup);
3644 BFD_ASSERT (entry);
3645
3646 gotidx = entry->gotidx;
3647 BFD_ASSERT (gotidx > 0 && gotidx < htab->root.sgot->size);
3648
3649 if (lookup.tls_type)
3650 {
3651 bfd_vma value = MINUS_ONE;
3652
3653 if ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
3654 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
3655 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section)
3656 value = (h->root.u.def.value
3657 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
3658 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma);
3659
3660 mips_elf_initialize_tls_slots (obfd, info, entry, lookup.d.h, value);
3661 }
3662 return gotidx;
3663 }
3664
3665 /* Find a GOT page entry that points to within 32KB of VALUE. These
3666 entries are supposed to be placed at small offsets in the GOT, i.e.,
3667 within 32KB of GP. Return the index of the GOT entry, or -1 if no
3668 entry could be created. If OFFSETP is nonnull, use it to return the
3669 offset of the GOT entry from VALUE. */
3670
3671 static bfd_vma
3672 mips_elf_got_page (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3673 bfd_vma value, bfd_vma *offsetp)
3674 {
3675 bfd_vma page, got_index;
3676 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3677
3678 page = (value + 0x8000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
3679 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, page, 0,
3680 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE);
3681
3682 if (!entry)
3683 return MINUS_ONE;
3684
3685 got_index = entry->gotidx;
3686
3687 if (offsetp)
3688 *offsetp = value - entry->d.address;
3689
3690 return got_index;
3691 }
3692
3693 /* Find a local GOT entry for an R_MIPS*_GOT16 relocation against VALUE.
3694 EXTERNAL is true if the relocation was originally against a global
3695 symbol that binds locally. */
3696
3697 static bfd_vma
3698 mips_elf_got16_entry (bfd *abfd, bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3699 bfd_vma value, bfd_boolean external)
3700 {
3701 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
3702
3703 /* GOT16 relocations against local symbols are followed by a LO16
3704 relocation; those against global symbols are not. Thus if the
3705 symbol was originally local, the GOT16 relocation should load the
3706 equivalent of %hi(VALUE), otherwise it should load VALUE itself. */
3707 if (! external)
3708 value = mips_elf_high (value) << 16;
3709
3710 /* It doesn't matter whether the original relocation was R_MIPS_GOT16,
3711 R_MIPS16_GOT16, R_MIPS_CALL16, etc. The format of the entry is the
3712 same in all cases. */
3713 entry = mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (abfd, info, ibfd, value, 0,
3714 NULL, R_MIPS_GOT16);
3715 if (entry)
3716 return entry->gotidx;
3717 else
3718 return MINUS_ONE;
3719 }
3720
3721 /* Returns the offset for the entry at the INDEXth position
3722 in the GOT. */
3723
3724 static bfd_vma
3725 mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *output_bfd,
3726 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_vma got_index)
3727 {
3728 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3729 asection *sgot;
3730 bfd_vma gp;
3731
3732 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3733 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3734
3735 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
3736 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd)
3737 + mips_elf_adjust_gp (output_bfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
3738
3739 return sgot->output_section->vma + sgot->output_offset + got_index - gp;
3740 }
3741
3742 /* Create and return a local GOT entry for VALUE, which was calculated
3743 from a symbol belonging to INPUT_SECTON. Return NULL if it could not
3744 be created. If R_SYMNDX refers to a TLS symbol, create a TLS entry
3745 instead. */
3746
3747 static struct mips_got_entry *
3748 mips_elf_create_local_got_entry (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
3749 bfd *ibfd, bfd_vma value,
3750 unsigned long r_symndx,
3751 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
3752 int r_type)
3753 {
3754 struct mips_got_entry lookup, *entry;
3755 void **loc;
3756 struct mips_got_info *g;
3757 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3758 bfd_vma gotidx;
3759
3760 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3761 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3762
3763 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
3764 if (g == NULL)
3765 {
3766 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (abfd, FALSE);
3767 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
3768 }
3769
3770 /* This function shouldn't be called for symbols that live in the global
3771 area of the GOT. */
3772 BFD_ASSERT (h == NULL || h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
3773
3774 lookup.tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
3775 if (lookup.tls_type)
3776 {
3777 lookup.abfd = ibfd;
3778 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
3779 {
3780 lookup.symndx = 0;
3781 lookup.d.addend = 0;
3782 }
3783 else if (h == NULL)
3784 {
3785 lookup.symndx = r_symndx;
3786 lookup.d.addend = 0;
3787 }
3788 else
3789 {
3790 lookup.symndx = -1;
3791 lookup.d.h = h;
3792 }
3793
3794 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries, &lookup);
3795 BFD_ASSERT (entry);
3796
3797 gotidx = entry->gotidx;
3798 BFD_ASSERT (gotidx > 0 && gotidx < htab->root.sgot->size);
3799
3800 return entry;
3801 }
3802
3803 lookup.abfd = NULL;
3804 lookup.symndx = -1;
3805 lookup.d.address = value;
3806 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
3807 if (!loc)
3808 return NULL;
3809
3810 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *loc;
3811 if (entry)
3812 return entry;
3813
3814 if (g->assigned_low_gotno > g->assigned_high_gotno)
3815 {
3816 /* We didn't allocate enough space in the GOT. */
3817 _bfd_error_handler
3818 (_("not enough GOT space for local GOT entries"));
3819 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3820 return NULL;
3821 }
3822
3823 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
3824 if (!entry)
3825 return NULL;
3826
3827 if (got16_reloc_p (r_type)
3828 || call16_reloc_p (r_type)
3829 || got_page_reloc_p (r_type)
3830 || got_disp_reloc_p (r_type))
3831 lookup.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_low_gotno++;
3832 else
3833 lookup.gotidx = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd) * g->assigned_high_gotno--;
3834
3835 *entry = lookup;
3836 *loc = entry;
3837
3838 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (abfd, value, htab->root.sgot->contents + entry->gotidx);
3839
3840 /* These GOT entries need a dynamic relocation on VxWorks. */
3841 if (htab->is_vxworks)
3842 {
3843 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
3844 asection *s;
3845 bfd_byte *rloc;
3846 bfd_vma got_address;
3847
3848 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
3849 got_address = (htab->root.sgot->output_section->vma
3850 + htab->root.sgot->output_offset
3851 + entry->gotidx);
3852
3853 rloc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
3854 outrel.r_offset = got_address;
3855 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_MIPS_32);
3856 outrel.r_addend = value;
3857 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, rloc);
3858 }
3859
3860 return entry;
3861 }
3862
3863 /* Return the number of dynamic section symbols required by OUTPUT_BFD.
3864 The number might be exact or a worst-case estimate, depending on how
3865 much information is available to elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym at
3866 the current linking stage. */
3867
3868 static bfd_size_type
3869 count_section_dynsyms (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3870 {
3871 bfd_size_type count;
3872
3873 count = 0;
3874 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3875 || elf_hash_table (info)->is_relocatable_executable)
3876 {
3877 asection *p;
3878 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
3879
3880 bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
3881 for (p = output_bfd->sections; p ; p = p->next)
3882 if ((p->flags & SEC_EXCLUDE) == 0
3883 && (p->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
3884 && elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_relocs
3885 && !(*bed->elf_backend_omit_section_dynsym) (output_bfd, info, p))
3886 ++count;
3887 }
3888 return count;
3889 }
3890
3891 /* Sort the dynamic symbol table so that symbols that need GOT entries
3892 appear towards the end. */
3893
3894 static bfd_boolean
3895 mips_elf_sort_hash_table (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3896 {
3897 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3898 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data hsd;
3899 struct mips_got_info *g;
3900
3901 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
3902 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
3903
3904 if (htab->root.dynsymcount == 0)
3905 return TRUE;
3906
3907 g = htab->got_info;
3908 if (g == NULL)
3909 return TRUE;
3910
3911 hsd.low = NULL;
3912 hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx
3913 = hsd.min_got_dynindx
3914 = (htab->root.dynsymcount - g->reloc_only_gotno);
3915 /* Add 1 to local symbol indices to account for the mandatory NULL entry
3916 at the head of the table; see `_bfd_elf_link_renumber_dynsyms'. */
3917 hsd.max_local_dynindx = count_section_dynsyms (abfd, info) + 1;
3918 hsd.max_non_got_dynindx = htab->root.local_dynsymcount + 1;
3919 hsd.output_bfd = abfd;
3920 if (htab->root.dynobj != NULL
3921 && htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
3922 && info->emit_gnu_hash)
3923 {
3924 asection *s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->root.dynobj, ".MIPS.xhash");
3925 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
3926 hsd.mipsxhash = s->contents;
3927 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.mipsxhash != NULL);
3928 }
3929 else
3930 hsd.mipsxhash = NULL;
3931 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f, &hsd);
3932
3933 /* There should have been enough room in the symbol table to
3934 accommodate both the GOT and non-GOT symbols. */
3935 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_local_dynindx <= htab->root.local_dynsymcount + 1);
3936 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_non_got_dynindx <= hsd.min_got_dynindx);
3937 BFD_ASSERT (hsd.max_unref_got_dynindx == htab->root.dynsymcount);
3938 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.dynsymcount - hsd.min_got_dynindx == g->global_gotno);
3939
3940 /* Now we know which dynamic symbol has the lowest dynamic symbol
3941 table index in the GOT. */
3942 htab->global_gotsym = hsd.low;
3943
3944 return TRUE;
3945 }
3946
3947 /* If H needs a GOT entry, assign it the highest available dynamic
3948 index. Otherwise, assign it the lowest available dynamic
3949 index. */
3950
3951 static bfd_boolean
3952 mips_elf_sort_hash_table_f (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
3953 {
3954 struct mips_elf_hash_sort_data *hsd = data;
3955
3956 /* Symbols without dynamic symbol table entries aren't interesting
3957 at all. */
3958 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
3959 return TRUE;
3960
3961 switch (h->global_got_area)
3962 {
3963 case GGA_NONE:
3964 if (h->root.forced_local)
3965 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_local_dynindx++;
3966 else
3967 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_non_got_dynindx++;
3968 break;
3969
3970 case GGA_NORMAL:
3971 h->root.dynindx = --hsd->min_got_dynindx;
3972 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3973 break;
3974
3975 case GGA_RELOC_ONLY:
3976 if (hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx == hsd->min_got_dynindx)
3977 hsd->low = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
3978 h->root.dynindx = hsd->max_unref_got_dynindx++;
3979 break;
3980 }
3981
3982 /* Populate the .MIPS.xhash translation table entry with
3983 the symbol dynindx. */
3984 if (h->mipsxhash_loc != 0 && hsd->mipsxhash != NULL)
3985 bfd_put_32 (hsd->output_bfd, h->root.dynindx,
3986 hsd->mipsxhash + h->mipsxhash_loc);
3987
3988 return TRUE;
3989 }
3990
3991 /* Record that input bfd ABFD requires a GOT entry like *LOOKUP
3992 (which is owned by the caller and shouldn't be added to the
3993 hash table directly). */
3994
3995 static bfd_boolean
3996 mips_elf_record_got_entry (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
3997 struct mips_got_entry *lookup)
3998 {
3999 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4000 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4001 struct mips_got_info *g;
4002 void **loc, **bfd_loc;
4003
4004 /* Make sure there's a slot for this entry in the master GOT. */
4005 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4006 g = htab->got_info;
4007 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, lookup, INSERT);
4008 if (!loc)
4009 return FALSE;
4010
4011 /* Populate the entry if it isn't already. */
4012 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *loc;
4013 if (!entry)
4014 {
4015 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4016 if (!entry)
4017 return FALSE;
4018
4019 lookup->tls_initialized = FALSE;
4020 lookup->gotidx = -1;
4021 *entry = *lookup;
4022 *loc = entry;
4023 }
4024
4025 /* Reuse the same GOT entry for the BFD's GOT. */
4026 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (abfd, TRUE);
4027 if (!g)
4028 return FALSE;
4029
4030 bfd_loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_entries, lookup, INSERT);
4031 if (!bfd_loc)
4032 return FALSE;
4033
4034 if (!*bfd_loc)
4035 *bfd_loc = entry;
4036 return TRUE;
4037 }
4038
4039 /* ABFD has a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against H. Reserve a GOT
4040 entry for it. FOR_CALL is true if the caller is only interested in
4041 using the GOT entry for calls. */
4042
4043 static bfd_boolean
4044 mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4045 bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4046 bfd_boolean for_call, int r_type)
4047 {
4048 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4049 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
4050 struct mips_got_entry entry;
4051 unsigned char tls_type;
4052
4053 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4054 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4055
4056 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
4057 if (!for_call)
4058 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
4059
4060 /* A global symbol in the GOT must also be in the dynamic symbol
4061 table. */
4062 if (h->dynindx == -1)
4063 {
4064 switch (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other))
4065 {
4066 case STV_INTERNAL:
4067 case STV_HIDDEN:
4068 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (info, h, TRUE);
4069 break;
4070 }
4071 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
4072 return FALSE;
4073 }
4074
4075 tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
4076 if (tls_type == GOT_TLS_NONE && hmips->global_got_area > GGA_NORMAL)
4077 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_NORMAL;
4078
4079 entry.abfd = abfd;
4080 entry.symndx = -1;
4081 entry.d.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
4082 entry.tls_type = tls_type;
4083 return mips_elf_record_got_entry (info, abfd, &entry);
4084 }
4085
4086 /* ABFD has a GOT relocation of type R_TYPE against symbol SYMNDX + ADDEND,
4087 where SYMNDX is a local symbol. Reserve a GOT entry for it. */
4088
4089 static bfd_boolean
4090 mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (bfd *abfd, long symndx, bfd_vma addend,
4091 struct bfd_link_info *info, int r_type)
4092 {
4093 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4094 struct mips_got_info *g;
4095 struct mips_got_entry entry;
4096
4097 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4098 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4099
4100 g = htab->got_info;
4101 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
4102
4103 entry.abfd = abfd;
4104 entry.symndx = symndx;
4105 entry.d.addend = addend;
4106 entry.tls_type = mips_elf_reloc_tls_type (r_type);
4107 return mips_elf_record_got_entry (info, abfd, &entry);
4108 }
4109
4110 /* Record that ABFD has a page relocation against SYMNDX + ADDEND.
4111 H is the symbol's hash table entry, or null if SYMNDX is local
4112 to ABFD. */
4113
4114 static bfd_boolean
4115 mips_elf_record_got_page_ref (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd *abfd,
4116 long symndx, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4117 bfd_signed_vma addend)
4118 {
4119 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4120 struct mips_got_info *g1, *g2;
4121 struct mips_got_page_ref lookup, *entry;
4122 void **loc, **bfd_loc;
4123
4124 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4125 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4126
4127 g1 = htab->got_info;
4128 BFD_ASSERT (g1 != NULL);
4129
4130 if (h)
4131 {
4132 lookup.symndx = -1;
4133 lookup.u.h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
4134 }
4135 else
4136 {
4137 lookup.symndx = symndx;
4138 lookup.u.abfd = abfd;
4139 }
4140 lookup.addend = addend;
4141 loc = htab_find_slot (g1->got_page_refs, &lookup, INSERT);
4142 if (loc == NULL)
4143 return FALSE;
4144
4145 entry = (struct mips_got_page_ref *) *loc;
4146 if (!entry)
4147 {
4148 entry = bfd_alloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4149 if (!entry)
4150 return FALSE;
4151
4152 *entry = lookup;
4153 *loc = entry;
4154 }
4155
4156 /* Add the same entry to the BFD's GOT. */
4157 g2 = mips_elf_bfd_got (abfd, TRUE);
4158 if (!g2)
4159 return FALSE;
4160
4161 bfd_loc = htab_find_slot (g2->got_page_refs, &lookup, INSERT);
4162 if (!bfd_loc)
4163 return FALSE;
4164
4165 if (!*bfd_loc)
4166 *bfd_loc = entry;
4167
4168 return TRUE;
4169 }
4170
4171 /* Add room for N relocations to the .rel(a).dyn section in ABFD. */
4172
4173 static void
4174 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4175 unsigned int n)
4176 {
4177 asection *s;
4178 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4179
4180 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4181 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4182
4183 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
4184 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4185
4186 if (htab->is_vxworks)
4187 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (abfd);
4188 else
4189 {
4190 if (s->size == 0)
4191 {
4192 /* Make room for a null element. */
4193 s->size += MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4194 ++s->reloc_count;
4195 }
4196 s->size += n * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (abfd);
4197 }
4198 }
4199 \f
4200 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries, with DATA pointing to a
4201 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg structure. Count the number of GOT
4202 entries and TLS relocs. Set DATA->value to true if we need
4203 to resolve indirect or warning symbols and then recreate the GOT. */
4204
4205 static int
4206 mips_elf_check_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
4207 {
4208 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4209 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4210
4211 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4212 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4213 if (entry->abfd != NULL && entry->symndx == -1)
4214 {
4215 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4216
4217 h = entry->d.h;
4218 if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4219 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4220 {
4221 arg->value = TRUE;
4222 return 0;
4223 }
4224 }
4225 mips_elf_count_got_entry (arg->info, arg->g, entry);
4226 return 1;
4227 }
4228
4229 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries, with DATA pointing to a
4230 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg structure. Add all entries to DATA->g,
4231 converting entries for indirect and warning symbols into entries
4232 for the target symbol. Set DATA->g to null on error. */
4233
4234 static int
4235 mips_elf_recreate_got (void **entryp, void *data)
4236 {
4237 struct mips_got_entry new_entry, *entry;
4238 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4239 void **slot;
4240
4241 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4242 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4243 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4244 && entry->symndx == -1
4245 && (entry->d.h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4246 || entry->d.h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning))
4247 {
4248 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4249
4250 new_entry = *entry;
4251 entry = &new_entry;
4252 h = entry->d.h;
4253 do
4254 {
4255 BFD_ASSERT (h->global_got_area == GGA_NONE);
4256 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
4257 }
4258 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4259 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning);
4260 entry->d.h = h;
4261 }
4262 slot = htab_find_slot (arg->g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
4263 if (slot == NULL)
4264 {
4265 arg->g = NULL;
4266 return 0;
4267 }
4268 if (*slot == NULL)
4269 {
4270 if (entry == &new_entry)
4271 {
4272 entry = bfd_alloc (entry->abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4273 if (!entry)
4274 {
4275 arg->g = NULL;
4276 return 0;
4277 }
4278 *entry = new_entry;
4279 }
4280 *slot = entry;
4281 mips_elf_count_got_entry (arg->info, arg->g, entry);
4282 }
4283 return 1;
4284 }
4285
4286 /* Return the maximum number of GOT page entries required for RANGE. */
4287
4288 static bfd_vma
4289 mips_elf_pages_for_range (const struct mips_got_page_range *range)
4290 {
4291 return (range->max_addend - range->min_addend + 0x1ffff) >> 16;
4292 }
4293
4294 /* Record that G requires a page entry that can reach SEC + ADDEND. */
4295
4296 static bfd_boolean
4297 mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg,
4298 asection *sec, bfd_signed_vma addend)
4299 {
4300 struct mips_got_info *g = arg->g;
4301 struct mips_got_page_entry lookup, *entry;
4302 struct mips_got_page_range **range_ptr, *range;
4303 bfd_vma old_pages, new_pages;
4304 void **loc;
4305
4306 /* Find the mips_got_page_entry hash table entry for this section. */
4307 lookup.sec = sec;
4308 loc = htab_find_slot (g->got_page_entries, &lookup, INSERT);
4309 if (loc == NULL)
4310 return FALSE;
4311
4312 /* Create a mips_got_page_entry if this is the first time we've
4313 seen the section. */
4314 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *loc;
4315 if (!entry)
4316 {
4317 entry = bfd_zalloc (arg->info->output_bfd, sizeof (*entry));
4318 if (!entry)
4319 return FALSE;
4320
4321 entry->sec = sec;
4322 *loc = entry;
4323 }
4324
4325 /* Skip over ranges whose maximum extent cannot share a page entry
4326 with ADDEND. */
4327 range_ptr = &entry->ranges;
4328 while (*range_ptr && addend > (*range_ptr)->max_addend + 0xffff)
4329 range_ptr = &(*range_ptr)->next;
4330
4331 /* If we scanned to the end of the list, or found a range whose
4332 minimum extent cannot share a page entry with ADDEND, create
4333 a new singleton range. */
4334 range = *range_ptr;
4335 if (!range || addend < range->min_addend - 0xffff)
4336 {
4337 range = bfd_zalloc (arg->info->output_bfd, sizeof (*range));
4338 if (!range)
4339 return FALSE;
4340
4341 range->next = *range_ptr;
4342 range->min_addend = addend;
4343 range->max_addend = addend;
4344
4345 *range_ptr = range;
4346 entry->num_pages++;
4347 g->page_gotno++;
4348 return TRUE;
4349 }
4350
4351 /* Remember how many pages the old range contributed. */
4352 old_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
4353
4354 /* Update the ranges. */
4355 if (addend < range->min_addend)
4356 range->min_addend = addend;
4357 else if (addend > range->max_addend)
4358 {
4359 if (range->next && addend >= range->next->min_addend - 0xffff)
4360 {
4361 old_pages += mips_elf_pages_for_range (range->next);
4362 range->max_addend = range->next->max_addend;
4363 range->next = range->next->next;
4364 }
4365 else
4366 range->max_addend = addend;
4367 }
4368
4369 /* Record any change in the total estimate. */
4370 new_pages = mips_elf_pages_for_range (range);
4371 if (old_pages != new_pages)
4372 {
4373 entry->num_pages += new_pages - old_pages;
4374 g->page_gotno += new_pages - old_pages;
4375 }
4376
4377 return TRUE;
4378 }
4379
4380 /* A htab_traverse callback for which *REFP points to a mips_got_page_ref
4381 and for which DATA points to a mips_elf_traverse_got_arg. Work out
4382 whether the page reference described by *REFP needs a GOT page entry,
4383 and record that entry in DATA->g if so. Set DATA->g to null on failure. */
4384
4385 static bfd_boolean
4386 mips_elf_resolve_got_page_ref (void **refp, void *data)
4387 {
4388 struct mips_got_page_ref *ref;
4389 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4390 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4391 asection *sec;
4392 bfd_vma addend;
4393
4394 ref = (struct mips_got_page_ref *) *refp;
4395 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4396 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (arg->info);
4397
4398 if (ref->symndx < 0)
4399 {
4400 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4401
4402 /* Global GOT_PAGEs decay to GOT_DISP and so don't need page entries. */
4403 h = ref->u.h;
4404 if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (arg->info, &h->root))
4405 return 1;
4406
4407 /* Ignore undefined symbols; we'll issue an error later if
4408 appropriate. */
4409 if (!((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4410 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4411 && h->root.root.u.def.section))
4412 return 1;
4413
4414 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
4415 addend = h->root.root.u.def.value + ref->addend;
4416 }
4417 else
4418 {
4419 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
4420
4421 /* Read in the symbol. */
4422 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache, ref->u.abfd,
4423 ref->symndx);
4424 if (isym == NULL)
4425 {
4426 arg->g = NULL;
4427 return 0;
4428 }
4429
4430 /* Get the associated input section. */
4431 sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ref->u.abfd, isym->st_shndx);
4432 if (sec == NULL)
4433 {
4434 arg->g = NULL;
4435 return 0;
4436 }
4437
4438 /* If this is a mergable section, work out the section and offset
4439 of the merged data. For section symbols, the addend specifies
4440 of the offset _of_ the first byte in the data, otherwise it
4441 specifies the offset _from_ the first byte. */
4442 if (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE)
4443 {
4444 void *secinfo;
4445
4446 secinfo = elf_section_data (sec)->sec_info;
4447 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
4448 addend = _bfd_merged_section_offset (ref->u.abfd, &sec, secinfo,
4449 isym->st_value + ref->addend);
4450 else
4451 addend = _bfd_merged_section_offset (ref->u.abfd, &sec, secinfo,
4452 isym->st_value) + ref->addend;
4453 }
4454 else
4455 addend = isym->st_value + ref->addend;
4456 }
4457 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_entry (arg, sec, addend))
4458 {
4459 arg->g = NULL;
4460 return 0;
4461 }
4462 return 1;
4463 }
4464
4465 /* If any entries in G->got_entries are for indirect or warning symbols,
4466 replace them with entries for the target symbol. Convert g->got_page_refs
4467 into got_page_entry structures and estimate the number of page entries
4468 that they require. */
4469
4470 static bfd_boolean
4471 mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4472 struct mips_got_info *g)
4473 {
4474 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
4475 struct mips_got_info oldg;
4476
4477 oldg = *g;
4478
4479 tga.info = info;
4480 tga.g = g;
4481 tga.value = FALSE;
4482 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_check_recreate_got, &tga);
4483 if (tga.value)
4484 {
4485 *g = oldg;
4486 g->got_entries = htab_create (htab_size (oldg.got_entries),
4487 mips_elf_got_entry_hash,
4488 mips_elf_got_entry_eq, NULL);
4489 if (!g->got_entries)
4490 return FALSE;
4491
4492 htab_traverse (oldg.got_entries, mips_elf_recreate_got, &tga);
4493 if (!tga.g)
4494 return FALSE;
4495
4496 htab_delete (oldg.got_entries);
4497 }
4498
4499 g->got_page_entries = htab_try_create (1, mips_got_page_entry_hash,
4500 mips_got_page_entry_eq, NULL);
4501 if (g->got_page_entries == NULL)
4502 return FALSE;
4503
4504 tga.info = info;
4505 tga.g = g;
4506 htab_traverse (g->got_page_refs, mips_elf_resolve_got_page_ref, &tga);
4507
4508 return TRUE;
4509 }
4510
4511 /* Return true if a GOT entry for H should live in the local rather than
4512 global GOT area. */
4513
4514 static bfd_boolean
4515 mips_use_local_got_p (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4516 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4517 {
4518 /* Symbols that aren't in the dynamic symbol table must live in the
4519 local GOT. This includes symbols that are completely undefined
4520 and which therefore don't bind locally. We'll report undefined
4521 symbols later if appropriate. */
4522 if (h->root.dynindx == -1)
4523 return TRUE;
4524
4525 /* Absolute symbols, if ever they need a GOT entry, cannot ever go
4526 to the local GOT, as they would be implicitly relocated by the
4527 base address by the dynamic loader. */
4528 if (bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root.root))
4529 return FALSE;
4530
4531 /* Symbols that bind locally can (and in the case of forced-local
4532 symbols, must) live in the local GOT. */
4533 if (h->got_only_for_calls
4534 ? SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root)
4535 : SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
4536 return TRUE;
4537
4538 /* If this is an executable that must provide a definition of the symbol,
4539 either though PLTs or copy relocations, then that address should go in
4540 the local rather than global GOT. */
4541 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && h->has_static_relocs)
4542 return TRUE;
4543
4544 return FALSE;
4545 }
4546
4547 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to the
4548 link_info structure. Decide whether the hash entry needs an entry in
4549 the global part of the primary GOT, setting global_got_area accordingly.
4550 Count the number of global symbols that are in the primary GOT only
4551 because they have relocations against them (reloc_only_gotno). */
4552
4553 static int
4554 mips_elf_count_got_symbols (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
4555 {
4556 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4557 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4558 struct mips_got_info *g;
4559
4560 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4561 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4562 g = htab->got_info;
4563 if (h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4564 {
4565 /* Make a final decision about whether the symbol belongs in the
4566 local or global GOT. */
4567 if (mips_use_local_got_p (info, h))
4568 /* The symbol belongs in the local GOT. We no longer need this
4569 entry if it was only used for relocations; those relocations
4570 will be against the null or section symbol instead of H. */
4571 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
4572 else if (htab->is_vxworks
4573 && h->got_only_for_calls
4574 && h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
4575 /* On VxWorks, calls can refer directly to the .got.plt entry;
4576 they don't need entries in the regular GOT. .got.plt entries
4577 will be allocated by _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
4578 h->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
4579 else if (h->global_got_area == GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
4580 {
4581 g->reloc_only_gotno++;
4582 g->global_gotno++;
4583 }
4584 }
4585 return 1;
4586 }
4587 \f
4588 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries. Add each one to the GOT
4589 given in mips_elf_traverse_got_arg DATA. Clear DATA->G on error. */
4590
4591 static int
4592 mips_elf_add_got_entry (void **entryp, void *data)
4593 {
4594 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4595 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4596 void **slot;
4597
4598 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4599 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4600 slot = htab_find_slot (arg->g->got_entries, entry, INSERT);
4601 if (!slot)
4602 {
4603 arg->g = NULL;
4604 return 0;
4605 }
4606 if (!*slot)
4607 {
4608 *slot = entry;
4609 mips_elf_count_got_entry (arg->info, arg->g, entry);
4610 }
4611 return 1;
4612 }
4613
4614 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT page entries. Add each one to the GOT
4615 given in mips_elf_traverse_got_arg DATA. Clear DATA->G on error. */
4616
4617 static int
4618 mips_elf_add_got_page_entry (void **entryp, void *data)
4619 {
4620 struct mips_got_page_entry *entry;
4621 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4622 void **slot;
4623
4624 entry = (struct mips_got_page_entry *) *entryp;
4625 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4626 slot = htab_find_slot (arg->g->got_page_entries, entry, INSERT);
4627 if (!slot)
4628 {
4629 arg->g = NULL;
4630 return 0;
4631 }
4632 if (!*slot)
4633 {
4634 *slot = entry;
4635 arg->g->page_gotno += entry->num_pages;
4636 }
4637 return 1;
4638 }
4639
4640 /* Consider merging FROM, which is ABFD's GOT, into TO. Return -1 if
4641 this would lead to overflow, 1 if they were merged successfully,
4642 and 0 if a merge failed due to lack of memory. (These values are chosen
4643 so that nonnegative return values can be returned by a htab_traverse
4644 callback.) */
4645
4646 static int
4647 mips_elf_merge_got_with (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *from,
4648 struct mips_got_info *to,
4649 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
4650 {
4651 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
4652 unsigned int estimate;
4653
4654 /* Work out how many page entries we would need for the combined GOT. */
4655 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4656 if (estimate >= from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno)
4657 estimate = from->page_gotno + to->page_gotno;
4658
4659 /* And conservatively estimate how many local and TLS entries
4660 would be needed. */
4661 estimate += from->local_gotno + to->local_gotno;
4662 estimate += from->tls_gotno + to->tls_gotno;
4663
4664 /* If we're merging with the primary got, any TLS relocations will
4665 come after the full set of global entries. Otherwise estimate those
4666 conservatively as well. */
4667 if (to == arg->primary && from->tls_gotno + to->tls_gotno)
4668 estimate += arg->global_count;
4669 else
4670 estimate += from->global_gotno + to->global_gotno;
4671
4672 /* Bail out if the combined GOT might be too big. */
4673 if (estimate > arg->max_count)
4674 return -1;
4675
4676 /* Transfer the bfd's got information from FROM to TO. */
4677 tga.info = arg->info;
4678 tga.g = to;
4679 htab_traverse (from->got_entries, mips_elf_add_got_entry, &tga);
4680 if (!tga.g)
4681 return 0;
4682
4683 htab_traverse (from->got_page_entries, mips_elf_add_got_page_entry, &tga);
4684 if (!tga.g)
4685 return 0;
4686
4687 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (abfd, to);
4688 return 1;
4689 }
4690
4691 /* Attempt to merge GOT G, which belongs to ABFD. Try to use as much
4692 as possible of the primary got, since it doesn't require explicit
4693 dynamic relocations, but don't use bfds that would reference global
4694 symbols out of the addressable range. Failing the primary got,
4695 attempt to merge with the current got, or finish the current got
4696 and then make make the new got current. */
4697
4698 static bfd_boolean
4699 mips_elf_merge_got (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g,
4700 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg *arg)
4701 {
4702 unsigned int estimate;
4703 int result;
4704
4705 if (!mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (arg->info, g))
4706 return FALSE;
4707
4708 /* Work out the number of page, local and TLS entries. */
4709 estimate = arg->max_pages;
4710 if (estimate > g->page_gotno)
4711 estimate = g->page_gotno;
4712 estimate += g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
4713
4714 /* We place TLS GOT entries after both locals and globals. The globals
4715 for the primary GOT may overflow the normal GOT size limit, so be
4716 sure not to merge a GOT which requires TLS with the primary GOT in that
4717 case. This doesn't affect non-primary GOTs. */
4718 estimate += (g->tls_gotno > 0 ? arg->global_count : g->global_gotno);
4719
4720 if (estimate <= arg->max_count)
4721 {
4722 /* If we don't have a primary GOT, use it as
4723 a starting point for the primary GOT. */
4724 if (!arg->primary)
4725 {
4726 arg->primary = g;
4727 return TRUE;
4728 }
4729
4730 /* Try merging with the primary GOT. */
4731 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (abfd, g, arg->primary, arg);
4732 if (result >= 0)
4733 return result;
4734 }
4735
4736 /* If we can merge with the last-created got, do it. */
4737 if (arg->current)
4738 {
4739 result = mips_elf_merge_got_with (abfd, g, arg->current, arg);
4740 if (result >= 0)
4741 return result;
4742 }
4743
4744 /* Well, we couldn't merge, so create a new GOT. Don't check if it
4745 fits; if it turns out that it doesn't, we'll get relocation
4746 overflows anyway. */
4747 g->next = arg->current;
4748 arg->current = g;
4749
4750 return TRUE;
4751 }
4752
4753 /* ENTRYP is a hash table entry for a mips_got_entry. Set its gotidx
4754 to GOTIDX, duplicating the entry if it has already been assigned
4755 an index in a different GOT. */
4756
4757 static bfd_boolean
4758 mips_elf_set_gotidx (void **entryp, long gotidx)
4759 {
4760 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4761
4762 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4763 if (entry->gotidx > 0)
4764 {
4765 struct mips_got_entry *new_entry;
4766
4767 new_entry = bfd_alloc (entry->abfd, sizeof (*entry));
4768 if (!new_entry)
4769 return FALSE;
4770
4771 *new_entry = *entry;
4772 *entryp = new_entry;
4773 entry = new_entry;
4774 }
4775 entry->gotidx = gotidx;
4776 return TRUE;
4777 }
4778
4779 /* Set the TLS GOT index for the GOT entry in ENTRYP. DATA points to a
4780 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg in which DATA->value is the size of one
4781 GOT entry. Set DATA->g to null on failure. */
4782
4783 static int
4784 mips_elf_initialize_tls_index (void **entryp, void *data)
4785 {
4786 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4787 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4788
4789 /* We're only interested in TLS symbols. */
4790 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4791 if (entry->tls_type == GOT_TLS_NONE)
4792 return 1;
4793
4794 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4795 if (!mips_elf_set_gotidx (entryp, arg->value * arg->g->tls_assigned_gotno))
4796 {
4797 arg->g = NULL;
4798 return 0;
4799 }
4800
4801 /* Account for the entries we've just allocated. */
4802 arg->g->tls_assigned_gotno += mips_tls_got_entries (entry->tls_type);
4803 return 1;
4804 }
4805
4806 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries, where DATA points to a
4807 mips_elf_traverse_got_arg. Set the global_got_area of each global
4808 symbol to DATA->value. */
4809
4810 static int
4811 mips_elf_set_global_got_area (void **entryp, void *data)
4812 {
4813 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4814 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4815
4816 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4817 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4818 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4819 && entry->symndx == -1
4820 && entry->d.h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4821 entry->d.h->global_got_area = arg->value;
4822 return 1;
4823 }
4824
4825 /* A htab_traverse callback for secondary GOT entries, where DATA points
4826 to a mips_elf_traverse_got_arg. Assign GOT indices to global entries
4827 and record the number of relocations they require. DATA->value is
4828 the size of one GOT entry. Set DATA->g to null on failure. */
4829
4830 static int
4831 mips_elf_set_global_gotidx (void **entryp, void *data)
4832 {
4833 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4834 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *arg;
4835
4836 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4837 arg = (struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg *) data;
4838 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4839 && entry->symndx == -1
4840 && entry->d.h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
4841 {
4842 if (!mips_elf_set_gotidx (entryp, arg->value * arg->g->assigned_low_gotno))
4843 {
4844 arg->g = NULL;
4845 return 0;
4846 }
4847 arg->g->assigned_low_gotno += 1;
4848
4849 if (bfd_link_pic (arg->info)
4850 || (elf_hash_table (arg->info)->dynamic_sections_created
4851 && entry->d.h->root.def_dynamic
4852 && !entry->d.h->root.def_regular))
4853 arg->g->relocs += 1;
4854 }
4855
4856 return 1;
4857 }
4858
4859 /* A htab_traverse callback for GOT entries for which DATA is the
4860 bfd_link_info. Forbid any global symbols from having traditional
4861 lazy-binding stubs. */
4862
4863 static int
4864 mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs (void **entryp, void *data)
4865 {
4866 struct bfd_link_info *info;
4867 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4868 struct mips_got_entry *entry;
4869
4870 entry = (struct mips_got_entry *) *entryp;
4871 info = (struct bfd_link_info *) data;
4872 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4873 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4874
4875 if (entry->abfd != NULL
4876 && entry->symndx == -1
4877 && entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub)
4878 {
4879 entry->d.h->needs_lazy_stub = FALSE;
4880 htab->lazy_stub_count--;
4881 }
4882
4883 return 1;
4884 }
4885
4886 /* Return the offset of an input bfd IBFD's GOT from the beginning of
4887 the primary GOT. */
4888 static bfd_vma
4889 mips_elf_adjust_gp (bfd *abfd, struct mips_got_info *g, bfd *ibfd)
4890 {
4891 if (!g->next)
4892 return 0;
4893
4894 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
4895 if (! g)
4896 return 0;
4897
4898 BFD_ASSERT (g->next);
4899
4900 g = g->next;
4901
4902 return (g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno)
4903 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
4904 }
4905
4906 /* Turn a single GOT that is too big for 16-bit addressing into
4907 a sequence of GOTs, each one 16-bit addressable. */
4908
4909 static bfd_boolean
4910 mips_elf_multi_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
4911 asection *got, bfd_size_type pages)
4912 {
4913 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4914 struct mips_elf_got_per_bfd_arg got_per_bfd_arg;
4915 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
4916 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
4917 unsigned int assign, needed_relocs;
4918 bfd *dynobj, *ibfd;
4919
4920 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
4921 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
4922 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
4923
4924 g = htab->got_info;
4925
4926 got_per_bfd_arg.obfd = abfd;
4927 got_per_bfd_arg.info = info;
4928 got_per_bfd_arg.current = NULL;
4929 got_per_bfd_arg.primary = NULL;
4930 got_per_bfd_arg.max_count = ((MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info)
4931 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd))
4932 - htab->reserved_gotno);
4933 got_per_bfd_arg.max_pages = pages;
4934 /* The number of globals that will be included in the primary GOT.
4935 See the calls to mips_elf_set_global_got_area below for more
4936 information. */
4937 got_per_bfd_arg.global_count = g->global_gotno;
4938
4939 /* Try to merge the GOTs of input bfds together, as long as they
4940 don't seem to exceed the maximum GOT size, choosing one of them
4941 to be the primary GOT. */
4942 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4943 {
4944 gg = mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE);
4945 if (gg && !mips_elf_merge_got (ibfd, gg, &got_per_bfd_arg))
4946 return FALSE;
4947 }
4948
4949 /* If we do not find any suitable primary GOT, create an empty one. */
4950 if (got_per_bfd_arg.primary == NULL)
4951 g->next = mips_elf_create_got_info (abfd);
4952 else
4953 g->next = got_per_bfd_arg.primary;
4954 g->next->next = got_per_bfd_arg.current;
4955
4956 /* GG is now the master GOT, and G is the primary GOT. */
4957 gg = g;
4958 g = g->next;
4959
4960 /* Map the output bfd to the primary got. That's what we're going
4961 to use for bfds that use GOT16 or GOT_PAGE relocations that we
4962 didn't mark in check_relocs, and we want a quick way to find it.
4963 We can't just use gg->next because we're going to reverse the
4964 list. */
4965 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (abfd, g);
4966
4967 /* Every symbol that is referenced in a dynamic relocation must be
4968 present in the primary GOT, so arrange for them to appear after
4969 those that are actually referenced. */
4970 gg->reloc_only_gotno = gg->global_gotno - g->global_gotno;
4971 g->global_gotno = gg->global_gotno;
4972
4973 tga.info = info;
4974 tga.value = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
4975 htab_traverse (gg->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_area, &tga);
4976 tga.value = GGA_NORMAL;
4977 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_got_area, &tga);
4978
4979 /* Now go through the GOTs assigning them offset ranges.
4980 [assigned_low_gotno, local_gotno[ will be set to the range of local
4981 entries in each GOT. We can then compute the end of a GOT by
4982 adding local_gotno to global_gotno. We reverse the list and make
4983 it circular since then we'll be able to quickly compute the
4984 beginning of a GOT, by computing the end of its predecessor. To
4985 avoid special cases for the primary GOT, while still preserving
4986 assertions that are valid for both single- and multi-got links,
4987 we arrange for the main got struct to have the right number of
4988 global entries, but set its local_gotno such that the initial
4989 offset of the primary GOT is zero. Remember that the primary GOT
4990 will become the last item in the circular linked list, so it
4991 points back to the master GOT. */
4992 gg->local_gotno = -g->global_gotno;
4993 gg->global_gotno = g->global_gotno;
4994 gg->tls_gotno = 0;
4995 assign = 0;
4996 gg->next = gg;
4997
4998 do
4999 {
5000 struct mips_got_info *gn;
5001
5002 assign += htab->reserved_gotno;
5003 g->assigned_low_gotno = assign;
5004 g->local_gotno += assign;
5005 g->local_gotno += (pages < g->page_gotno ? pages : g->page_gotno);
5006 g->assigned_high_gotno = g->local_gotno - 1;
5007 assign = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno + g->tls_gotno;
5008
5009 /* Take g out of the direct list, and push it onto the reversed
5010 list that gg points to. g->next is guaranteed to be nonnull after
5011 this operation, as required by mips_elf_initialize_tls_index. */
5012 gn = g->next;
5013 g->next = gg->next;
5014 gg->next = g;
5015
5016 /* Set up any TLS entries. We always place the TLS entries after
5017 all non-TLS entries. */
5018 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno;
5019 tga.g = g;
5020 tga.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
5021 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, &tga);
5022 if (!tga.g)
5023 return FALSE;
5024 BFD_ASSERT (g->tls_assigned_gotno == assign);
5025
5026 /* Move onto the next GOT. It will be a secondary GOT if nonull. */
5027 g = gn;
5028
5029 /* Forbid global symbols in every non-primary GOT from having
5030 lazy-binding stubs. */
5031 if (g)
5032 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_forbid_lazy_stubs, info);
5033 }
5034 while (g);
5035
5036 got->size = assign * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
5037
5038 needed_relocs = 0;
5039 for (g = gg->next; g && g->next != gg; g = g->next)
5040 {
5041 unsigned int save_assign;
5042
5043 /* Assign offsets to global GOT entries and count how many
5044 relocations they need. */
5045 save_assign = g->assigned_low_gotno;
5046 g->assigned_low_gotno = g->local_gotno;
5047 tga.info = info;
5048 tga.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (abfd);
5049 tga.g = g;
5050 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_set_global_gotidx, &tga);
5051 if (!tga.g)
5052 return FALSE;
5053 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_low_gotno == g->local_gotno + g->global_gotno);
5054 g->assigned_low_gotno = save_assign;
5055
5056 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5057 {
5058 g->relocs += g->local_gotno - g->assigned_low_gotno;
5059 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_low_gotno == g->next->local_gotno
5060 + g->next->global_gotno
5061 + g->next->tls_gotno
5062 + htab->reserved_gotno);
5063 }
5064 needed_relocs += g->relocs;
5065 }
5066 needed_relocs += g->relocs;
5067
5068 if (needed_relocs)
5069 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info,
5070 needed_relocs);
5071
5072 return TRUE;
5073 }
5074
5075 \f
5076 /* Returns the first relocation of type r_type found, beginning with
5077 RELOCATION. RELEND is one-past-the-end of the relocation table. */
5078
5079 static const Elf_Internal_Rela *
5080 mips_elf_next_relocation (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int r_type,
5081 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5082 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend)
5083 {
5084 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info);
5085
5086 while (relocation < relend)
5087 {
5088 if (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_type
5089 && ELF_R_SYM (abfd, relocation->r_info) == r_symndx)
5090 return relocation;
5091
5092 ++relocation;
5093 }
5094
5095 /* We didn't find it. */
5096 return NULL;
5097 }
5098
5099 /* Return whether an input relocation is against a local symbol. */
5100
5101 static bfd_boolean
5102 mips_elf_local_relocation_p (bfd *input_bfd,
5103 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5104 asection **local_sections)
5105 {
5106 unsigned long r_symndx;
5107 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5108 size_t extsymoff;
5109
5110 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5111 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
5112 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5113
5114 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
5115 return TRUE;
5116 if (elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd) && local_sections[r_symndx] != NULL)
5117 return TRUE;
5118
5119 return FALSE;
5120 }
5121 \f
5122 /* Sign-extend VALUE, which has the indicated number of BITS. */
5123
5124 bfd_vma
5125 _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (bfd_vma value, int bits)
5126 {
5127 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << (bits - 1)))
5128 /* VALUE is negative. */
5129 value |= ((bfd_vma) - 1) << bits;
5130
5131 return value;
5132 }
5133
5134 /* Return non-zero if the indicated VALUE has overflowed the maximum
5135 range expressible by a signed number with the indicated number of
5136 BITS. */
5137
5138 static bfd_boolean
5139 mips_elf_overflow_p (bfd_vma value, int bits)
5140 {
5141 bfd_signed_vma svalue = (bfd_signed_vma) value;
5142
5143 if (svalue > (1 << (bits - 1)) - 1)
5144 /* The value is too big. */
5145 return TRUE;
5146 else if (svalue < -(1 << (bits - 1)))
5147 /* The value is too small. */
5148 return TRUE;
5149
5150 /* All is well. */
5151 return FALSE;
5152 }
5153
5154 /* Calculate the %high function. */
5155
5156 static bfd_vma
5157 mips_elf_high (bfd_vma value)
5158 {
5159 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
5160 }
5161
5162 /* Calculate the %higher function. */
5163
5164 static bfd_vma
5165 mips_elf_higher (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5166 {
5167 #ifdef BFD64
5168 return ((value + (bfd_vma) 0x80008000) >> 32) & 0xffff;
5169 #else
5170 abort ();
5171 return MINUS_ONE;
5172 #endif
5173 }
5174
5175 /* Calculate the %highest function. */
5176
5177 static bfd_vma
5178 mips_elf_highest (bfd_vma value ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5179 {
5180 #ifdef BFD64
5181 return ((value + (((bfd_vma) 0x8000 << 32) | 0x80008000)) >> 48) & 0xffff;
5182 #else
5183 abort ();
5184 return MINUS_ONE;
5185 #endif
5186 }
5187 \f
5188 /* Create the .compact_rel section. */
5189
5190 static bfd_boolean
5191 mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section
5192 (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
5193 {
5194 flagword flags;
5195 register asection *s;
5196
5197 if (bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".compact_rel") == NULL)
5198 {
5199 flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED
5200 | SEC_READONLY);
5201
5202 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".compact_rel", flags);
5203 if (s == NULL
5204 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
5205 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
5206 return FALSE;
5207
5208 s->size = sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel);
5209 }
5210
5211 return TRUE;
5212 }
5213
5214 /* Create the .got section to hold the global offset table. */
5215
5216 static bfd_boolean
5217 mips_elf_create_got_section (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
5218 {
5219 flagword flags;
5220 register asection *s;
5221 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
5222 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
5223 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5224
5225 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5226 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
5227
5228 /* This function may be called more than once. */
5229 if (htab->root.sgot)
5230 return TRUE;
5231
5232 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5233 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
5234
5235 /* We have to use an alignment of 2**4 here because this is hardcoded
5236 in the function stub generation and in the linker script. */
5237 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got", flags);
5238 if (s == NULL
5239 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, 4))
5240 return FALSE;
5241 htab->root.sgot = s;
5242
5243 /* Define the symbol _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. We don't do this in the
5244 linker script because we don't want to define the symbol if we
5245 are not creating a global offset table. */
5246 bh = NULL;
5247 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
5248 (info, abfd, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_", BSF_GLOBAL, s,
5249 0, NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
5250 return FALSE;
5251
5252 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
5253 h->non_elf = 0;
5254 h->def_regular = 1;
5255 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
5256 h->other = (h->other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) | STV_HIDDEN;
5257 elf_hash_table (info)->hgot = h;
5258
5259 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5260 && ! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
5261 return FALSE;
5262
5263 htab->got_info = mips_elf_create_got_info (abfd);
5264 mips_elf_section_data (s)->elf.this_hdr.sh_flags
5265 |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
5266
5267 /* We also need a .got.plt section when generating PLTs. */
5268 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".got.plt",
5269 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
5270 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
5271 | SEC_IN_MEMORY
5272 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
5273 if (s == NULL)
5274 return FALSE;
5275 htab->root.sgotplt = s;
5276
5277 return TRUE;
5278 }
5279 \f
5280 /* Return true if H refers to the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ or
5281 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols. These symbols are only special for
5282 shared objects; they are not used in executables. */
5283
5284 static bfd_boolean
5285 is_gott_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5286 {
5287 return (mips_elf_hash_table (info)->is_vxworks
5288 && bfd_link_pic (info)
5289 && (strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_BASE__") == 0
5290 || strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__GOTT_INDEX__") == 0));
5291 }
5292
5293 /* Return TRUE if a relocation of type R_TYPE from INPUT_BFD might
5294 require an la25 stub. See also mips_elf_local_pic_function_p,
5295 which determines whether the destination function ever requires a
5296 stub. */
5297
5298 static bfd_boolean
5299 mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (bfd *input_bfd, int r_type,
5300 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5301 {
5302 /* We specifically ignore branches and jumps from EF_PIC objects,
5303 where the onus is on the compiler or programmer to perform any
5304 necessary initialization of $25. Sometimes such initialization
5305 is unnecessary; for example, -mno-shared functions do not use
5306 the incoming value of $25, and may therefore be called directly. */
5307 if (PIC_OBJECT_P (input_bfd))
5308 return FALSE;
5309
5310 switch (r_type)
5311 {
5312 case R_MIPS_26:
5313 case R_MIPS_PC16:
5314 case R_MIPS_PC21_S2:
5315 case R_MIPS_PC26_S2:
5316 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
5317 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
5318 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
5319 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
5320 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
5321 return TRUE;
5322
5323 case R_MIPS16_26:
5324 return !target_is_16_bit_code_p;
5325
5326 default:
5327 return FALSE;
5328 }
5329 }
5330 \f
5331 /* Obtain the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
5332
5333 static bfd_vma
5334 mips_elf_obtain_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
5335 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5336 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents)
5337 {
5338 bfd_vma x = 0;
5339 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5340 unsigned int size = bfd_get_reloc_size (howto);
5341
5342 /* Obtain the bytes. */
5343 if (size != 0)
5344 x = bfd_get (8 * size, input_bfd, location);
5345
5346 return x;
5347 }
5348
5349 /* Store the field relocated by RELOCATION. */
5350
5351 static void
5352 mips_elf_store_contents (reloc_howto_type *howto,
5353 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5354 bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma x)
5355 {
5356 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5357 unsigned int size = bfd_get_reloc_size (howto);
5358
5359 /* Put the value into the output. */
5360 if (size != 0)
5361 bfd_put (8 * size, input_bfd, x, location);
5362 }
5363
5364 /* Try to patch a load from GOT instruction in CONTENTS pointed to by
5365 RELOCATION described by HOWTO, with a move of 0 to the load target
5366 register, returning TRUE if that is successful and FALSE otherwise.
5367 If DOIT is FALSE, then only determine it patching is possible and
5368 return status without actually changing CONTENTS.
5369 */
5370
5371 static bfd_boolean
5372 mips_elf_nullify_got_load (bfd *input_bfd, bfd_byte *contents,
5373 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5374 reloc_howto_type *howto, bfd_boolean doit)
5375 {
5376 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5377 bfd_byte *location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
5378 bfd_boolean nullified = TRUE;
5379 bfd_vma x;
5380
5381 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
5382
5383 /* Obtain the current value. */
5384 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
5385
5386 /* Note that in the unshuffled MIPS16 encoding RX is at bits [21:19]
5387 while RY is at bits [18:16] of the combined 32-bit instruction word. */
5388 if (mips16_reloc_p (r_type)
5389 && (((x >> 22) & 0x3ff) == 0x3d3 /* LW */
5390 || ((x >> 22) & 0x3ff) == 0x3c7)) /* LD */
5391 x = (0x3cd << 22) | (x & (7 << 16)) << 3; /* LI */
5392 else if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
5393 && ((x >> 26) & 0x37) == 0x37) /* LW/LD */
5394 x = (0xc << 26) | (x & (0x1f << 21)); /* ADDIU */
5395 else if (((x >> 26) & 0x3f) == 0x23 /* LW */
5396 || ((x >> 26) & 0x3f) == 0x37) /* LD */
5397 x = (0x9 << 26) | (x & (0x1f << 16)); /* ADDIU */
5398 else
5399 nullified = FALSE;
5400
5401 /* Put the value into the output. */
5402 if (doit && nullified)
5403 mips_elf_store_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents, x);
5404
5405 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
5406
5407 return nullified;
5408 }
5409
5410 /* Calculate the value produced by the RELOCATION (which comes from
5411 the INPUT_BFD). The ADDEND is the addend to use for this
5412 RELOCATION; RELOCATION->R_ADDEND is ignored.
5413
5414 The result of the relocation calculation is stored in VALUEP.
5415 On exit, set *CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P to true if the relocation field
5416 is a MIPS16 or microMIPS jump to standard MIPS code, or vice versa.
5417
5418 This function returns bfd_reloc_continue if the caller need take no
5419 further action regarding this relocation, bfd_reloc_notsupported if
5420 something goes dramatically wrong, bfd_reloc_overflow if an
5421 overflow occurs, and bfd_reloc_ok to indicate success. */
5422
5423 static bfd_reloc_status_type
5424 mips_elf_calculate_relocation (bfd *abfd, bfd *input_bfd,
5425 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
5426 struct bfd_link_info *info,
5427 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
5428 bfd_vma addend, reloc_howto_type *howto,
5429 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
5430 asection **local_sections, bfd_vma *valuep,
5431 const char **namep,
5432 bfd_boolean *cross_mode_jump_p,
5433 bfd_boolean save_addend)
5434 {
5435 /* The eventual value we will return. */
5436 bfd_vma value;
5437 /* The address of the symbol against which the relocation is
5438 occurring. */
5439 bfd_vma symbol = 0;
5440 /* The final GP value to be used for the relocatable, executable, or
5441 shared object file being produced. */
5442 bfd_vma gp;
5443 /* The place (section offset or address) of the storage unit being
5444 relocated. */
5445 bfd_vma p;
5446 /* The value of GP used to create the relocatable object. */
5447 bfd_vma gp0;
5448 /* The offset into the global offset table at which the address of
5449 the relocation entry symbol, adjusted by the addend, resides
5450 during execution. */
5451 bfd_vma g = MINUS_ONE;
5452 /* The section in which the symbol referenced by the relocation is
5453 located. */
5454 asection *sec = NULL;
5455 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
5456 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a local
5457 symbol. */
5458 bfd_boolean local_p, was_local_p;
5459 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is a section
5460 symbol. */
5461 bfd_boolean section_p = FALSE;
5462 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is "_gp_disp". */
5463 bfd_boolean gp_disp_p = FALSE;
5464 /* TRUE if the symbol referred to by this relocation is
5465 "__gnu_local_gp". */
5466 bfd_boolean gnu_local_gp_p = FALSE;
5467 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5468 size_t extsymoff;
5469 unsigned long r_symndx;
5470 int r_type;
5471 /* TRUE if overflow occurred during the calculation of the
5472 relocation value. */
5473 bfd_boolean overflowed_p;
5474 /* TRUE if this relocation refers to a MIPS16 function. */
5475 bfd_boolean target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5476 bfd_boolean target_is_micromips_code_p = FALSE;
5477 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5478 bfd *dynobj;
5479 bfd_boolean resolved_to_zero;
5480
5481 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
5482 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
5483 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
5484
5485 /* Parse the relocation. */
5486 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5487 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
5488 p = (input_section->output_section->vma
5489 + input_section->output_offset
5490 + relocation->r_offset);
5491
5492 /* Assume that there will be no overflow. */
5493 overflowed_p = FALSE;
5494
5495 /* Figure out whether or not the symbol is local, and get the offset
5496 used in the array of hash table entries. */
5497 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
5498 local_p = mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, relocation,
5499 local_sections);
5500 was_local_p = local_p;
5501 if (! elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
5502 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5503 else
5504 {
5505 /* The symbol table does not follow the rule that local symbols
5506 must come before globals. */
5507 extsymoff = 0;
5508 }
5509
5510 /* Figure out the value of the symbol. */
5511 if (local_p)
5512 {
5513 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (abfd);
5514 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
5515
5516 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
5517 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
5518
5519 section_p = ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION;
5520
5521 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5522 if (!section_p || (sec->flags & SEC_MERGE))
5523 symbol += sym->st_value;
5524 if ((sec->flags & SEC_MERGE) && section_p)
5525 {
5526 addend = _bfd_elf_rel_local_sym (abfd, sym, &sec, addend);
5527 addend -= symbol;
5528 addend += sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5529 }
5530
5531 /* MIPS16/microMIPS text labels should be treated as odd. */
5532 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
5533 ++symbol;
5534
5535 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
5536 *namep = bfd_elf_string_from_elf_section (input_bfd,
5537 symtab_hdr->sh_link,
5538 sym->st_name);
5539 if (*namep == NULL || **namep == '\0')
5540 *namep = bfd_section_name (input_bfd, sec);
5541
5542 /* For relocations against a section symbol and ones against no
5543 symbol (absolute relocations) infer the ISA mode from the addend. */
5544 if (section_p || r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
5545 {
5546 target_is_16_bit_code_p = (addend & 1) && !micromips_p;
5547 target_is_micromips_code_p = (addend & 1) && micromips_p;
5548 }
5549 /* For relocations against an absolute symbol infer the ISA mode
5550 from the value of the symbol plus addend. */
5551 else if (bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
5552 {
5553 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ((symbol + addend) & 1) && !micromips_p;
5554 target_is_micromips_code_p = ((symbol + addend) & 1) && micromips_p;
5555 }
5556 /* Otherwise just use the regular symbol annotation available. */
5557 else
5558 {
5559 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other);
5560 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym->st_other);
5561 }
5562 }
5563 else
5564 {
5565 /* ??? Could we use RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL here ? */
5566
5567 /* For global symbols we look up the symbol in the hash-table. */
5568 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
5569 elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff]);
5570 /* Find the real hash-table entry for this symbol. */
5571 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
5572 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
5573 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
5574
5575 /* Record the name of this symbol, for our caller. */
5576 *namep = h->root.root.root.string;
5577
5578 /* See if this is the special _gp_disp symbol. Note that such a
5579 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
5580 if (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0
5581 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
5582 {
5583 /* Relocations against _gp_disp are permitted only with
5584 R_MIPS_HI16 and R_MIPS_LO16 relocations. */
5585 if (!hi16_reloc_p (r_type) && !lo16_reloc_p (r_type))
5586 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5587
5588 gp_disp_p = TRUE;
5589 }
5590 /* See if this is the special _gp symbol. Note that such a
5591 symbol must always be a global symbol. */
5592 else if (strcmp (*namep, "__gnu_local_gp") == 0)
5593 gnu_local_gp_p = TRUE;
5594
5595
5596 /* If this symbol is defined, calculate its address. Note that
5597 _gp_disp is a magic symbol, always implicitly defined by the
5598 linker, so it's inappropriate to check to see whether or not
5599 its defined. */
5600 else if ((h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
5601 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
5602 && h->root.root.u.def.section)
5603 {
5604 sec = h->root.root.u.def.section;
5605 if (sec->output_section)
5606 symbol = (h->root.root.u.def.value
5607 + sec->output_section->vma
5608 + sec->output_offset);
5609 else
5610 symbol = h->root.root.u.def.value;
5611 }
5612 else if (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5613 /* We allow relocations against undefined weak symbols, giving
5614 it the value zero, so that you can undefined weak functions
5615 and check to see if they exist by looking at their
5616 addresses. */
5617 symbol = 0;
5618 else if (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_IGNORE
5619 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5620 symbol = 0;
5621 else if (strcmp (*namep, SGI_COMPAT (input_bfd)
5622 ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
5623 {
5624 /* If this is a dynamic link, we should have created a
5625 _DYNAMIC_LINK symbol or _DYNAMIC_LINKING(for normal mips) symbol
5626 in _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections.
5627 Otherwise, we should define the symbol with a value of 0.
5628 FIXME: It should probably get into the symbol table
5629 somehow as well. */
5630 BFD_ASSERT (! bfd_link_pic (info));
5631 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") == NULL);
5632 symbol = 0;
5633 }
5634 else if (ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->root.other))
5635 {
5636 /* This is an optional symbol - an Irix specific extension to the
5637 ELF spec. Ignore it for now.
5638 XXX - FIXME - there is more to the spec for OPTIONAL symbols
5639 than simply ignoring them, but we do not handle this for now.
5640 For information see the "64-bit ELF Object File Specification"
5641 which is available from here:
5642 http://techpubs.sgi.com/library/manuals/4000/007-4658-001/pdf/007-4658-001.pdf */
5643 symbol = 0;
5644 }
5645 else
5646 {
5647 bfd_boolean reject_undefined
5648 = (info->unresolved_syms_in_objects == RM_GENERATE_ERROR
5649 || ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) != STV_DEFAULT);
5650
5651 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
5652 (info, h->root.root.root.string, input_bfd,
5653 input_section, relocation->r_offset, reject_undefined);
5654
5655 if (reject_undefined)
5656 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
5657
5658 symbol = 0;
5659 }
5660
5661 target_is_16_bit_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->root.other);
5662 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other);
5663 }
5664
5665 /* If this is a reference to a 16-bit function with a stub, we need
5666 to redirect the relocation to the stub unless:
5667
5668 (a) the relocation is for a MIPS16 JAL;
5669
5670 (b) the relocation is for a MIPS16 PIC call, and there are no
5671 non-MIPS16 uses of the GOT slot; or
5672
5673 (c) the section allows direct references to MIPS16 functions. */
5674 if (r_type != R_MIPS16_26
5675 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5676 && ((h != NULL
5677 && h->fn_stub != NULL
5678 && (r_type != R_MIPS16_CALL16 || h->need_fn_stub))
5679 || (local_p
5680 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs != NULL
5681 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5682 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (input_section))
5683 {
5684 /* This is a 32- or 64-bit call to a 16-bit function. We should
5685 have already noticed that we were going to need the
5686 stub. */
5687 if (local_p)
5688 {
5689 sec = mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx];
5690 value = 0;
5691 }
5692 else
5693 {
5694 BFD_ASSERT (h->need_fn_stub);
5695 if (h->la25_stub)
5696 {
5697 /* If a LA25 header for the stub itself exists, point to the
5698 prepended LUI/ADDIU sequence. */
5699 sec = h->la25_stub->stub_section;
5700 value = h->la25_stub->offset;
5701 }
5702 else
5703 {
5704 sec = h->fn_stub;
5705 value = 0;
5706 }
5707 }
5708
5709 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + value;
5710 /* The target is 16-bit, but the stub isn't. */
5711 target_is_16_bit_code_p = FALSE;
5712 }
5713 /* If this is a MIPS16 call with a stub, that is made through the PLT or
5714 to a standard MIPS function, we need to redirect the call to the stub.
5715 Note that we specifically exclude R_MIPS16_CALL16 from this behavior;
5716 indirect calls should use an indirect stub instead. */
5717 else if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5718 && ((h != NULL && (h->call_stub != NULL || h->call_fp_stub != NULL))
5719 || (local_p
5720 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs != NULL
5721 && mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] != NULL))
5722 && ((h != NULL && h->use_plt_entry) || !target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5723 {
5724 if (local_p)
5725 sec = mips_elf_tdata (input_bfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx];
5726 else
5727 {
5728 /* If both call_stub and call_fp_stub are defined, we can figure
5729 out which one to use by checking which one appears in the input
5730 file. */
5731 if (h->call_stub != NULL && h->call_fp_stub != NULL)
5732 {
5733 asection *o;
5734
5735 sec = NULL;
5736 for (o = input_bfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
5737 {
5738 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (bfd_get_section_name (input_bfd, o)))
5739 {
5740 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5741 break;
5742 }
5743 }
5744 if (sec == NULL)
5745 sec = h->call_stub;
5746 }
5747 else if (h->call_stub != NULL)
5748 sec = h->call_stub;
5749 else
5750 sec = h->call_fp_stub;
5751 }
5752
5753 BFD_ASSERT (sec->size > 0);
5754 symbol = sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset;
5755 }
5756 /* If this is a direct call to a PIC function, redirect to the
5757 non-PIC stub. */
5758 else if (h != NULL && h->la25_stub
5759 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (input_bfd, r_type,
5760 target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5761 {
5762 symbol = (h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_section->vma
5763 + h->la25_stub->stub_section->output_offset
5764 + h->la25_stub->offset);
5765 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->root.other))
5766 symbol |= 1;
5767 }
5768 /* For direct MIPS16 and microMIPS calls make sure the compressed PLT
5769 entry is used if a standard PLT entry has also been made. In this
5770 case the symbol will have been set by mips_elf_set_plt_sym_value
5771 to point to the standard PLT entry, so redirect to the compressed
5772 one. */
5773 else if ((mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5774 || micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type))
5775 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5776 && h != NULL
5777 && h->use_plt_entry
5778 && h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE
5779 && h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
5780 {
5781 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (abfd);
5782
5783 sec = htab->root.splt;
5784 symbol = (sec->output_section->vma
5785 + sec->output_offset
5786 + htab->plt_header_size
5787 + htab->plt_mips_offset
5788 + h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset
5789 + 1);
5790
5791 target_is_16_bit_code_p = !micromips_p;
5792 target_is_micromips_code_p = micromips_p;
5793 }
5794
5795 /* Make sure MIPS16 and microMIPS are not used together. */
5796 if ((mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type) && target_is_micromips_code_p)
5797 || (micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type) && target_is_16_bit_code_p))
5798 {
5799 _bfd_error_handler
5800 (_("MIPS16 and microMIPS functions cannot call each other"));
5801 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
5802 }
5803
5804 /* Calls from 16-bit code to 32-bit code and vice versa require the
5805 mode change. However, we can ignore calls to undefined weak symbols,
5806 which should never be executed at runtime. This exception is important
5807 because the assembly writer may have "known" that any definition of the
5808 symbol would be 16-bit code, and that direct jumps were therefore
5809 acceptable. */
5810 *cross_mode_jump_p = (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5811 && !(h && h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5812 && ((mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5813 && !target_is_16_bit_code_p)
5814 || (micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5815 && !target_is_micromips_code_p)
5816 || ((branch_reloc_p (r_type)
5817 || r_type == R_MIPS_JALR)
5818 && (target_is_16_bit_code_p
5819 || target_is_micromips_code_p))));
5820
5821 resolved_to_zero = (h != NULL
5822 && UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &h->root));
5823
5824 switch (r_type)
5825 {
5826 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5827 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5828 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5829 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5830 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5831 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5832 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5833 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5834 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
5835 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
5836 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
5837 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
5838 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
5839 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
5840 if (resolved_to_zero
5841 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
5842 && mips_elf_nullify_got_load (input_bfd, contents,
5843 relocation, howto, TRUE))
5844 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5845
5846 /* Fall through. */
5847 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5848 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5849 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
5850 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
5851 if (resolved_to_zero
5852 && htab->use_absolute_zero
5853 && bfd_link_pic (info))
5854 {
5855 /* Redirect to the special `__gnu_absolute_zero' symbol. */
5856 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (htab, "__gnu_absolute_zero",
5857 FALSE, FALSE, FALSE);
5858 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
5859 }
5860 break;
5861 }
5862
5863 local_p = (h == NULL || mips_use_local_got_p (info, h));
5864
5865 gp0 = _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
5866 gp = _bfd_get_gp_value (abfd);
5867 if (htab->got_info)
5868 gp += mips_elf_adjust_gp (abfd, htab->got_info, input_bfd);
5869
5870 if (gnu_local_gp_p)
5871 symbol = gp;
5872
5873 /* Global R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE relocations are equivalent
5874 to R_MIPS_GOT_DISP/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP. The addend is applied by the
5875 corresponding R_MIPS_GOT_OFST/R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST. */
5876 if (got_page_reloc_p (r_type) && !local_p)
5877 {
5878 r_type = (micromips_reloc_p (r_type)
5879 ? R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP : R_MIPS_GOT_DISP);
5880 addend = 0;
5881 }
5882
5883 /* If we haven't already determined the GOT offset, and we're going
5884 to need it, get it now. */
5885 switch (r_type)
5886 {
5887 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
5888 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
5889 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
5890 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
5891 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
5892 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
5893 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
5894 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
5895 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
5896 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
5897 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
5898 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
5899 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
5900 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
5901 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
5902 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
5903 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
5904 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5905 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
5906 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
5907 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5908 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
5909 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
5910 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
5911 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
5912 /* Find the index into the GOT where this value is located. */
5913 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
5914 {
5915 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5916 0, 0, NULL, r_type);
5917 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5918 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5919 }
5920 else if (!local_p)
5921 {
5922 /* On VxWorks, CALL relocations should refer to the .got.plt
5923 entry, which is initialized to point at the PLT stub. */
5924 if (htab->is_vxworks
5925 && (call_hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
5926 || call_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
5927 || call16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5928 {
5929 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5930 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.needs_plt);
5931 g = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, &h->root);
5932 }
5933 else
5934 {
5935 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
5936 g = mips_elf_global_got_index (abfd, info, input_bfd,
5937 &h->root, r_type);
5938 if (!TLS_RELOC_P (r_type)
5939 && !elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5940 /* This is a static link. We must initialize the GOT entry. */
5941 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (dynobj, symbol, htab->root.sgot->contents + g);
5942 }
5943 }
5944 else if (!htab->is_vxworks
5945 && (call16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type)))
5946 /* The calculation below does not involve "g". */
5947 break;
5948 else
5949 {
5950 g = mips_elf_local_got_index (abfd, input_bfd, info,
5951 symbol + addend, r_symndx, h, r_type);
5952 if (g == MINUS_ONE)
5953 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
5954 }
5955
5956 /* Convert GOT indices to actual offsets. */
5957 g = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, g);
5958 break;
5959 }
5960
5961 /* Relocations against the VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__
5962 symbols are resolved by the loader. Add them to .rela.dyn. */
5963 if (h != NULL && is_gott_symbol (info, &h->root))
5964 {
5965 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
5966 bfd_byte *loc;
5967 asection *s;
5968
5969 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
5970 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5971
5972 outrel.r_offset = (input_section->output_section->vma
5973 + input_section->output_offset
5974 + relocation->r_offset);
5975 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->root.dynindx, r_type);
5976 outrel.r_addend = addend;
5977 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (abfd, &outrel, loc);
5978
5979 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
5980 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
5981 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
5982 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
5983 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5984
5985 *valuep = 0;
5986 return bfd_reloc_ok;
5987 }
5988
5989 /* Figure out what kind of relocation is being performed. */
5990 switch (r_type)
5991 {
5992 case R_MIPS_NONE:
5993 return bfd_reloc_continue;
5994
5995 case R_MIPS_16:
5996 if (howto->partial_inplace)
5997 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
5998 value = symbol + addend;
5999 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6000 break;
6001
6002 case R_MIPS_32:
6003 case R_MIPS_REL32:
6004 case R_MIPS_64:
6005 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
6006 || (htab->root.dynamic_sections_created
6007 && h != NULL
6008 && h->root.def_dynamic
6009 && !h->root.def_regular
6010 && !h->has_static_relocs))
6011 && r_symndx != STN_UNDEF
6012 && (h == NULL
6013 || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak
6014 || (ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->root.other) == STV_DEFAULT
6015 && !resolved_to_zero))
6016 && (input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
6017 {
6018 /* If we're creating a shared library, then we can't know
6019 where the symbol will end up. So, we create a relocation
6020 record in the output, and leave the job up to the dynamic
6021 linker. We must do the same for executable references to
6022 shared library symbols, unless we've decided to use copy
6023 relocs or PLTs instead. */
6024 value = addend;
6025 if (!mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (abfd,
6026 info,
6027 relocation,
6028 h,
6029 sec,
6030 symbol,
6031 &value,
6032 input_section))
6033 return bfd_reloc_undefined;
6034 }
6035 else
6036 {
6037 if (r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
6038 value = symbol + addend;
6039 else
6040 value = addend;
6041 }
6042 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6043 break;
6044
6045 case R_MIPS_PC32:
6046 value = symbol + addend - p;
6047 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6048 break;
6049
6050 case R_MIPS16_26:
6051 /* The calculation for R_MIPS16_26 is just the same as for an
6052 R_MIPS_26. It's only the storage of the relocated field into
6053 the output file that's different. That's handled in
6054 mips_elf_perform_relocation. So, we just fall through to the
6055 R_MIPS_26 case here. */
6056 case R_MIPS_26:
6057 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
6058 {
6059 unsigned int shift;
6060
6061 /* Shift is 2, unusually, for microMIPS JALX. */
6062 shift = (!*cross_mode_jump_p && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1) ? 1 : 2;
6063
6064 if (howto->partial_inplace && !section_p)
6065 value = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 26 + shift);
6066 else
6067 value = addend;
6068 value += symbol;
6069
6070 /* Make sure the target of a jump is suitably aligned. Bit 0 must
6071 be the correct ISA mode selector except for weak undefined
6072 symbols. */
6073 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6074 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6075 ? (value & 3) != (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
6076 : (value & ((1 << shift) - 1)) != (r_type != R_MIPS_26)))
6077 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6078
6079 value >>= shift;
6080 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6081 overflowed_p = (value >> 26) != ((p + 4) >> (26 + shift));
6082 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6083 }
6084 break;
6085
6086 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
6087 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
6088 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_HI16:
6089 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - dtprel_base (info))
6090 & howto->dst_mask);
6091 break;
6092
6093 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
6094 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL32:
6095 case R_MIPS_TLS_DTPREL64:
6096 case R_MIPS16_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
6097 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_DTPREL_LO16:
6098 value = (symbol + addend - dtprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
6099 break;
6100
6101 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
6102 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
6103 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
6104 value = (mips_elf_high (addend + symbol - tprel_base (info))
6105 & howto->dst_mask);
6106 break;
6107
6108 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
6109 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL32:
6110 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL64:
6111 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
6112 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
6113 value = (symbol + addend - tprel_base (info)) & howto->dst_mask;
6114 break;
6115
6116 case R_MIPS_HI16:
6117 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
6118 case R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
6119 if (!gp_disp_p)
6120 {
6121 value = mips_elf_high (addend + symbol);
6122 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6123 }
6124 else
6125 {
6126 /* For MIPS16 ABI code we generate this sequence
6127 0: li $v0,%hi(_gp_disp)
6128 4: addiupc $v1,%lo(_gp_disp)
6129 8: sll $v0,16
6130 12: addu $v0,$v1
6131 14: move $gp,$v0
6132 So the offsets of hi and lo relocs are the same, but the
6133 base $pc is that used by the ADDIUPC instruction at $t9 + 4.
6134 ADDIUPC clears the low two bits of the instruction address,
6135 so the base is ($t9 + 4) & ~3. */
6136 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_HI16)
6137 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - ((p + 4) & ~(bfd_vma) 0x3));
6138 /* The microMIPS .cpload sequence uses the same assembly
6139 instructions as the traditional psABI version, but the
6140 incoming $t9 has the low bit set. */
6141 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16)
6142 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p - 1);
6143 else
6144 value = mips_elf_high (addend + gp - p);
6145 }
6146 break;
6147
6148 case R_MIPS_LO16:
6149 case R_MIPS16_LO16:
6150 case R_MICROMIPS_LO16:
6151 case R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16:
6152 if (!gp_disp_p)
6153 value = (symbol + addend) & howto->dst_mask;
6154 else
6155 {
6156 /* See the comment for R_MIPS16_HI16 above for the reason
6157 for this conditional. */
6158 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_LO16)
6159 value = addend + gp - (p & ~(bfd_vma) 0x3);
6160 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
6161 || r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16)
6162 value = addend + gp - p + 3;
6163 else
6164 value = addend + gp - p + 4;
6165 /* The MIPS ABI requires checking the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation
6166 for overflow. But, on, say, IRIX5, relocations against
6167 _gp_disp are normally generated from the .cpload
6168 pseudo-op. It generates code that normally looks like
6169 this:
6170
6171 lui $gp,%hi(_gp_disp)
6172 addiu $gp,$gp,%lo(_gp_disp)
6173 addu $gp,$gp,$t9
6174
6175 Here $t9 holds the address of the function being called,
6176 as required by the MIPS ELF ABI. The R_MIPS_LO16
6177 relocation can easily overflow in this situation, but the
6178 R_MIPS_HI16 relocation will handle the overflow.
6179 Therefore, we consider this a bug in the MIPS ABI, and do
6180 not check for overflow here. */
6181 }
6182 break;
6183
6184 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
6185 case R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
6186 /* Because we don't merge literal sections, we can handle this
6187 just like R_MIPS_GPREL16. In the long run, we should merge
6188 shared literals, and then we will need to additional work
6189 here. */
6190
6191 /* Fall through. */
6192
6193 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
6194 /* The R_MIPS16_GPREL performs the same calculation as
6195 R_MIPS_GPREL16, but stores the relocated bits in a different
6196 order. We don't need to do anything special here; the
6197 differences are handled in mips_elf_perform_relocation. */
6198 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
6199 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
6200 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
6201 /* Only sign-extend the addend if it was extracted from the
6202 instruction. If the addend was separate, leave it alone,
6203 otherwise we may lose significant bits. */
6204 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6205 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
6206 value = symbol + addend - gp;
6207 /* If the symbol was local, any earlier relocatable links will
6208 have adjusted its addend with the gp offset, so compensate
6209 for that now. Don't do it for symbols forced local in this
6210 link, though, since they won't have had the gp offset applied
6211 to them before. */
6212 if (was_local_p)
6213 value += gp0;
6214 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6215 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6216 break;
6217
6218 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
6219 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
6220 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
6221 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
6222 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
6223 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
6224 /* VxWorks does not have separate local and global semantics for
6225 R_MIPS*_GOT16; every relocation evaluates to "G". */
6226 if (!htab->is_vxworks && local_p)
6227 {
6228 value = mips_elf_got16_entry (abfd, input_bfd, info,
6229 symbol + addend, !was_local_p);
6230 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
6231 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6232 value
6233 = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
6234 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6235 break;
6236 }
6237
6238 /* Fall through. */
6239
6240 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
6241 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6242 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
6243 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
6244 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
6245 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6246 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
6247 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
6248 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
6249 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
6250 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
6251 value = g;
6252 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6253 break;
6254
6255 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
6256 value = (addend + symbol + gp0 - gp);
6257 if (!save_addend)
6258 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6259 break;
6260
6261 case R_MIPS_PC16:
6262 case R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2:
6263 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6264 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 18);
6265
6266 /* No need to exclude weak undefined symbols here as they resolve
6267 to 0 and never set `*cross_mode_jump_p', so this alignment check
6268 will never trigger for them. */
6269 if (*cross_mode_jump_p
6270 ? ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 1
6271 : ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 0)
6272 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6273
6274 value = symbol + addend - p;
6275 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6276 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 18);
6277 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6278 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6279 break;
6280
6281 case R_MIPS16_PC16_S1:
6282 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6283 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 17);
6284
6285 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6286 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6287 ? ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 0
6288 : ((symbol + addend) & 1) == 0))
6289 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6290
6291 value = symbol + addend - p;
6292 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6293 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 17);
6294 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6295 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6296 break;
6297
6298 case R_MIPS_PC21_S2:
6299 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6300 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 23);
6301
6302 if ((symbol + addend) & 3)
6303 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6304
6305 value = symbol + addend - p;
6306 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6307 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 23);
6308 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6309 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6310 break;
6311
6312 case R_MIPS_PC26_S2:
6313 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6314 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 28);
6315
6316 if ((symbol + addend) & 3)
6317 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6318
6319 value = symbol + addend - p;
6320 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6321 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 28);
6322 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6323 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6324 break;
6325
6326 case R_MIPS_PC18_S3:
6327 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6328 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 21);
6329
6330 if ((symbol + addend) & 7)
6331 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6332
6333 value = symbol + addend - ((p | 7) ^ 7);
6334 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6335 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 21);
6336 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6337 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6338 break;
6339
6340 case R_MIPS_PC19_S2:
6341 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6342 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 21);
6343
6344 if ((symbol + addend) & 3)
6345 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6346
6347 value = symbol + addend - p;
6348 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6349 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 21);
6350 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6351 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6352 break;
6353
6354 case R_MIPS_PCHI16:
6355 value = mips_elf_high (symbol + addend - p);
6356 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6357 break;
6358
6359 case R_MIPS_PCLO16:
6360 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6361 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 16);
6362 value = symbol + addend - p;
6363 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6364 break;
6365
6366 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
6367 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6368 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 8);
6369
6370 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6371 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6372 ? ((symbol + addend + 2) & 3) != 0
6373 : ((symbol + addend + 2) & 1) == 0))
6374 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6375
6376 value = symbol + addend - p;
6377 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6378 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 8);
6379 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6380 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6381 break;
6382
6383 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
6384 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6385 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 11);
6386
6387 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6388 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6389 ? ((symbol + addend + 2) & 3) != 0
6390 : ((symbol + addend + 2) & 1) == 0))
6391 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6392
6393 value = symbol + addend - p;
6394 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6395 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 11);
6396 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6397 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6398 break;
6399
6400 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
6401 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6402 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 17);
6403
6404 if ((was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6405 && (*cross_mode_jump_p
6406 ? ((symbol + addend) & 3) != 0
6407 : ((symbol + addend) & 1) == 0))
6408 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6409
6410 value = symbol + addend - p;
6411 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6412 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 17);
6413 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6414 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6415 break;
6416
6417 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
6418 if (howto->partial_inplace)
6419 addend = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (addend, 25);
6420 value = symbol + addend - ((p | 3) ^ 3);
6421 if (was_local_p || h->root.root.type != bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6422 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 25);
6423 value >>= howto->rightshift;
6424 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6425 break;
6426
6427 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
6428 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
6429 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
6430 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
6431 /* We're allowed to handle these two relocations identically.
6432 The dynamic linker is allowed to handle the CALL relocations
6433 differently by creating a lazy evaluation stub. */
6434 value = g;
6435 value = mips_elf_high (value);
6436 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6437 break;
6438
6439 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
6440 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
6441 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
6442 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
6443 value = g & howto->dst_mask;
6444 break;
6445
6446 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6447 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
6448 value = mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, NULL);
6449 if (value == MINUS_ONE)
6450 return bfd_reloc_outofrange;
6451 value = mips_elf_got_offset_from_index (info, abfd, input_bfd, value);
6452 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6453 break;
6454
6455 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
6456 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
6457 if (local_p)
6458 mips_elf_got_page (abfd, input_bfd, info, symbol + addend, &value);
6459 else
6460 value = addend;
6461 overflowed_p = mips_elf_overflow_p (value, 16);
6462 break;
6463
6464 case R_MIPS_SUB:
6465 case R_MICROMIPS_SUB:
6466 value = symbol - addend;
6467 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6468 break;
6469
6470 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
6471 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
6472 value = mips_elf_higher (addend + symbol);
6473 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6474 break;
6475
6476 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
6477 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
6478 value = mips_elf_highest (addend + symbol);
6479 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6480 break;
6481
6482 case R_MIPS_SCN_DISP:
6483 case R_MICROMIPS_SCN_DISP:
6484 value = symbol + addend - sec->output_offset;
6485 value &= howto->dst_mask;
6486 break;
6487
6488 case R_MIPS_JALR:
6489 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
6490 /* This relocation is only a hint. In some cases, we optimize
6491 it into a bal instruction. But we don't try to optimize
6492 when the symbol does not resolve locally. */
6493 if (h != NULL && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
6494 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6495 /* We can't optimize cross-mode jumps either. */
6496 if (*cross_mode_jump_p)
6497 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6498 value = symbol + addend;
6499 /* Neither we can non-instruction-aligned targets. */
6500 if (r_type == R_MIPS_JALR ? (value & 3) != 0 : (value & 1) == 0)
6501 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6502 break;
6503
6504 case R_MIPS_PJUMP:
6505 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
6506 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
6507 /* We don't do anything with these at present. */
6508 return bfd_reloc_continue;
6509
6510 default:
6511 /* An unrecognized relocation type. */
6512 return bfd_reloc_notsupported;
6513 }
6514
6515 /* Store the VALUE for our caller. */
6516 *valuep = value;
6517 return overflowed_p ? bfd_reloc_overflow : bfd_reloc_ok;
6518 }
6519
6520 /* It has been determined that the result of the RELOCATION is the
6521 VALUE. Use HOWTO to place VALUE into the output file at the
6522 appropriate position. The SECTION is the section to which the
6523 relocation applies.
6524 CROSS_MODE_JUMP_P is true if the relocation field
6525 is a MIPS16 or microMIPS jump to standard MIPS code, or vice versa.
6526
6527 Returns FALSE if anything goes wrong. */
6528
6529 static bfd_boolean
6530 mips_elf_perform_relocation (struct bfd_link_info *info,
6531 reloc_howto_type *howto,
6532 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocation,
6533 bfd_vma value, bfd *input_bfd,
6534 asection *input_section, bfd_byte *contents,
6535 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p)
6536 {
6537 bfd_vma x;
6538 bfd_byte *location;
6539 int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, relocation->r_info);
6540
6541 /* Figure out where the relocation is occurring. */
6542 location = contents + relocation->r_offset;
6543
6544 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (input_bfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
6545
6546 /* Obtain the current value. */
6547 x = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents);
6548
6549 /* Clear the field we are setting. */
6550 x &= ~howto->dst_mask;
6551
6552 /* Set the field. */
6553 x |= (value & howto->dst_mask);
6554
6555 /* Detect incorrect JALX usage. If required, turn JAL or BAL into JALX. */
6556 if (!cross_mode_jump_p && jal_reloc_p (r_type))
6557 {
6558 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
6559
6560 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26 ? opcode == 0x7
6561 : r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 ? opcode == 0x3c
6562 : opcode == 0x1d)
6563 {
6564 info->callbacks->einfo
6565 (_("%X%H: unsupported JALX to the same ISA mode\n"),
6566 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6567 return TRUE;
6568 }
6569 }
6570 if (cross_mode_jump_p && jal_reloc_p (r_type))
6571 {
6572 bfd_boolean ok;
6573 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 26;
6574 bfd_vma jalx_opcode;
6575
6576 /* Check to see if the opcode is already JAL or JALX. */
6577 if (r_type == R_MIPS16_26)
6578 {
6579 ok = ((opcode == 0x6) || (opcode == 0x7));
6580 jalx_opcode = 0x7;
6581 }
6582 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
6583 {
6584 ok = ((opcode == 0x3d) || (opcode == 0x3c));
6585 jalx_opcode = 0x3c;
6586 }
6587 else
6588 {
6589 ok = ((opcode == 0x3) || (opcode == 0x1d));
6590 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
6591 }
6592
6593 /* If the opcode is not JAL or JALX, there's a problem. We cannot
6594 convert J or JALS to JALX. */
6595 if (!ok)
6596 {
6597 info->callbacks->einfo
6598 (_("%X%H: unsupported jump between ISA modes; "
6599 "consider recompiling with interlinking enabled\n"),
6600 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6601 return TRUE;
6602 }
6603
6604 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
6605 x = (x & ~(0x3f << 26)) | (jalx_opcode << 26);
6606 }
6607 else if (cross_mode_jump_p && b_reloc_p (r_type))
6608 {
6609 bfd_boolean ok = FALSE;
6610 bfd_vma opcode = x >> 16;
6611 bfd_vma jalx_opcode = 0;
6612 bfd_vma sign_bit = 0;
6613 bfd_vma addr;
6614 bfd_vma dest;
6615
6616 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1)
6617 {
6618 ok = opcode == 0x4060;
6619 jalx_opcode = 0x3c;
6620 sign_bit = 0x10000;
6621 value <<= 1;
6622 }
6623 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_PC16 || r_type == R_MIPS_GNU_REL16_S2)
6624 {
6625 ok = opcode == 0x411;
6626 jalx_opcode = 0x1d;
6627 sign_bit = 0x20000;
6628 value <<= 2;
6629 }
6630
6631 if (ok && !bfd_link_pic (info))
6632 {
6633 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
6634 + input_section->output_offset
6635 + relocation->r_offset
6636 + 4);
6637 dest = (addr
6638 + (((value & ((sign_bit << 1) - 1)) ^ sign_bit) - sign_bit));
6639
6640 if ((addr >> 28) << 28 != (dest >> 28) << 28)
6641 {
6642 info->callbacks->einfo
6643 (_("%X%H: cannot convert branch between ISA modes "
6644 "to JALX: relocation out of range\n"),
6645 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6646 return TRUE;
6647 }
6648
6649 /* Make this the JALX opcode. */
6650 x = ((dest >> 2) & 0x3ffffff) | jalx_opcode << 26;
6651 }
6652 else if (!mips_elf_hash_table (info)->ignore_branch_isa)
6653 {
6654 info->callbacks->einfo
6655 (_("%X%H: unsupported branch between ISA modes\n"),
6656 input_bfd, input_section, relocation->r_offset);
6657 return TRUE;
6658 }
6659 }
6660
6661 /* Try converting JAL to BAL and J(AL)R to B(AL), if the target is in
6662 range. */
6663 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
6664 && !cross_mode_jump_p
6665 && ((JAL_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
6666 && r_type == R_MIPS_26
6667 && (x >> 26) == 0x3) /* jal addr */
6668 || (JALR_TO_BAL_P (input_bfd)
6669 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
6670 && x == 0x0320f809) /* jalr t9 */
6671 || (JR_TO_B_P (input_bfd)
6672 && r_type == R_MIPS_JALR
6673 && (x & ~1) == 0x03200008))) /* jr t9 / jalr zero, t9 */
6674 {
6675 bfd_vma addr;
6676 bfd_vma dest;
6677 bfd_signed_vma off;
6678
6679 addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
6680 + input_section->output_offset
6681 + relocation->r_offset
6682 + 4);
6683 if (r_type == R_MIPS_26)
6684 dest = (value << 2) | ((addr >> 28) << 28);
6685 else
6686 dest = value;
6687 off = dest - addr;
6688 if (off <= 0x1ffff && off >= -0x20000)
6689 {
6690 if ((x & ~1) == 0x03200008) /* jr t9 / jalr zero, t9 */
6691 x = 0x10000000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* b addr */
6692 else
6693 x = 0x04110000 | (((bfd_vma) off >> 2) & 0xffff); /* bal addr */
6694 }
6695 }
6696
6697 /* Put the value into the output. */
6698 mips_elf_store_contents (howto, relocation, input_bfd, contents, x);
6699
6700 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (input_bfd, r_type, !bfd_link_relocatable (info),
6701 location);
6702
6703 return TRUE;
6704 }
6705 \f
6706 /* Create a rel.dyn relocation for the dynamic linker to resolve. REL
6707 is the original relocation, which is now being transformed into a
6708 dynamic relocation. The ADDENDP is adjusted if necessary; the
6709 caller should store the result in place of the original addend. */
6710
6711 static bfd_boolean
6712 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation (bfd *output_bfd,
6713 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6714 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
6715 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6716 asection *sec, bfd_vma symbol,
6717 bfd_vma *addendp, asection *input_section)
6718 {
6719 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel[3];
6720 asection *sreloc;
6721 bfd *dynobj;
6722 int r_type;
6723 long indx;
6724 bfd_boolean defined_p;
6725 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6726
6727 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
6728 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
6729
6730 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
6731 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
6732 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
6733 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc != NULL);
6734 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->contents != NULL);
6735 BFD_ASSERT (sreloc->reloc_count * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd)
6736 < sreloc->size);
6737
6738 outrel[0].r_offset =
6739 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[0].r_offset);
6740 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6741 {
6742 outrel[1].r_offset =
6743 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[1].r_offset);
6744 outrel[2].r_offset =
6745 _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section, rel[2].r_offset);
6746 }
6747
6748 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_ONE)
6749 /* The relocation field has been deleted. */
6750 return TRUE;
6751
6752 if (outrel[0].r_offset == MINUS_TWO)
6753 {
6754 /* The relocation field has been converted into a relative value of
6755 some sort. Functions like _bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame expect
6756 the field to be fully relocated, so add in the symbol's value. */
6757 *addendp += symbol;
6758 return TRUE;
6759 }
6760
6761 /* We must now calculate the dynamic symbol table index to use
6762 in the relocation. */
6763 if (h != NULL && ! SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &h->root))
6764 {
6765 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks || h->global_got_area != GGA_NONE);
6766 indx = h->root.dynindx;
6767 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6768 defined_p = h->root.def_regular;
6769 else
6770 /* ??? glibc's ld.so just adds the final GOT entry to the
6771 relocation field. It therefore treats relocs against
6772 defined symbols in the same way as relocs against
6773 undefined symbols. */
6774 defined_p = FALSE;
6775 }
6776 else
6777 {
6778 if (sec != NULL && bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
6779 indx = 0;
6780 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
6781 {
6782 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
6783 return FALSE;
6784 }
6785 else
6786 {
6787 indx = elf_section_data (sec->output_section)->dynindx;
6788 if (indx == 0)
6789 {
6790 asection *osec = htab->root.text_index_section;
6791 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
6792 }
6793 if (indx == 0)
6794 abort ();
6795 }
6796
6797 /* Instead of generating a relocation using the section
6798 symbol, we may as well make it a fully relative
6799 relocation. We want to avoid generating relocations to
6800 local symbols because we used to generate them
6801 incorrectly, without adding the original symbol value,
6802 which is mandated by the ABI for section symbols. In
6803 order to give dynamic loaders and applications time to
6804 phase out the incorrect use, we refrain from emitting
6805 section-relative relocations. It's not like they're
6806 useful, after all. This should be a bit more efficient
6807 as well. */
6808 /* ??? Although this behavior is compatible with glibc's ld.so,
6809 the ABI says that relocations against STN_UNDEF should have
6810 a symbol value of 0. Irix rld honors this, so relocations
6811 against STN_UNDEF have no effect. */
6812 if (!SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
6813 indx = 0;
6814 defined_p = TRUE;
6815 }
6816
6817 /* If the relocation was previously an absolute relocation and
6818 this symbol will not be referred to by the relocation, we must
6819 adjust it by the value we give it in the dynamic symbol table.
6820 Otherwise leave the job up to the dynamic linker. */
6821 if (defined_p && r_type != R_MIPS_REL32)
6822 *addendp += symbol;
6823
6824 if (htab->is_vxworks)
6825 /* VxWorks uses non-relative relocations for this. */
6826 outrel[0].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_MIPS_32);
6827 else
6828 /* The relocation is always an REL32 relocation because we don't
6829 know where the shared library will wind up at load-time. */
6830 outrel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, (unsigned long) indx,
6831 R_MIPS_REL32);
6832
6833 /* For strict adherence to the ABI specification, we should
6834 generate a R_MIPS_64 relocation record by itself before the
6835 _REL32/_64 record as well, such that the addend is read in as
6836 a 64-bit value (REL32 is a 32-bit relocation, after all).
6837 However, since none of the existing ELF64 MIPS dynamic
6838 loaders seems to care, we don't waste space with these
6839 artificial relocations. If this turns out to not be true,
6840 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocation() should be tweaked so
6841 as to make room for a pair of dynamic relocations per
6842 invocation if ABI_64_P, and here we should generate an
6843 additional relocation record with R_MIPS_64 by itself for a
6844 NULL symbol before this relocation record. */
6845 outrel[1].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0,
6846 ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
6847 ? R_MIPS_64
6848 : R_MIPS_NONE);
6849 outrel[2].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_NONE);
6850
6851 /* Adjust the output offset of the relocation to reference the
6852 correct location in the output file. */
6853 outrel[0].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6854 + input_section->output_offset);
6855 outrel[1].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6856 + input_section->output_offset);
6857 outrel[2].r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
6858 + input_section->output_offset);
6859
6860 /* Put the relocation back out. We have to use the special
6861 relocation outputter in the 64-bit case since the 64-bit
6862 relocation format is non-standard. */
6863 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
6864 {
6865 (*get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd)->s->swap_reloc_out)
6866 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6867 (sreloc->contents
6868 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)));
6869 }
6870 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
6871 {
6872 /* VxWorks uses RELA rather than REL dynamic relocations. */
6873 outrel[0].r_addend = *addendp;
6874 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out
6875 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6876 (sreloc->contents
6877 + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)));
6878 }
6879 else
6880 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out
6881 (output_bfd, &outrel[0],
6882 (sreloc->contents + sreloc->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
6883
6884 /* We've now added another relocation. */
6885 ++sreloc->reloc_count;
6886
6887 /* Make sure the output section is writable. The dynamic linker
6888 will be writing to it. */
6889 elf_section_data (input_section->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_flags
6890 |= SHF_WRITE;
6891
6892 /* On IRIX5, make an entry of compact relocation info. */
6893 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix5)
6894 {
6895 asection *scpt = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
6896 bfd_byte *cr;
6897
6898 if (scpt)
6899 {
6900 Elf32_crinfo cptrel;
6901
6902 mips_elf_set_cr_format (cptrel, CRF_MIPS_LONG);
6903 cptrel.vaddr = (rel->r_offset
6904 + input_section->output_section->vma
6905 + input_section->output_offset);
6906 if (r_type == R_MIPS_REL32)
6907 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_REL32);
6908 else
6909 mips_elf_set_cr_type (cptrel, CRT_MIPS_WORD);
6910 mips_elf_set_cr_dist2to (cptrel, 0);
6911 cptrel.konst = *addendp;
6912
6913 cr = (scpt->contents
6914 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
6915 mips_elf_set_cr_relvaddr (cptrel, 0);
6916 bfd_elf32_swap_crinfo_out (output_bfd, &cptrel,
6917 ((Elf32_External_crinfo *) cr
6918 + scpt->reloc_count));
6919 ++scpt->reloc_count;
6920 }
6921 }
6922
6923 /* If we've written this relocation for a readonly section,
6924 we need to set DF_TEXTREL again, so that we do not delete the
6925 DT_TEXTREL tag. */
6926 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (input_section))
6927 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
6928
6929 return TRUE;
6930 }
6931 \f
6932 /* Return the MACH for a MIPS e_flags value. */
6933
6934 unsigned long
6935 _bfd_elf_mips_mach (flagword flags)
6936 {
6937 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_MACH)
6938 {
6939 case E_MIPS_MACH_3900:
6940 return bfd_mach_mips3900;
6941
6942 case E_MIPS_MACH_4010:
6943 return bfd_mach_mips4010;
6944
6945 case E_MIPS_MACH_4100:
6946 return bfd_mach_mips4100;
6947
6948 case E_MIPS_MACH_4111:
6949 return bfd_mach_mips4111;
6950
6951 case E_MIPS_MACH_4120:
6952 return bfd_mach_mips4120;
6953
6954 case E_MIPS_MACH_4650:
6955 return bfd_mach_mips4650;
6956
6957 case E_MIPS_MACH_5400:
6958 return bfd_mach_mips5400;
6959
6960 case E_MIPS_MACH_5500:
6961 return bfd_mach_mips5500;
6962
6963 case E_MIPS_MACH_5900:
6964 return bfd_mach_mips5900;
6965
6966 case E_MIPS_MACH_9000:
6967 return bfd_mach_mips9000;
6968
6969 case E_MIPS_MACH_SB1:
6970 return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
6971
6972 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E:
6973 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
6974
6975 case E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F:
6976 return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
6977
6978 case E_MIPS_MACH_GS464:
6979 return bfd_mach_mips_gs464;
6980
6981 case E_MIPS_MACH_GS464E:
6982 return bfd_mach_mips_gs464e;
6983
6984 case E_MIPS_MACH_GS264E:
6985 return bfd_mach_mips_gs264e;
6986
6987 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON3:
6988 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon3;
6989
6990 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2:
6991 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon2;
6992
6993 case E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON:
6994 return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
6995
6996 case E_MIPS_MACH_XLR:
6997 return bfd_mach_mips_xlr;
6998
6999 case E_MIPS_MACH_IAMR2:
7000 return bfd_mach_mips_interaptiv_mr2;
7001
7002 default:
7003 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
7004 {
7005 default:
7006 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1:
7007 return bfd_mach_mips3000;
7008
7009 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2:
7010 return bfd_mach_mips6000;
7011
7012 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3:
7013 return bfd_mach_mips4000;
7014
7015 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4:
7016 return bfd_mach_mips8000;
7017
7018 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5:
7019 return bfd_mach_mips5;
7020
7021 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32:
7022 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32;
7023
7024 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64:
7025 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64;
7026
7027 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2:
7028 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2;
7029
7030 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2:
7031 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2;
7032
7033 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6:
7034 return bfd_mach_mipsisa32r6;
7035
7036 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6:
7037 return bfd_mach_mipsisa64r6;
7038 }
7039 }
7040
7041 return 0;
7042 }
7043
7044 /* Return printable name for ABI. */
7045
7046 static INLINE char *
7047 elf_mips_abi_name (bfd *abfd)
7048 {
7049 flagword flags;
7050
7051 flags = elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags;
7052 switch (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
7053 {
7054 case 0:
7055 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
7056 return "N32";
7057 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
7058 return "64";
7059 else
7060 return "none";
7061 case E_MIPS_ABI_O32:
7062 return "O32";
7063 case E_MIPS_ABI_O64:
7064 return "O64";
7065 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32:
7066 return "EABI32";
7067 case E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64:
7068 return "EABI64";
7069 default:
7070 return "unknown abi";
7071 }
7072 }
7073 \f
7074 /* MIPS ELF uses two common sections. One is the usual one, and the
7075 other is for small objects. All the small objects are kept
7076 together, and then referenced via the gp pointer, which yields
7077 faster assembler code. This is what we use for the small common
7078 section. This approach is copied from ecoff.c. */
7079 static asection mips_elf_scom_section;
7080 static asymbol mips_elf_scom_symbol;
7081 static asymbol *mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
7082
7083 /* MIPS ELF also uses an acommon section, which represents an
7084 allocated common symbol which may be overridden by a
7085 definition in a shared library. */
7086 static asection mips_elf_acom_section;
7087 static asymbol mips_elf_acom_symbol;
7088 static asymbol *mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
7089
7090 /* This is used for both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
7091
7092 void
7093 _bfd_mips_elf_symbol_processing (bfd *abfd, asymbol *asym)
7094 {
7095 elf_symbol_type *elfsym;
7096
7097 /* Handle the special MIPS section numbers that a symbol may use. */
7098 elfsym = (elf_symbol_type *) asym;
7099 switch (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_shndx)
7100 {
7101 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
7102 /* This section is used in a dynamically linked executable file.
7103 It is an allocated common section. The dynamic linker can
7104 either resolve these symbols to something in a shared
7105 library, or it can just leave them here. For our purposes,
7106 we can consider these symbols to be in a new section. */
7107 if (mips_elf_acom_section.name == NULL)
7108 {
7109 /* Initialize the acommon section. */
7110 mips_elf_acom_section.name = ".acommon";
7111 mips_elf_acom_section.flags = SEC_ALLOC;
7112 mips_elf_acom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
7113 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
7114 mips_elf_acom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr;
7115 mips_elf_acom_symbol.name = ".acommon";
7116 mips_elf_acom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
7117 mips_elf_acom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
7118 mips_elf_acom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_acom_symbol;
7119 }
7120 asym->section = &mips_elf_acom_section;
7121 break;
7122
7123 case SHN_COMMON:
7124 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
7125 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols on IRIX5. */
7126 if (asym->value > elf_gp_size (abfd)
7127 || ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_TLS
7128 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
7129 break;
7130 /* Fall through. */
7131 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
7132 if (mips_elf_scom_section.name == NULL)
7133 {
7134 /* Initialize the small common section. */
7135 mips_elf_scom_section.name = ".scommon";
7136 mips_elf_scom_section.flags = SEC_IS_COMMON;
7137 mips_elf_scom_section.output_section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
7138 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
7139 mips_elf_scom_section.symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr;
7140 mips_elf_scom_symbol.name = ".scommon";
7141 mips_elf_scom_symbol.flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM;
7142 mips_elf_scom_symbol.section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
7143 mips_elf_scom_symbol_ptr = &mips_elf_scom_symbol;
7144 }
7145 asym->section = &mips_elf_scom_section;
7146 asym->value = elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_size;
7147 break;
7148
7149 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
7150 asym->section = bfd_und_section_ptr;
7151 break;
7152
7153 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
7154 {
7155 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".text");
7156
7157 if (section != NULL)
7158 {
7159 asym->section = section;
7160 /* MIPS_TEXT is a bit special, the address is not an offset
7161 to the base of the .text section. So subtract the section
7162 base address to make it an offset. */
7163 asym->value -= section->vma;
7164 }
7165 }
7166 break;
7167
7168 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
7169 {
7170 asection *section = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".data");
7171
7172 if (section != NULL)
7173 {
7174 asym->section = section;
7175 /* MIPS_DATA is a bit special, the address is not an offset
7176 to the base of the .data section. So subtract the section
7177 base address to make it an offset. */
7178 asym->value -= section->vma;
7179 }
7180 }
7181 break;
7182 }
7183
7184 /* If this is an odd-valued function symbol, assume it's a MIPS16
7185 or microMIPS one. */
7186 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_info) == STT_FUNC
7187 && (asym->value & 1) != 0)
7188 {
7189 asym->value--;
7190 if (MICROMIPS_P (abfd))
7191 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
7192 = ELF_ST_SET_MICROMIPS (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
7193 else
7194 elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other
7195 = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS16 (elfsym->internal_elf_sym.st_other);
7196 }
7197 }
7198 \f
7199 /* Implement elf_backend_eh_frame_address_size. This differs from
7200 the default in the way it handles EABI64.
7201
7202 EABI64 was originally specified as an LP64 ABI, and that is what
7203 -mabi=eabi normally gives on a 64-bit target. However, gcc has
7204 historically accepted the combination of -mabi=eabi and -mlong32,
7205 and this ILP32 variation has become semi-official over time.
7206 Both forms use elf32 and have pointer-sized FDE addresses.
7207
7208 If an EABI object was generated by GCC 4.0 or above, it will have
7209 an empty .gcc_compiled_longXX section, where XX is the size of longs
7210 in bits. Unfortunately, ILP32 objects generated by earlier compilers
7211 have no special marking to distinguish them from LP64 objects.
7212
7213 We don't want users of the official LP64 ABI to be punished for the
7214 existence of the ILP32 variant, but at the same time, we don't want
7215 to mistakenly interpret pre-4.0 ILP32 objects as being LP64 objects.
7216 We therefore take the following approach:
7217
7218 - If ABFD contains a .gcc_compiled_longXX section, use it to
7219 determine the pointer size.
7220
7221 - Otherwise check the type of the first relocation. Assume that
7222 the LP64 ABI is being used if the relocation is of type R_MIPS_64.
7223
7224 - Otherwise punt.
7225
7226 The second check is enough to detect LP64 objects generated by pre-4.0
7227 compilers because, in the kind of output generated by those compilers,
7228 the first relocation will be associated with either a CIE personality
7229 routine or an FDE start address. Furthermore, the compilers never
7230 used a special (non-pointer) encoding for this ABI.
7231
7232 Checking the relocation type should also be safe because there is no
7233 reason to use R_MIPS_64 in an ILP32 object. Pre-4.0 compilers never
7234 did so. */
7235
7236 unsigned int
7237 _bfd_mips_elf_eh_frame_address_size (bfd *abfd, const asection *sec)
7238 {
7239 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS64)
7240 return 8;
7241 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
7242 {
7243 bfd_boolean long32_p, long64_p;
7244
7245 long32_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long32") != 0;
7246 long64_p = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".gcc_compiled_long64") != 0;
7247 if (long32_p && long64_p)
7248 return 0;
7249 if (long32_p)
7250 return 4;
7251 if (long64_p)
7252 return 8;
7253
7254 if (sec->reloc_count > 0
7255 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != NULL
7256 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs[0].r_info)
7257 == R_MIPS_64))
7258 return 8;
7259
7260 return 0;
7261 }
7262 return 4;
7263 }
7264 \f
7265 /* There appears to be a bug in the MIPSpro linker that causes GOT_DISP
7266 relocations against two unnamed section symbols to resolve to the
7267 same address. For example, if we have code like:
7268
7269 lw $4,%got_disp(.data)($gp)
7270 lw $25,%got_disp(.text)($gp)
7271 jalr $25
7272
7273 then the linker will resolve both relocations to .data and the program
7274 will jump there rather than to .text.
7275
7276 We can work around this problem by giving names to local section symbols.
7277 This is also what the MIPSpro tools do. */
7278
7279 bfd_boolean
7280 _bfd_mips_elf_name_local_section_symbols (bfd *abfd)
7281 {
7282 return SGI_COMPAT (abfd);
7283 }
7284 \f
7285 /* Work over a section just before writing it out. This routine is
7286 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. FIXME: We recognize
7287 sections that need the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag by name; there has to be
7288 a better way. */
7289
7290 bfd_boolean
7291 _bfd_mips_elf_section_processing (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr)
7292 {
7293 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO
7294 && hdr->sh_size > 0)
7295 {
7296 bfd_byte buf[4];
7297
7298 BFD_ASSERT (hdr->contents == NULL);
7299
7300 if (hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
7301 {
7302 _bfd_error_handler
7303 (_("%pB: incorrect `.reginfo' section size; "
7304 "expected %" PRIu64 ", got %" PRIu64),
7305 abfd, (uint64_t) sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo),
7306 (uint64_t) hdr->sh_size);
7307 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7308 return FALSE;
7309 }
7310
7311 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
7312 hdr->sh_offset + sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4,
7313 SEEK_SET) != 0)
7314 return FALSE;
7315 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
7316 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
7317 return FALSE;
7318 }
7319
7320 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS
7321 && hdr->bfd_section != NULL
7322 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section) != NULL
7323 && mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata != NULL)
7324 {
7325 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
7326
7327 /* We stored the section contents in the tdata field in the
7328 set_section_contents routine. We save the section contents
7329 so that we don't have to read them again.
7330 At this point we know that elf_gp is set, so we can look
7331 through the section contents to see if there is an
7332 ODK_REGINFO structure. */
7333
7334 contents = mips_elf_section_data (hdr->bfd_section)->u.tdata;
7335 l = contents;
7336 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
7337 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
7338 {
7339 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
7340
7341 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
7342 &intopt);
7343 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
7344 {
7345 _bfd_error_handler
7346 /* xgettext:c-format */
7347 (_("%pB: warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than"
7348 " its header"),
7349 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
7350 break;
7351 }
7352 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7353 {
7354 bfd_byte buf[8];
7355
7356 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
7357 (hdr->sh_offset
7358 + (l - contents)
7359 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
7360 + (sizeof (Elf64_External_RegInfo) - 8)),
7361 SEEK_SET) != 0)
7362 return FALSE;
7363 H_PUT_64 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
7364 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 8, abfd) != 8)
7365 return FALSE;
7366 }
7367 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7368 {
7369 bfd_byte buf[4];
7370
7371 if (bfd_seek (abfd,
7372 (hdr->sh_offset
7373 + (l - contents)
7374 + sizeof (Elf_External_Options)
7375 + (sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo) - 4)),
7376 SEEK_SET) != 0)
7377 return FALSE;
7378 H_PUT_32 (abfd, elf_gp (abfd), buf);
7379 if (bfd_bwrite (buf, 4, abfd) != 4)
7380 return FALSE;
7381 }
7382 l += intopt.size;
7383 }
7384 }
7385
7386 if (hdr->bfd_section != NULL)
7387 {
7388 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, hdr->bfd_section);
7389
7390 /* .sbss is not handled specially here because the GNU/Linux
7391 prelinker can convert .sbss from NOBITS to PROGBITS and
7392 changing it back to NOBITS breaks the binary. The entry in
7393 _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections will ensure the correct flags
7394 are set on .sbss if BFD creates it without reading it from an
7395 input file, and without special handling here the flags set
7396 on it in an input file will be followed. */
7397 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
7398 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0
7399 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0)
7400 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_WRITE | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
7401 else if (strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0)
7402 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC | SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
7403 else if (strcmp (name, ".compact_rel") == 0)
7404 hdr->sh_flags = 0;
7405 else if (strcmp (name, ".rtproc") == 0)
7406 {
7407 if (hdr->sh_addralign != 0 && hdr->sh_entsize == 0)
7408 {
7409 unsigned int adjust;
7410
7411 adjust = hdr->sh_size % hdr->sh_addralign;
7412 if (adjust != 0)
7413 hdr->sh_size += hdr->sh_addralign - adjust;
7414 }
7415 }
7416 }
7417
7418 return TRUE;
7419 }
7420
7421 /* Handle a MIPS specific section when reading an object file. This
7422 is called when elfcode.h finds a section with an unknown type.
7423 This routine supports both the 32-bit and 64-bit ELF ABI.
7424
7425 FIXME: We need to handle the SHF_MIPS_GPREL flag, but I'm not sure
7426 how to. */
7427
7428 bfd_boolean
7429 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
7430 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
7431 const char *name,
7432 int shindex)
7433 {
7434 flagword flags = 0;
7435
7436 /* There ought to be a place to keep ELF backend specific flags, but
7437 at the moment there isn't one. We just keep track of the
7438 sections by their name, instead. Fortunately, the ABI gives
7439 suggested names for all the MIPS specific sections, so we will
7440 probably get away with this. */
7441 switch (hdr->sh_type)
7442 {
7443 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
7444 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") != 0)
7445 return FALSE;
7446 break;
7447 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
7448 if (strcmp (name, ".msym") != 0)
7449 return FALSE;
7450 break;
7451 case SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
7452 if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") != 0)
7453 return FALSE;
7454 break;
7455 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
7456 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
7457 return FALSE;
7458 break;
7459 case SHT_MIPS_UCODE:
7460 if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") != 0)
7461 return FALSE;
7462 break;
7463 case SHT_MIPS_DEBUG:
7464 if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") != 0)
7465 return FALSE;
7466 flags = SEC_DEBUGGING;
7467 break;
7468 case SHT_MIPS_REGINFO:
7469 if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") != 0
7470 || hdr->sh_size != sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo))
7471 return FALSE;
7472 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
7473 break;
7474 case SHT_MIPS_IFACE:
7475 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") != 0)
7476 return FALSE;
7477 break;
7478 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
7479 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
7480 return FALSE;
7481 break;
7482 case SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
7483 if (!MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
7484 return FALSE;
7485 break;
7486 case SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS:
7487 if (!MIPS_ELF_ABIFLAGS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
7488 return FALSE;
7489 flags = (SEC_LINK_ONCE | SEC_LINK_DUPLICATES_SAME_SIZE);
7490 break;
7491 case SHT_MIPS_DWARF:
7492 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
7493 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
7494 return FALSE;
7495 break;
7496 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
7497 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") != 0)
7498 return FALSE;
7499 break;
7500 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
7501 if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
7502 && ! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
7503 return FALSE;
7504 break;
7505 case SHT_MIPS_XHASH:
7506 if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.xhash") != 0)
7507 return FALSE;
7508 default:
7509 break;
7510 }
7511
7512 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
7513 return FALSE;
7514
7515 if (flags)
7516 {
7517 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
7518 (bfd_get_section_flags (abfd,
7519 hdr->bfd_section)
7520 | flags)))
7521 return FALSE;
7522 }
7523
7524 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS)
7525 {
7526 Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 ext;
7527
7528 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
7529 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
7530 return FALSE;
7531 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_in (abfd, &ext,
7532 &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags);
7533 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags.version != 0)
7534 return FALSE;
7535 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
7536 }
7537
7538 /* FIXME: We should record sh_info for a .gptab section. */
7539
7540 /* For a .reginfo section, set the gp value in the tdata information
7541 from the contents of this section. We need the gp value while
7542 processing relocs, so we just get it now. The .reginfo section
7543 is not used in the 64-bit MIPS ELF ABI. */
7544 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_REGINFO)
7545 {
7546 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
7547 Elf32_RegInfo s;
7548
7549 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section,
7550 &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
7551 return FALSE;
7552 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (abfd, &ext, &s);
7553 elf_gp (abfd) = s.ri_gp_value;
7554 }
7555
7556 /* For a SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS section, look for a ODK_REGINFO entry, and
7557 set the gp value based on what we find. We may see both
7558 SHT_MIPS_REGINFO and SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS/ODK_REGINFO; in that case,
7559 they should agree. */
7560 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
7561 {
7562 bfd_byte *contents, *l, *lend;
7563
7564 contents = bfd_malloc (hdr->sh_size);
7565 if (contents == NULL)
7566 return FALSE;
7567 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, hdr->bfd_section, contents,
7568 0, hdr->sh_size))
7569 {
7570 free (contents);
7571 return FALSE;
7572 }
7573 l = contents;
7574 lend = contents + hdr->sh_size;
7575 while (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options) <= lend)
7576 {
7577 Elf_Internal_Options intopt;
7578
7579 bfd_mips_elf_swap_options_in (abfd, (Elf_External_Options *) l,
7580 &intopt);
7581 if (intopt.size < sizeof (Elf_External_Options))
7582 {
7583 _bfd_error_handler
7584 /* xgettext:c-format */
7585 (_("%pB: warning: bad `%s' option size %u smaller than"
7586 " its header"),
7587 abfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd), intopt.size);
7588 break;
7589 }
7590 if (ABI_64_P (abfd) && intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7591 {
7592 Elf64_Internal_RegInfo intreg;
7593
7594 bfd_mips_elf64_swap_reginfo_in
7595 (abfd,
7596 ((Elf64_External_RegInfo *)
7597 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
7598 &intreg);
7599 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
7600 }
7601 else if (intopt.kind == ODK_REGINFO)
7602 {
7603 Elf32_RegInfo intreg;
7604
7605 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in
7606 (abfd,
7607 ((Elf32_External_RegInfo *)
7608 (l + sizeof (Elf_External_Options))),
7609 &intreg);
7610 elf_gp (abfd) = intreg.ri_gp_value;
7611 }
7612 l += intopt.size;
7613 }
7614 free (contents);
7615 }
7616
7617 return TRUE;
7618 }
7619
7620 /* Set the correct type for a MIPS ELF section. We do this by the
7621 section name, which is a hack, but ought to work. This routine is
7622 used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
7623
7624 bfd_boolean
7625 _bfd_mips_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr, asection *sec)
7626 {
7627 const char *name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
7628
7629 if (strcmp (name, ".liblist") == 0)
7630 {
7631 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST;
7632 hdr->sh_info = sec->size / sizeof (Elf32_Lib);
7633 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
7634 }
7635 else if (strcmp (name, ".conflict") == 0)
7636 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONFLICT;
7637 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."))
7638 {
7639 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_GPTAB;
7640 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
7641 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
7642 }
7643 else if (strcmp (name, ".ucode") == 0)
7644 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_UCODE;
7645 else if (strcmp (name, ".mdebug") == 0)
7646 {
7647 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DEBUG;
7648 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .mdebug section has an
7649 entsize of 0. FIXME: Does this matter? */
7650 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
7651 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7652 else
7653 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
7654 }
7655 else if (strcmp (name, ".reginfo") == 0)
7656 {
7657 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_REGINFO;
7658 /* In a shared object on IRIX 5.3, the .reginfo section has an
7659 entsize of 0x18. FIXME: Does this matter? */
7660 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7661 {
7662 if ((abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
7663 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
7664 else
7665 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
7666 }
7667 else
7668 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo);
7669 }
7670 else if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7671 && (strcmp (name, ".hash") == 0
7672 || strcmp (name, ".dynamic") == 0
7673 || strcmp (name, ".dynstr") == 0))
7674 {
7675 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
7676 hdr->sh_entsize = 0;
7677 #if 0
7678 /* This isn't how the IRIX6 linker behaves. */
7679 hdr->sh_info = SIZEOF_MIPS_DYNSYM_SECNAMES;
7680 #endif
7681 }
7682 else if (strcmp (name, ".got") == 0
7683 || strcmp (name, ".srdata") == 0
7684 || strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
7685 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0
7686 || strcmp (name, ".lit4") == 0
7687 || strcmp (name, ".lit8") == 0)
7688 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_GPREL;
7689 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.interfaces") == 0)
7690 {
7691 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_IFACE;
7692 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7693 }
7694 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"))
7695 {
7696 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_CONTENT;
7697 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7698 /* The sh_info field is set in final_write_processing. */
7699 }
7700 else if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (name))
7701 {
7702 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
7703 hdr->sh_entsize = 1;
7704 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7705 }
7706 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.abiflags"))
7707 {
7708 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS;
7709 hdr->sh_entsize = sizeof (Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0);
7710 }
7711 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_")
7712 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".zdebug_"))
7713 {
7714 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_DWARF;
7715
7716 /* Irix facilities such as libexc expect a single .debug_frame
7717 per executable, the system ones have NOSTRIP set and the linker
7718 doesn't merge sections with different flags so ... */
7719 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".debug_frame"))
7720 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7721 }
7722 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.symlib") == 0)
7723 {
7724 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB;
7725 /* The sh_link and sh_info fields are set in
7726 final_write_processing. */
7727 }
7728 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events")
7729 || CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"))
7730 {
7731 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_EVENTS;
7732 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_MIPS_NOSTRIP;
7733 /* The sh_link field is set in final_write_processing. */
7734 }
7735 else if (strcmp (name, ".msym") == 0)
7736 {
7737 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_MSYM;
7738 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
7739 hdr->sh_entsize = 8;
7740 }
7741 else if (strcmp (name, ".MIPS.xhash") == 0)
7742 {
7743 hdr->sh_type = SHT_MIPS_XHASH;
7744 hdr->sh_flags |= SHF_ALLOC;
7745 hdr->sh_entsize = get_elf_backend_data(abfd)->s->arch_size == 64 ? 0 : 4;
7746 }
7747
7748 /* The generic elf_fake_sections will set up REL_HDR using the default
7749 kind of relocations. We used to set up a second header for the
7750 non-default kind of relocations here, but only NewABI would use
7751 these, and the IRIX ld doesn't like resulting empty RELA sections.
7752 Thus we create those header only on demand now. */
7753
7754 return TRUE;
7755 }
7756
7757 /* Given a BFD section, try to locate the corresponding ELF section
7758 index. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI.
7759 Actually, it's not clear to me that the 64-bit ABI supports these,
7760 but for non-PIC objects we will certainly want support for at least
7761 the .scommon section. */
7762
7763 bfd_boolean
7764 _bfd_mips_elf_section_from_bfd_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7765 asection *sec, int *retval)
7766 {
7767 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".scommon") == 0)
7768 {
7769 *retval = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
7770 return TRUE;
7771 }
7772 if (strcmp (bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec), ".acommon") == 0)
7773 {
7774 *retval = SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON;
7775 return TRUE;
7776 }
7777 return FALSE;
7778 }
7779 \f
7780 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
7781 file. We must handle the special MIPS section numbers here. */
7782
7783 bfd_boolean
7784 _bfd_mips_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
7785 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym, const char **namep,
7786 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7787 asection **secp, bfd_vma *valp)
7788 {
7789 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7790 && (abfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0
7791 && strcmp (*namep, "_rld_new_interface") == 0)
7792 {
7793 /* Skip IRIX5 rld entry name. */
7794 *namep = NULL;
7795 return TRUE;
7796 }
7797
7798 /* Shared objects may have a dynamic symbol '_gp_disp' defined as
7799 a SECTION *ABS*. This causes ld to think it can resolve _gp_disp
7800 by setting a DT_NEEDED for the shared object. Since _gp_disp is
7801 a magic symbol resolved by the linker, we ignore this bogus definition
7802 of _gp_disp. New ABI objects do not suffer from this problem so this
7803 is not done for them. */
7804 if (!NEWABI_P(abfd)
7805 && (sym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
7806 && (strcmp (*namep, "_gp_disp") == 0))
7807 {
7808 *namep = NULL;
7809 return TRUE;
7810 }
7811
7812 switch (sym->st_shndx)
7813 {
7814 case SHN_COMMON:
7815 /* Common symbols less than the GP size are automatically
7816 treated as SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON symbols. */
7817 if (sym->st_size > elf_gp_size (abfd)
7818 || ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_TLS
7819 || IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
7820 break;
7821 /* Fall through. */
7822 case SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON:
7823 *secp = bfd_make_section_old_way (abfd, ".scommon");
7824 (*secp)->flags |= SEC_IS_COMMON;
7825 *valp = sym->st_size;
7826 break;
7827
7828 case SHN_MIPS_TEXT:
7829 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
7830 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section == NULL)
7831 {
7832 asymbol *elf_text_symbol;
7833 asection *elf_text_section;
7834 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
7835
7836 elf_text_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7837 if (elf_text_section == NULL)
7838 return FALSE;
7839
7840 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
7841 elf_text_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7842 if (elf_text_symbol == NULL)
7843 return FALSE;
7844
7845 /* Initialize the section. */
7846
7847 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section = elf_text_section;
7848 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol = elf_text_symbol;
7849
7850 elf_text_section->symbol = elf_text_symbol;
7851 elf_text_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_symbol;
7852
7853 elf_text_section->name = ".text";
7854 elf_text_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
7855 elf_text_section->output_section = NULL;
7856 elf_text_section->owner = abfd;
7857 elf_text_symbol->name = ".text";
7858 elf_text_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
7859 elf_text_symbol->section = elf_text_section;
7860 }
7861 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
7862 bfd_link_pic (info). I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
7863 so I took it out. */
7864 *secp = mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_text_section;
7865 break;
7866
7867 case SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON:
7868 /* Fall through. XXX Can we treat this as allocated data? */
7869 case SHN_MIPS_DATA:
7870 /* This section is used in a shared object. */
7871 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section == NULL)
7872 {
7873 asymbol *elf_data_symbol;
7874 asection *elf_data_section;
7875 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (asection);
7876
7877 elf_data_section = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7878 if (elf_data_section == NULL)
7879 return FALSE;
7880
7881 amt = sizeof (asymbol);
7882 elf_data_symbol = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
7883 if (elf_data_symbol == NULL)
7884 return FALSE;
7885
7886 /* Initialize the section. */
7887
7888 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section = elf_data_section;
7889 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol = elf_data_symbol;
7890
7891 elf_data_section->symbol = elf_data_symbol;
7892 elf_data_section->symbol_ptr_ptr = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_symbol;
7893
7894 elf_data_section->name = ".data";
7895 elf_data_section->flags = SEC_NO_FLAGS;
7896 elf_data_section->output_section = NULL;
7897 elf_data_section->owner = abfd;
7898 elf_data_symbol->name = ".data";
7899 elf_data_symbol->flags = BSF_SECTION_SYM | BSF_DYNAMIC;
7900 elf_data_symbol->section = elf_data_section;
7901 }
7902 /* This code used to do *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr if
7903 bfd_link_pic (info). I don't know why, and that doesn't make sense,
7904 so I took it out. */
7905 *secp = mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->elf_data_section;
7906 break;
7907
7908 case SHN_MIPS_SUNDEFINED:
7909 *secp = bfd_und_section_ptr;
7910 break;
7911 }
7912
7913 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
7914 && ! bfd_link_pic (info)
7915 && info->output_bfd->xvec == abfd->xvec
7916 && strcmp (*namep, "__rld_obj_head") == 0)
7917 {
7918 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7919 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
7920
7921 /* Mark __rld_obj_head as dynamic. */
7922 bh = NULL;
7923 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
7924 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, *secp, *valp, NULL, FALSE,
7925 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
7926 return FALSE;
7927
7928 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
7929 h->non_elf = 0;
7930 h->def_regular = 1;
7931 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
7932
7933 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
7934 return FALSE;
7935
7936 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head = TRUE;
7937 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol = h;
7938 }
7939
7940 /* If this is a mips16 text symbol, add 1 to the value to make it
7941 odd. This will cause something like .word SYM to come up with
7942 the right value when it is loaded into the PC. */
7943 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
7944 ++*valp;
7945
7946 return TRUE;
7947 }
7948
7949 /* This hook function is called before the linker writes out a global
7950 symbol. We mark symbols as small common if appropriate. This is
7951 also where we undo the increment of the value for a mips16 symbol. */
7952
7953 int
7954 _bfd_mips_elf_link_output_symbol_hook
7955 (struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
7956 const char *name ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
7957 asection *input_sec, struct elf_link_hash_entry *h ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
7958 {
7959 /* If we see a common symbol, which implies a relocatable link, then
7960 if a symbol was small common in an input file, mark it as small
7961 common in the output file. */
7962 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
7963 && strcmp (input_sec->name, ".scommon") == 0)
7964 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON;
7965
7966 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
7967 sym->st_value &= ~1;
7968
7969 return 1;
7970 }
7971 \f
7972 /* Functions for the dynamic linker. */
7973
7974 /* Create dynamic sections when linking against a dynamic object. */
7975
7976 bfd_boolean
7977 _bfd_mips_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
7978 {
7979 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7980 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
7981 flagword flags;
7982 register asection *s;
7983 const char * const *namep;
7984 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
7985
7986 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
7987 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
7988
7989 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
7990 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
7991
7992 /* The psABI requires a read-only .dynamic section, but the VxWorks
7993 EABI doesn't. */
7994 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7995 {
7996 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynamic");
7997 if (s != NULL)
7998 {
7999 if (! bfd_set_section_flags (abfd, s, flags))
8000 return FALSE;
8001 }
8002 }
8003
8004 /* We need to create .got section. */
8005 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
8006 return FALSE;
8007
8008 if (! mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE))
8009 return FALSE;
8010
8011 /* Create .stub section. */
8012 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd,
8013 MIPS_ELF_STUB_SECTION_NAME (abfd),
8014 flags | SEC_CODE);
8015 if (s == NULL
8016 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
8017 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
8018 return FALSE;
8019 htab->sstubs = s;
8020
8021 if (!mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
8022 && bfd_link_executable (info)
8023 && bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rld_map") == NULL)
8024 {
8025 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rld_map",
8026 flags &~ (flagword) SEC_READONLY);
8027 if (s == NULL
8028 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s,
8029 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd)))
8030 return FALSE;
8031 }
8032
8033 /* Create .MIPS.xhash section. */
8034 if (info->emit_gnu_hash)
8035 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".MIPS.xhash",
8036 flags | SEC_READONLY);
8037
8038 /* On IRIX5, we adjust add some additional symbols and change the
8039 alignments of several sections. There is no ABI documentation
8040 indicating that this is necessary on IRIX6, nor any evidence that
8041 the linker takes such action. */
8042 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
8043 {
8044 for (namep = mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names; *namep != NULL; namep++)
8045 {
8046 bh = NULL;
8047 if (! (_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
8048 (info, abfd, *namep, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_und_section_ptr, 0,
8049 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
8050 return FALSE;
8051
8052 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
8053 h->mark = 1;
8054 h->non_elf = 0;
8055 h->def_regular = 1;
8056 h->type = STT_SECTION;
8057
8058 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
8059 return FALSE;
8060 }
8061
8062 /* We need to create a .compact_rel section. */
8063 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
8064 {
8065 if (!mips_elf_create_compact_rel_section (abfd, info))
8066 return FALSE;
8067 }
8068
8069 /* Change alignments of some sections. */
8070 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".hash");
8071 if (s != NULL)
8072 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
8073
8074 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynsym");
8075 if (s != NULL)
8076 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
8077
8078 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynstr");
8079 if (s != NULL)
8080 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
8081
8082 /* ??? */
8083 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
8084 if (s != NULL)
8085 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
8086
8087 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".dynamic");
8088 if (s != NULL)
8089 (void) bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, s, MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (abfd));
8090 }
8091
8092 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
8093 {
8094 const char *name;
8095
8096 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "_DYNAMIC_LINK" : "_DYNAMIC_LINKING";
8097 bh = NULL;
8098 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
8099 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
8100 NULL, FALSE, get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
8101 return FALSE;
8102
8103 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
8104 h->non_elf = 0;
8105 h->def_regular = 1;
8106 h->type = STT_SECTION;
8107
8108 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
8109 return FALSE;
8110
8111 if (! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head)
8112 {
8113 /* __rld_map is a four byte word located in the .data section
8114 and is filled in by the rtld to contain a pointer to
8115 the _r_debug structure. Its symbol value will be set in
8116 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol. */
8117 s = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rld_map");
8118 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
8119
8120 name = SGI_COMPAT (abfd) ? "__rld_map" : "__RLD_MAP";
8121 bh = NULL;
8122 if (!(_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol
8123 (info, abfd, name, BSF_GLOBAL, s, 0, NULL, FALSE,
8124 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->collect, &bh)))
8125 return FALSE;
8126
8127 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) bh;
8128 h->non_elf = 0;
8129 h->def_regular = 1;
8130 h->type = STT_OBJECT;
8131
8132 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
8133 return FALSE;
8134 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol = h;
8135 }
8136 }
8137
8138 /* Create the .plt, .rel(a).plt, .dynbss and .rel(a).bss sections.
8139 Also, on VxWorks, create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_ symbol. */
8140 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
8141 return FALSE;
8142
8143 /* Do the usual VxWorks handling. */
8144 if (htab->is_vxworks
8145 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
8146 return FALSE;
8147
8148 return TRUE;
8149 }
8150 \f
8151 /* Return true if relocation REL against section SEC is a REL rather than
8152 RELA relocation. RELOCS is the first relocation in the section and
8153 ABFD is the bfd that contains SEC. */
8154
8155 static bfd_boolean
8156 mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
8157 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
8158 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
8159 {
8160 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
8161 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8162
8163 /* To determine which flavor of relocation this is, we depend on the
8164 fact that the INPUT_SECTION's REL_HDR is read before RELA_HDR. */
8165 rel_hdr = elf_section_data (sec)->rel.hdr;
8166 if (rel_hdr == NULL)
8167 return FALSE;
8168 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8169 return ((size_t) (rel - relocs)
8170 < NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (rel_hdr) * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel);
8171 }
8172
8173 /* Read the addend for REL relocation REL, which belongs to bfd ABFD.
8174 HOWTO is the relocation's howto and CONTENTS points to the contents
8175 of the section that REL is against. */
8176
8177 static bfd_vma
8178 mips_elf_read_rel_addend (bfd *abfd, const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
8179 reloc_howto_type *howto, bfd_byte *contents)
8180 {
8181 bfd_byte *location;
8182 unsigned int r_type;
8183 bfd_vma addend;
8184 bfd_vma bytes;
8185
8186 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
8187 location = contents + rel->r_offset;
8188
8189 /* Get the addend, which is stored in the input file. */
8190 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_unshuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
8191 bytes = mips_elf_obtain_contents (howto, rel, abfd, contents);
8192 _bfd_mips_elf_reloc_shuffle (abfd, r_type, FALSE, location);
8193
8194 addend = bytes & howto->src_mask;
8195
8196 /* Shift is 2, unusually, for microMIPS JALX. Adjust the addend
8197 accordingly. */
8198 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 && (bytes >> 26) == 0x3c)
8199 addend <<= 1;
8200
8201 return addend;
8202 }
8203
8204 /* REL is a relocation in ABFD that needs a partnering LO16 relocation
8205 and *ADDEND is the addend for REL itself. Look for the LO16 relocation
8206 and update *ADDEND with the final addend. Return true on success
8207 or false if the LO16 could not be found. RELEND is the exclusive
8208 upper bound on the relocations for REL's section. */
8209
8210 static bfd_boolean
8211 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (bfd *abfd,
8212 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
8213 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend,
8214 bfd_byte *contents, bfd_vma *addend)
8215 {
8216 unsigned int r_type, lo16_type;
8217 const Elf_Internal_Rela *lo16_relocation;
8218 reloc_howto_type *lo16_howto;
8219 bfd_vma l;
8220
8221 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
8222 if (mips16_reloc_p (r_type))
8223 lo16_type = R_MIPS16_LO16;
8224 else if (micromips_reloc_p (r_type))
8225 lo16_type = R_MICROMIPS_LO16;
8226 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_PCHI16)
8227 lo16_type = R_MIPS_PCLO16;
8228 else
8229 lo16_type = R_MIPS_LO16;
8230
8231 /* The combined value is the sum of the HI16 addend, left-shifted by
8232 sixteen bits, and the LO16 addend, sign extended. (Usually, the
8233 code does a `lui' of the HI16 value, and then an `addiu' of the
8234 LO16 value.)
8235
8236 Scan ahead to find a matching LO16 relocation.
8237
8238 According to the MIPS ELF ABI, the R_MIPS_LO16 relocation must
8239 be immediately following. However, for the IRIX6 ABI, the next
8240 relocation may be a composed relocation consisting of several
8241 relocations for the same address. In that case, the R_MIPS_LO16
8242 relocation may occur as one of these. We permit a similar
8243 extension in general, as that is useful for GCC.
8244
8245 In some cases GCC dead code elimination removes the LO16 but keeps
8246 the corresponding HI16. This is strictly speaking a violation of
8247 the ABI but not immediately harmful. */
8248 lo16_relocation = mips_elf_next_relocation (abfd, lo16_type, rel, relend);
8249 if (lo16_relocation == NULL)
8250 return FALSE;
8251
8252 /* Obtain the addend kept there. */
8253 lo16_howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, lo16_type, FALSE);
8254 l = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, lo16_relocation, lo16_howto, contents);
8255
8256 l <<= lo16_howto->rightshift;
8257 l = _bfd_mips_elf_sign_extend (l, 16);
8258
8259 *addend <<= 16;
8260 *addend += l;
8261 return TRUE;
8262 }
8263
8264 /* Try to read the contents of section SEC in bfd ABFD. Return true and
8265 store the contents in *CONTENTS on success. Assume that *CONTENTS
8266 already holds the contents if it is nonull on entry. */
8267
8268 static bfd_boolean
8269 mips_elf_get_section_contents (bfd *abfd, asection *sec, bfd_byte **contents)
8270 {
8271 if (*contents)
8272 return TRUE;
8273
8274 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
8275 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
8276 {
8277 *contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
8278 return TRUE;
8279 }
8280
8281 return bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, contents);
8282 }
8283
8284 /* Make a new PLT record to keep internal data. */
8285
8286 static struct plt_entry *
8287 mips_elf_make_plt_record (bfd *abfd)
8288 {
8289 struct plt_entry *entry;
8290
8291 entry = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*entry));
8292 if (entry == NULL)
8293 return NULL;
8294
8295 entry->stub_offset = MINUS_ONE;
8296 entry->mips_offset = MINUS_ONE;
8297 entry->comp_offset = MINUS_ONE;
8298 entry->gotplt_index = MINUS_ONE;
8299 return entry;
8300 }
8301
8302 /* Define the special `__gnu_absolute_zero' symbol. We only need this
8303 for PIC code, as otherwise there is no load-time relocation involved
8304 and local GOT entries whose value is zero at static link time will
8305 retain their value at load time. */
8306
8307 static bfd_boolean
8308 mips_elf_define_absolute_zero (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8309 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab,
8310 unsigned int r_type)
8311 {
8312 union
8313 {
8314 struct elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
8315 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *bh;
8316 }
8317 hzero;
8318
8319 BFD_ASSERT (!htab->use_absolute_zero);
8320 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_link_pic (info));
8321
8322 hzero.bh = NULL;
8323 if (!_bfd_generic_link_add_one_symbol (info, abfd, "__gnu_absolute_zero",
8324 BSF_GLOBAL, bfd_abs_section_ptr, 0,
8325 NULL, FALSE, FALSE, &hzero.bh))
8326 return FALSE;
8327
8328 BFD_ASSERT (hzero.bh != NULL);
8329 hzero.eh->size = 0;
8330 hzero.eh->type = STT_NOTYPE;
8331 hzero.eh->other = STV_PROTECTED;
8332 hzero.eh->def_regular = 1;
8333 hzero.eh->non_elf = 0;
8334
8335 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (hzero.eh, abfd, info, TRUE, r_type))
8336 return FALSE;
8337
8338 htab->use_absolute_zero = TRUE;
8339
8340 return TRUE;
8341 }
8342
8343 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
8344 allocate space in the global offset table and record the need for
8345 standard MIPS and compressed procedure linkage table entries. */
8346
8347 bfd_boolean
8348 _bfd_mips_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
8349 asection *sec, const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
8350 {
8351 const char *name;
8352 bfd *dynobj;
8353 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
8354 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
8355 size_t extsymoff;
8356 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
8357 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
8358 asection *sreloc;
8359 const struct elf_backend_data *bed;
8360 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
8361 bfd_byte *contents;
8362 bfd_vma addend;
8363 reloc_howto_type *howto;
8364
8365 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8366 return TRUE;
8367
8368 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
8369 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
8370
8371 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
8372 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
8373 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
8374 extsymoff = (elf_bad_symtab (abfd)) ? 0 : symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8375
8376 bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
8377 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
8378
8379 /* Check for the mips16 stub sections. */
8380
8381 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, sec);
8382 if (FN_STUB_P (name))
8383 {
8384 unsigned long r_symndx;
8385
8386 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
8387 this is for. */
8388
8389 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (bed, sec, relocs, rel_end);
8390 if (r_symndx == 0)
8391 {
8392 _bfd_error_handler
8393 /* xgettext:c-format */
8394 (_("%pB: warning: cannot determine the target function for"
8395 " stub section `%s'"),
8396 abfd, name);
8397 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8398 return FALSE;
8399 }
8400
8401 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
8402 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
8403 {
8404 asection *o;
8405
8406 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
8407 needed if there is some relocation in this BFD, other
8408 than a 16 bit function call, which refers to this symbol. */
8409 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
8410 {
8411 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
8412 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
8413
8414 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
8415 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
8416 || o->reloc_count == 0
8417 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
8418 continue;
8419
8420 sec_relocs
8421 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
8422 info->keep_memory);
8423 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
8424 return FALSE;
8425
8426 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
8427 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
8428 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
8429 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info)))
8430 break;
8431
8432 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
8433 free (sec_relocs);
8434
8435 if (r < rend)
8436 break;
8437 }
8438
8439 if (o == NULL)
8440 {
8441 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
8442 not need it. Since this function is called before
8443 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
8444 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
8445 flag. */
8446 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8447 return TRUE;
8448 }
8449
8450 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol stubs for
8451 this BFD. */
8452 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs == NULL)
8453 {
8454 unsigned long symcount;
8455 asection **n;
8456 bfd_size_type amt;
8457
8458 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
8459 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
8460 else
8461 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8462 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
8463 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8464 if (n == NULL)
8465 return FALSE;
8466 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs = n;
8467 }
8468
8469 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8470 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
8471
8472 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
8473 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
8474 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
8475 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
8476 }
8477 else
8478 {
8479 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8480
8481 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
8482 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
8483
8484 while (h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8485 || h->root.root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8486 h = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.root.u.i.link;
8487
8488 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
8489
8490 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
8491 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
8492 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
8493 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
8494 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
8495 if (h->fn_stub != NULL)
8496 {
8497 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8498 return TRUE;
8499 }
8500
8501 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8502 h->fn_stub = sec;
8503 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
8504 }
8505 }
8506 else if (CALL_STUB_P (name) || CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
8507 {
8508 unsigned long r_symndx;
8509 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8510 asection **loc;
8511
8512 /* Look at the relocation information to figure out which symbol
8513 this is for. */
8514
8515 r_symndx = mips16_stub_symndx (bed, sec, relocs, rel_end);
8516 if (r_symndx == 0)
8517 {
8518 _bfd_error_handler
8519 /* xgettext:c-format */
8520 (_("%pB: warning: cannot determine the target function for"
8521 " stub section `%s'"),
8522 abfd, name);
8523 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8524 return FALSE;
8525 }
8526
8527 if (r_symndx < extsymoff
8528 || sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff] == NULL)
8529 {
8530 asection *o;
8531
8532 /* This stub is for a local symbol. This stub will only be
8533 needed if there is some relocation (R_MIPS16_26) in this BFD
8534 that refers to this symbol. */
8535 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
8536 {
8537 Elf_Internal_Rela *sec_relocs;
8538 const Elf_Internal_Rela *r, *rend;
8539
8540 /* We can ignore stub sections when looking for relocs. */
8541 if ((o->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
8542 || o->reloc_count == 0
8543 || section_allows_mips16_refs_p (o))
8544 continue;
8545
8546 sec_relocs
8547 = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
8548 info->keep_memory);
8549 if (sec_relocs == NULL)
8550 return FALSE;
8551
8552 rend = sec_relocs + o->reloc_count;
8553 for (r = sec_relocs; r < rend; r++)
8554 if (ELF_R_SYM (abfd, r->r_info) == r_symndx
8555 && ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, r->r_info) == R_MIPS16_26)
8556 break;
8557
8558 if (elf_section_data (o)->relocs != sec_relocs)
8559 free (sec_relocs);
8560
8561 if (r < rend)
8562 break;
8563 }
8564
8565 if (o == NULL)
8566 {
8567 /* There is no non-call reloc for this stub, so we do
8568 not need it. Since this function is called before
8569 the linker maps input sections to output sections, we
8570 can easily discard it by setting the SEC_EXCLUDE
8571 flag. */
8572 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8573 return TRUE;
8574 }
8575
8576 /* Record this stub in an array of local symbol call_stubs for
8577 this BFD. */
8578 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs == NULL)
8579 {
8580 unsigned long symcount;
8581 asection **n;
8582 bfd_size_type amt;
8583
8584 if (elf_bad_symtab (abfd))
8585 symcount = NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr);
8586 else
8587 symcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
8588 amt = symcount * sizeof (asection *);
8589 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
8590 if (n == NULL)
8591 return FALSE;
8592 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs = n;
8593 }
8594
8595 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8596 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->local_call_stubs[r_symndx] = sec;
8597
8598 /* We don't need to set mips16_stubs_seen in this case.
8599 That flag is used to see whether we need to look through
8600 the global symbol table for stubs. We don't need to set
8601 it here, because we just have a local stub. */
8602 }
8603 else
8604 {
8605 h = ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *)
8606 sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff]);
8607
8608 /* H is the symbol this stub is for. */
8609
8610 if (CALL_FP_STUB_P (name))
8611 loc = &h->call_fp_stub;
8612 else
8613 loc = &h->call_stub;
8614
8615 /* If we already have an appropriate stub for this function, we
8616 don't need another one, so we can discard this one. Since
8617 this function is called before the linker maps input sections
8618 to output sections, we can easily discard it by setting the
8619 SEC_EXCLUDE flag. */
8620 if (*loc != NULL)
8621 {
8622 sec->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
8623 return TRUE;
8624 }
8625
8626 sec->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
8627 *loc = sec;
8628 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->mips16_stubs_seen = TRUE;
8629 }
8630 }
8631
8632 sreloc = NULL;
8633 contents = NULL;
8634 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; ++rel)
8635 {
8636 unsigned long r_symndx;
8637 unsigned int r_type;
8638 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
8639 bfd_boolean can_make_dynamic_p;
8640 bfd_boolean call_reloc_p;
8641 bfd_boolean constrain_symbol_p;
8642
8643 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (abfd, rel->r_info);
8644 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (abfd, rel->r_info);
8645
8646 if (r_symndx < extsymoff)
8647 h = NULL;
8648 else if (r_symndx >= extsymoff + NUM_SHDR_ENTRIES (symtab_hdr))
8649 {
8650 _bfd_error_handler
8651 /* xgettext:c-format */
8652 (_("%pB: malformed reloc detected for section %s"),
8653 abfd, name);
8654 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8655 return FALSE;
8656 }
8657 else
8658 {
8659 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - extsymoff];
8660 if (h != NULL)
8661 {
8662 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
8663 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
8664 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
8665 }
8666 }
8667
8668 /* Set CAN_MAKE_DYNAMIC_P to true if we can convert this
8669 relocation into a dynamic one. */
8670 can_make_dynamic_p = FALSE;
8671
8672 /* Set CALL_RELOC_P to true if the relocation is for a call,
8673 and if pointer equality therefore doesn't matter. */
8674 call_reloc_p = FALSE;
8675
8676 /* Set CONSTRAIN_SYMBOL_P if we need to take the relocation
8677 into account when deciding how to define the symbol.
8678 Relocations in nonallocatable sections such as .pdr and
8679 .debug* should have no effect. */
8680 constrain_symbol_p = ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0);
8681
8682 switch (r_type)
8683 {
8684 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8685 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8686 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8687 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8688 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
8689 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
8690 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
8691 call_reloc_p = TRUE;
8692 /* Fall through. */
8693
8694 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8695 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8696 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8697 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8698 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
8699 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
8700 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
8701 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8702 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
8703 /* If we have a symbol that will resolve to zero at static link
8704 time and it is used by a GOT relocation applied to code we
8705 cannot relax to an immediate zero load, then we will be using
8706 the special `__gnu_absolute_zero' symbol whose value is zero
8707 at dynamic load time. We ignore HI16-type GOT relocations at
8708 this stage, because their handling will depend entirely on
8709 the corresponding LO16-type GOT relocation. */
8710 if (!call_hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
8711 && h != NULL
8712 && bfd_link_pic (info)
8713 && !htab->use_absolute_zero
8714 && UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
8715 {
8716 bfd_boolean rel_reloc;
8717
8718 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
8719 return FALSE;
8720
8721 rel_reloc = mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (abfd, sec, relocs, rel);
8722 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
8723
8724 if (!mips_elf_nullify_got_load (abfd, contents, rel, howto,
8725 FALSE))
8726 if (!mips_elf_define_absolute_zero (abfd, info, htab, r_type))
8727 return FALSE;
8728 }
8729
8730 /* Fall through. */
8731 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8732 case R_MIPS_GOT_OFST:
8733 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8734 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
8735 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
8736 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8737 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
8738 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
8739 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
8740 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_OFST:
8741 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8742 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
8743 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
8744 if (dynobj == NULL)
8745 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
8746 if (!mips_elf_create_got_section (dynobj, info))
8747 return FALSE;
8748 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8749 {
8750 _bfd_error_handler
8751 /* xgettext:c-format */
8752 (_("%pB: GOT reloc at %#" PRIx64 " not expected in executables"),
8753 abfd, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset);
8754 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8755 return FALSE;
8756 }
8757 can_make_dynamic_p = TRUE;
8758 break;
8759
8760 case R_MIPS_NONE:
8761 case R_MIPS_JALR:
8762 case R_MICROMIPS_JALR:
8763 /* These relocations have empty fields and are purely there to
8764 provide link information. The symbol value doesn't matter. */
8765 constrain_symbol_p = FALSE;
8766 break;
8767
8768 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
8769 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
8770 case R_MIPS16_GPREL:
8771 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
8772 /* GP-relative relocations always resolve to a definition in a
8773 regular input file, ignoring the one-definition rule. This is
8774 important for the GP setup sequence in NewABI code, which
8775 always resolves to a local function even if other relocations
8776 against the symbol wouldn't. */
8777 constrain_symbol_p = FALSE;
8778 break;
8779
8780 case R_MIPS_32:
8781 case R_MIPS_REL32:
8782 case R_MIPS_64:
8783 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
8784 must be handled using copy relocs or PLT entries; it is not
8785 possible to convert this relocation into a dynamic one.
8786
8787 For executables that use PLTs and copy-relocs, we have a
8788 choice between converting the relocation into a dynamic
8789 one or using copy relocations or PLT entries. It is
8790 usually better to do the former, unless the relocation is
8791 against a read-only section. */
8792 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
8793 || (h != NULL
8794 && !htab->is_vxworks
8795 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "__gnu_local_gp") != 0
8796 && !(!info->nocopyreloc
8797 && !PIC_OBJECT_P (abfd)
8798 && MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))))
8799 && (sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
8800 {
8801 can_make_dynamic_p = TRUE;
8802 if (dynobj == NULL)
8803 elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj = dynobj = abfd;
8804 }
8805 break;
8806
8807 case R_MIPS_26:
8808 case R_MIPS_PC16:
8809 case R_MIPS_PC21_S2:
8810 case R_MIPS_PC26_S2:
8811 case R_MIPS16_26:
8812 case R_MIPS16_PC16_S1:
8813 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
8814 case R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1:
8815 case R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1:
8816 case R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1:
8817 case R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2:
8818 call_reloc_p = TRUE;
8819 break;
8820 }
8821
8822 if (h)
8823 {
8824 if (constrain_symbol_p)
8825 {
8826 if (!can_make_dynamic_p)
8827 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_static_relocs = 1;
8828
8829 if (!call_reloc_p)
8830 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
8831
8832 /* We must not create a stub for a symbol that has
8833 relocations related to taking the function's address.
8834 This doesn't apply to VxWorks, where CALL relocs refer
8835 to a .got.plt entry instead of a normal .got entry. */
8836 if (!htab->is_vxworks && (!can_make_dynamic_p || !call_reloc_p))
8837 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
8838 }
8839
8840 /* Relocations against the special VxWorks __GOTT_BASE__ and
8841 __GOTT_INDEX__ symbols must be left to the loader. Allocate
8842 room for them in .rela.dyn. */
8843 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
8844 {
8845 if (sreloc == NULL)
8846 {
8847 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
8848 if (sreloc == NULL)
8849 return FALSE;
8850 }
8851 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
8852 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
8853 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
8854 relocations against the text segment. */
8855 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
8856 }
8857 }
8858 else if (call_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
8859 || got_lo16_reloc_p (r_type)
8860 || got_disp_reloc_p (r_type)
8861 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type) && htab->is_vxworks))
8862 {
8863 /* We may need a local GOT entry for this relocation. We
8864 don't count R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE because we can estimate the
8865 maximum number of pages needed by looking at the size of
8866 the segment. Similar comments apply to R_MIPS*_GOT16 and
8867 R_MIPS*_CALL16, except on VxWorks, where GOT relocations
8868 always evaluate to "G". We don't count R_MIPS_GOT_HI16, or
8869 R_MIPS_CALL_HI16 because these are always followed by an
8870 R_MIPS_GOT_LO16 or R_MIPS_CALL_LO16. */
8871 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
8872 rel->r_addend, info, r_type))
8873 return FALSE;
8874 }
8875
8876 if (h != NULL
8877 && mips_elf_relocation_needs_la25_stub (abfd, r_type,
8878 ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (h->other)))
8879 ((struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
8880
8881 switch (r_type)
8882 {
8883 case R_MIPS_CALL16:
8884 case R_MIPS16_CALL16:
8885 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL16:
8886 if (h == NULL)
8887 {
8888 _bfd_error_handler
8889 /* xgettext:c-format */
8890 (_("%pB: CALL16 reloc at %#" PRIx64 " not against global symbol"),
8891 abfd, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset);
8892 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8893 return FALSE;
8894 }
8895 /* Fall through. */
8896
8897 case R_MIPS_CALL_HI16:
8898 case R_MIPS_CALL_LO16:
8899 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_HI16:
8900 case R_MICROMIPS_CALL_LO16:
8901 if (h != NULL)
8902 {
8903 /* Make sure there is room in the regular GOT to hold the
8904 function's address. We may eliminate it in favour of
8905 a .got.plt entry later; see mips_elf_count_got_symbols. */
8906 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info, TRUE,
8907 r_type))
8908 return FALSE;
8909
8910 /* We need a stub, not a plt entry for the undefined
8911 function. But we record it as if it needs plt. See
8912 _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol. */
8913 h->needs_plt = 1;
8914 h->type = STT_FUNC;
8915 }
8916 break;
8917
8918 case R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8919 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_PAGE:
8920 case R_MIPS16_GOT16:
8921 case R_MIPS_GOT16:
8922 case R_MIPS_GOT_HI16:
8923 case R_MIPS_GOT_LO16:
8924 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT16:
8925 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_HI16:
8926 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_LO16:
8927 if (!h || got_page_reloc_p (r_type))
8928 {
8929 /* This relocation needs (or may need, if h != NULL) a
8930 page entry in the GOT. For R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE we do not
8931 know for sure until we know whether the symbol is
8932 preemptible. */
8933 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (abfd, sec, relocs, rel))
8934 {
8935 if (!mips_elf_get_section_contents (abfd, sec, &contents))
8936 return FALSE;
8937 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, FALSE);
8938 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (abfd, rel,
8939 howto, contents);
8940 if (got16_reloc_p (r_type))
8941 mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (abfd, rel, rel_end,
8942 contents, &addend);
8943 else
8944 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
8945 }
8946 else
8947 addend = rel->r_addend;
8948 if (!mips_elf_record_got_page_ref (info, abfd, r_symndx,
8949 h, addend))
8950 return FALSE;
8951
8952 if (h)
8953 {
8954 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips =
8955 (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
8956
8957 /* This symbol is definitely not overridable. */
8958 if (hmips->root.def_regular
8959 && ! (bfd_link_pic (info) && ! info->symbolic
8960 && ! hmips->root.forced_local))
8961 h = NULL;
8962 }
8963 }
8964 /* If this is a global, overridable symbol, GOT_PAGE will
8965 decay to GOT_DISP, so we'll need a GOT entry for it. */
8966 /* Fall through. */
8967
8968 case R_MIPS_GOT_DISP:
8969 case R_MICROMIPS_GOT_DISP:
8970 if (h && !mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
8971 FALSE, r_type))
8972 return FALSE;
8973 break;
8974
8975 case R_MIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8976 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8977 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GOTTPREL:
8978 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8979 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
8980 /* Fall through */
8981
8982 case R_MIPS_TLS_LDM:
8983 case R_MIPS16_TLS_LDM:
8984 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_LDM:
8985 if (tls_ldm_reloc_p (r_type))
8986 {
8987 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
8988 h = NULL;
8989 }
8990 /* Fall through */
8991
8992 case R_MIPS_TLS_GD:
8993 case R_MIPS16_TLS_GD:
8994 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_GD:
8995 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry, or two
8996 for TLS GD relocations. */
8997 if (h != NULL)
8998 {
8999 if (!mips_elf_record_global_got_symbol (h, abfd, info,
9000 FALSE, r_type))
9001 return FALSE;
9002 }
9003 else
9004 {
9005 if (!mips_elf_record_local_got_symbol (abfd, r_symndx,
9006 rel->r_addend,
9007 info, r_type))
9008 return FALSE;
9009 }
9010 break;
9011
9012 case R_MIPS_32:
9013 case R_MIPS_REL32:
9014 case R_MIPS_64:
9015 /* In VxWorks executables, references to external symbols
9016 are handled using copy relocs or PLT stubs, so there's
9017 no need to add a .rela.dyn entry for this relocation. */
9018 if (can_make_dynamic_p)
9019 {
9020 if (sreloc == NULL)
9021 {
9022 sreloc = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, TRUE);
9023 if (sreloc == NULL)
9024 return FALSE;
9025 }
9026 if (bfd_link_pic (info) && h == NULL)
9027 {
9028 /* When creating a shared object, we must copy these
9029 reloc types into the output file as R_MIPS_REL32
9030 relocs. Make room for this reloc in .rel(a).dyn. */
9031 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
9032 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
9033 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are
9034 relocations against the text segment. */
9035 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9036 }
9037 else
9038 {
9039 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
9040
9041 /* For a shared object, we must copy this relocation
9042 unless the symbol turns out to be undefined and
9043 weak with non-default visibility, in which case
9044 it will be left as zero.
9045
9046 We could elide R_MIPS_REL32 for locally binding symbols
9047 in shared libraries, but do not yet do so.
9048
9049 For an executable, we only need to copy this
9050 reloc if the symbol is defined in a dynamic
9051 object. */
9052 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9053 ++hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
9054 if (MIPS_ELF_READONLY_SECTION (sec))
9055 /* We need it to tell the dynamic linker if there
9056 are relocations against the text segment. */
9057 hmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
9058 }
9059 }
9060
9061 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
9062 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
9063 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
9064 break;
9065
9066 case R_MIPS_26:
9067 case R_MIPS_GPREL16:
9068 case R_MIPS_LITERAL:
9069 case R_MIPS_GPREL32:
9070 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
9071 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL16:
9072 case R_MICROMIPS_LITERAL:
9073 case R_MICROMIPS_GPREL7_S2:
9074 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
9075 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size +=
9076 sizeof (Elf32_External_crinfo);
9077 break;
9078
9079 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
9080 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
9081 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
9082 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
9083 return FALSE;
9084 break;
9085
9086 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
9087 used. Record for later use during GC. */
9088 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
9089 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
9090 return FALSE;
9091 break;
9092
9093 default:
9094 break;
9095 }
9096
9097 /* Record the need for a PLT entry. At this point we don't know
9098 yet if we are going to create a PLT in the first place, but
9099 we only record whether the relocation requires a standard MIPS
9100 or a compressed code entry anyway. If we don't make a PLT after
9101 all, then we'll just ignore these arrangements. Likewise if
9102 a PLT entry is not created because the symbol is satisfied
9103 locally. */
9104 if (h != NULL
9105 && (branch_reloc_p (r_type)
9106 || mips16_branch_reloc_p (r_type)
9107 || micromips_branch_reloc_p (r_type))
9108 && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
9109 {
9110 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
9111 h->plt.plist = mips_elf_make_plt_record (abfd);
9112 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
9113 return FALSE;
9114
9115 if (branch_reloc_p (r_type))
9116 h->plt.plist->need_mips = TRUE;
9117 else
9118 h->plt.plist->need_comp = TRUE;
9119 }
9120
9121 /* See if this reloc would need to refer to a MIPS16 hard-float stub,
9122 if there is one. We only need to handle global symbols here;
9123 we decide whether to keep or delete stubs for local symbols
9124 when processing the stub's relocations. */
9125 if (h != NULL
9126 && !mips16_call_reloc_p (r_type)
9127 && !section_allows_mips16_refs_p (sec))
9128 {
9129 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *mh;
9130
9131 mh = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9132 mh->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
9133 }
9134
9135 /* Refuse some position-dependent relocations when creating a
9136 shared library. Do not refuse R_MIPS_32 / R_MIPS_64; they're
9137 not PIC, but we can create dynamic relocations and the result
9138 will be fine. Also do not refuse R_MIPS_LO16, which can be
9139 combined with R_MIPS_GOT16. */
9140 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9141 {
9142 switch (r_type)
9143 {
9144 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
9145 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
9146 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_HI16:
9147 case R_MIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
9148 case R_MIPS16_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
9149 case R_MICROMIPS_TLS_TPREL_LO16:
9150 /* These are okay in PIE, but not in a shared library. */
9151 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
9152 break;
9153
9154 /* FALLTHROUGH */
9155
9156 case R_MIPS16_HI16:
9157 case R_MIPS_HI16:
9158 case R_MIPS_HIGHER:
9159 case R_MIPS_HIGHEST:
9160 case R_MICROMIPS_HI16:
9161 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHER:
9162 case R_MICROMIPS_HIGHEST:
9163 /* Don't refuse a high part relocation if it's against
9164 no symbol (e.g. part of a compound relocation). */
9165 if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF)
9166 break;
9167
9168 /* Likewise an absolute symbol. */
9169 if (h != NULL && bfd_is_abs_symbol (&h->root))
9170 break;
9171
9172 /* R_MIPS_HI16 against _gp_disp is used for $gp setup,
9173 and has a special meaning. */
9174 if (!NEWABI_P (abfd) && h != NULL
9175 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_gp_disp") == 0)
9176 break;
9177
9178 /* Likewise __GOTT_BASE__ and __GOTT_INDEX__ on VxWorks. */
9179 if (is_gott_symbol (info, h))
9180 break;
9181
9182 /* FALLTHROUGH */
9183
9184 case R_MIPS16_26:
9185 case R_MIPS_26:
9186 case R_MICROMIPS_26_S1:
9187 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (abfd, r_type, NEWABI_P (abfd));
9188 /* An error for unsupported relocations is raised as part
9189 of the above search, so we can skip the following. */
9190 if (howto != NULL)
9191 info->callbacks->einfo
9192 /* xgettext:c-format */
9193 (_("%X%H: relocation %s against `%s' cannot be used"
9194 " when making a shared object; recompile with -fPIC\n"),
9195 abfd, sec, rel->r_offset, howto->name,
9196 (h) ? h->root.root.string : "a local symbol");
9197 break;
9198 default:
9199 break;
9200 }
9201 }
9202 }
9203
9204 return TRUE;
9205 }
9206 \f
9207 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
9208
9209 static bfd_boolean
9210 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9211 {
9212 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
9213 bfd *dynobj;
9214 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
9215 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9216
9217 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9218 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9219
9220 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9221 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9222
9223 /* VxWorks executables are handled elsewhere; we only need to
9224 allocate relocations in shared objects. */
9225 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9226 return TRUE;
9227
9228 /* Ignore indirect symbols. All relocations against such symbols
9229 will be redirected to the target symbol. */
9230 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
9231 return TRUE;
9232
9233 /* If this symbol is defined in a dynamic object, or we are creating
9234 a shared library, we will need to copy any R_MIPS_32 or
9235 R_MIPS_REL32 relocs against it into the output file. */
9236 if (! bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9237 && hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs != 0
9238 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
9239 || (!h->def_regular && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h))
9240 || bfd_link_pic (info)))
9241 {
9242 bfd_boolean do_copy = TRUE;
9243
9244 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
9245 {
9246 /* Do not copy relocations for undefined weak symbols that
9247 we are not going to export. */
9248 if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
9249 do_copy = FALSE;
9250
9251 /* Make sure undefined weak symbols are output as a dynamic
9252 symbol in PIEs. */
9253 else if (h->dynindx == -1 && !h->forced_local)
9254 {
9255 if (! bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h))
9256 return FALSE;
9257 }
9258 }
9259
9260 if (do_copy)
9261 {
9262 /* Even though we don't directly need a GOT entry for this symbol,
9263 the SVR4 psABI requires it to have a dynamic symbol table
9264 index greater that DT_MIPS_GOTSYM if there are dynamic
9265 relocations against it.
9266
9267 VxWorks does not enforce the same mapping between the GOT
9268 and the symbol table, so the same requirement does not
9269 apply there. */
9270 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9271 {
9272 if (hmips->global_got_area > GGA_RELOC_ONLY)
9273 hmips->global_got_area = GGA_RELOC_ONLY;
9274 hmips->got_only_for_calls = FALSE;
9275 }
9276
9277 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations
9278 (dynobj, info, hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs);
9279 if (hmips->readonly_reloc)
9280 /* We tell the dynamic linker that there are relocations
9281 against the text segment. */
9282 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
9283 }
9284 }
9285
9286 return TRUE;
9287 }
9288
9289 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
9290 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
9291 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
9292 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
9293 understand. */
9294
9295 bfd_boolean
9296 _bfd_mips_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
9297 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
9298 {
9299 bfd *dynobj;
9300 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
9301 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9302 asection *s, *srel;
9303
9304 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9305 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9306
9307 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9308 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9309
9310 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
9311 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL
9312 && (h->needs_plt
9313 || h->is_weakalias
9314 || (h->def_dynamic
9315 && h->ref_regular
9316 && !h->def_regular)));
9317
9318 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
9319
9320 /* If there are call relocations against an externally-defined symbol,
9321 see whether we can create a MIPS lazy-binding stub for it. We can
9322 only do this if all references to the function are through call
9323 relocations, and in that case, the traditional lazy-binding stubs
9324 are much more efficient than PLT entries.
9325
9326 Traditional stubs are only available on SVR4 psABI-based systems;
9327 VxWorks always uses PLTs instead. */
9328 if (!htab->is_vxworks && h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
9329 {
9330 if (! elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9331 return TRUE;
9332
9333 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular file, then set
9334 the symbol to the stub location. This is required to make
9335 function pointers compare as equal between the normal
9336 executable and the shared library. */
9337 if (!h->def_regular
9338 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->sstubs->output_section))
9339 {
9340 hmips->needs_lazy_stub = TRUE;
9341 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
9342 return TRUE;
9343 }
9344 }
9345 /* As above, VxWorks requires PLT entries for externally-defined
9346 functions that are only accessed through call relocations.
9347
9348 Both VxWorks and non-VxWorks targets also need PLT entries if there
9349 are static-only relocations against an externally-defined function.
9350 This can technically occur for shared libraries if there are
9351 branches to the symbol, although it is unlikely that this will be
9352 used in practice due to the short ranges involved. It can occur
9353 for any relative or absolute relocation in executables; in that
9354 case, the PLT entry becomes the function's canonical address. */
9355 else if (((h->needs_plt && !hmips->no_fn_stub)
9356 || (h->type == STT_FUNC && hmips->has_static_relocs))
9357 && htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs
9358 && !SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
9359 && !(ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT
9360 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak))
9361 {
9362 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (info->output_bfd);
9363 bfd_boolean newabi_p = NEWABI_P (info->output_bfd);
9364
9365 /* If this is the first symbol to need a PLT entry, then make some
9366 basic setup. Also work out PLT entry sizes. We'll need them
9367 for PLT offset calculations. */
9368 if (htab->plt_mips_offset + htab->plt_comp_offset == 0)
9369 {
9370 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.sgotplt->size == 0);
9371 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_got_index == 0);
9372
9373 /* If we're using the PLT additions to the psABI, each PLT
9374 entry is 16 bytes and the PLT0 entry is 32 bytes.
9375 Encourage better cache usage by aligning. We do this
9376 lazily to avoid pessimizing traditional objects. */
9377 if (!htab->is_vxworks
9378 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->root.splt, 5))
9379 return FALSE;
9380
9381 /* Make sure that .got.plt is word-aligned. We do this lazily
9382 for the same reason as above. */
9383 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (dynobj, htab->root.sgotplt,
9384 MIPS_ELF_LOG_FILE_ALIGN (dynobj)))
9385 return FALSE;
9386
9387 /* On non-VxWorks targets, the first two entries in .got.plt
9388 are reserved. */
9389 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
9390 htab->plt_got_index
9391 += (get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->got_header_size
9392 / MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9393
9394 /* On VxWorks, also allocate room for the header's
9395 .rela.plt.unloaded entries. */
9396 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9397 htab->srelplt2->size += 2 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9398
9399 /* Now work out the sizes of individual PLT entries. */
9400 if (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info))
9401 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9402 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry);
9403 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
9404 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9405 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry);
9406 else if (newabi_p)
9407 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9408 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9409 else if (!micromips_p)
9410 {
9411 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9412 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9413 htab->plt_comp_entry_size
9414 = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry);
9415 }
9416 else if (htab->insn32)
9417 {
9418 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9419 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9420 htab->plt_comp_entry_size
9421 = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry);
9422 }
9423 else
9424 {
9425 htab->plt_mips_entry_size
9426 = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
9427 htab->plt_comp_entry_size
9428 = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry);
9429 }
9430 }
9431
9432 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
9433 h->plt.plist = mips_elf_make_plt_record (dynobj);
9434 if (h->plt.plist == NULL)
9435 return FALSE;
9436
9437 /* There are no defined MIPS16 or microMIPS PLT entries for VxWorks,
9438 n32 or n64, so always use a standard entry there.
9439
9440 If the symbol has a MIPS16 call stub and gets a PLT entry, then
9441 all MIPS16 calls will go via that stub, and there is no benefit
9442 to having a MIPS16 entry. And in the case of call_stub a
9443 standard entry actually has to be used as the stub ends with a J
9444 instruction. */
9445 if (newabi_p
9446 || htab->is_vxworks
9447 || hmips->call_stub
9448 || hmips->call_fp_stub)
9449 {
9450 h->plt.plist->need_mips = TRUE;
9451 h->plt.plist->need_comp = FALSE;
9452 }
9453
9454 /* Otherwise, if there are no direct calls to the function, we
9455 have a free choice of whether to use standard or compressed
9456 entries. Prefer microMIPS entries if the object is known to
9457 contain microMIPS code, so that it becomes possible to create
9458 pure microMIPS binaries. Prefer standard entries otherwise,
9459 because MIPS16 ones are no smaller and are usually slower. */
9460 if (!h->plt.plist->need_mips && !h->plt.plist->need_comp)
9461 {
9462 if (micromips_p)
9463 h->plt.plist->need_comp = TRUE;
9464 else
9465 h->plt.plist->need_mips = TRUE;
9466 }
9467
9468 if (h->plt.plist->need_mips)
9469 {
9470 h->plt.plist->mips_offset = htab->plt_mips_offset;
9471 htab->plt_mips_offset += htab->plt_mips_entry_size;
9472 }
9473 if (h->plt.plist->need_comp)
9474 {
9475 h->plt.plist->comp_offset = htab->plt_comp_offset;
9476 htab->plt_comp_offset += htab->plt_comp_entry_size;
9477 }
9478
9479 /* Reserve the corresponding .got.plt entry now too. */
9480 h->plt.plist->gotplt_index = htab->plt_got_index++;
9481
9482 /* If the output file has no definition of the symbol, set the
9483 symbol's value to the address of the stub. */
9484 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && !h->def_regular)
9485 hmips->use_plt_entry = TRUE;
9486
9487 /* Make room for the R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation. */
9488 htab->root.srelplt->size += (htab->is_vxworks
9489 ? MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj)
9490 : MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj));
9491
9492 /* Make room for the .rela.plt.unloaded relocations. */
9493 if (htab->is_vxworks && !bfd_link_pic (info))
9494 htab->srelplt2->size += 3 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9495
9496 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
9497 dynamic will now refer to the PLT entry instead. */
9498 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
9499
9500 return TRUE;
9501 }
9502
9503 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
9504 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
9505 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
9506 if (h->is_weakalias)
9507 {
9508 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
9509 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
9510 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
9511 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
9512 return TRUE;
9513 }
9514
9515 /* Otherwise, there is nothing further to do for symbols defined
9516 in regular objects. */
9517 if (h->def_regular)
9518 return TRUE;
9519
9520 /* There's also nothing more to do if we'll convert all relocations
9521 against this symbol into dynamic relocations. */
9522 if (!hmips->has_static_relocs)
9523 return TRUE;
9524
9525 /* We're now relying on copy relocations. Complain if we have
9526 some that we can't convert. */
9527 if (!htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs || bfd_link_pic (info))
9528 {
9529 _bfd_error_handler (_("non-dynamic relocations refer to "
9530 "dynamic symbol %s"),
9531 h->root.root.string);
9532 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9533 return FALSE;
9534 }
9535
9536 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
9537 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
9538 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
9539 object will contain position independent code, so all references
9540 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
9541 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
9542 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
9543 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
9544 same memory location for the variable. */
9545
9546 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
9547 {
9548 s = htab->root.sdynrelro;
9549 srel = htab->root.sreldynrelro;
9550 }
9551 else
9552 {
9553 s = htab->root.sdynbss;
9554 srel = htab->root.srelbss;
9555 }
9556 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
9557 {
9558 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9559 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9560 else
9561 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, 1);
9562 h->needs_copy = 1;
9563 }
9564
9565 /* All relocations against this symbol that could have been made
9566 dynamic will now refer to the local copy instead. */
9567 hmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs = 0;
9568
9569 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
9570 }
9571 \f
9572 /* This function is called after all the input files have been read,
9573 and the input sections have been assigned to output sections. We
9574 check for any mips16 stub sections that we can discard. */
9575
9576 bfd_boolean
9577 _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9578 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9579 {
9580 asection *sect;
9581 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9582 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
9583
9584 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9585 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9586
9587 /* The .reginfo section has a fixed size. */
9588 sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".reginfo");
9589 if (sect != NULL)
9590 {
9591 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, sect, sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
9592 sect->flags |= SEC_FIXED_SIZE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9593 }
9594
9595 /* The .MIPS.abiflags section has a fixed size. */
9596 sect = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, ".MIPS.abiflags");
9597 if (sect != NULL)
9598 {
9599 bfd_set_section_size (output_bfd, sect,
9600 sizeof (Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0));
9601 sect->flags |= SEC_FIXED_SIZE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
9602 }
9603
9604 hti.info = info;
9605 hti.output_bfd = output_bfd;
9606 hti.error = FALSE;
9607 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
9608 mips_elf_check_symbols, &hti);
9609 if (hti.error)
9610 return FALSE;
9611
9612 return TRUE;
9613 }
9614
9615 /* If the link uses a GOT, lay it out and work out its size. */
9616
9617 static bfd_boolean
9618 mips_elf_lay_out_got (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9619 {
9620 bfd *dynobj;
9621 asection *s;
9622 struct mips_got_info *g;
9623 bfd_size_type loadable_size = 0;
9624 bfd_size_type page_gotno;
9625 bfd *ibfd;
9626 struct mips_elf_traverse_got_arg tga;
9627 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9628
9629 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9630 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9631
9632 s = htab->root.sgot;
9633 if (s == NULL)
9634 return TRUE;
9635
9636 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9637 g = htab->got_info;
9638
9639 /* Allocate room for the reserved entries. VxWorks always reserves
9640 3 entries; other objects only reserve 2 entries. */
9641 BFD_ASSERT (g->assigned_low_gotno == 0);
9642 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9643 htab->reserved_gotno = 3;
9644 else
9645 htab->reserved_gotno = 2;
9646 g->local_gotno += htab->reserved_gotno;
9647 g->assigned_low_gotno = htab->reserved_gotno;
9648
9649 /* Decide which symbols need to go in the global part of the GOT and
9650 count the number of reloc-only GOT symbols. */
9651 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_count_got_symbols, info);
9652
9653 if (!mips_elf_resolve_final_got_entries (info, g))
9654 return FALSE;
9655
9656 /* Calculate the total loadable size of the output. That
9657 will give us the maximum number of GOT_PAGE entries
9658 required. */
9659 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9660 {
9661 asection *subsection;
9662
9663 for (subsection = ibfd->sections;
9664 subsection;
9665 subsection = subsection->next)
9666 {
9667 if ((subsection->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
9668 continue;
9669 loadable_size += ((subsection->size + 0xf)
9670 &~ (bfd_size_type) 0xf);
9671 }
9672 }
9673
9674 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9675 /* There's no need to allocate page entries for VxWorks; R_MIPS*_GOT16
9676 relocations against local symbols evaluate to "G", and the EABI does
9677 not include R_MIPS_GOT_PAGE. */
9678 page_gotno = 0;
9679 else
9680 /* Assume there are two loadable segments consisting of contiguous
9681 sections. Is 5 enough? */
9682 page_gotno = (loadable_size >> 16) + 5;
9683
9684 /* Choose the smaller of the two page estimates; both are intended to be
9685 conservative. */
9686 if (page_gotno > g->page_gotno)
9687 page_gotno = g->page_gotno;
9688
9689 g->local_gotno += page_gotno;
9690 g->assigned_high_gotno = g->local_gotno - 1;
9691
9692 s->size += g->local_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9693 s->size += g->global_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9694 s->size += g->tls_gotno * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9695
9696 /* VxWorks does not support multiple GOTs. It initializes $gp to
9697 __GOTT_BASE__[__GOTT_INDEX__], the value of which is set by the
9698 dynamic loader. */
9699 if (!htab->is_vxworks && s->size > MIPS_ELF_GOT_MAX_SIZE (info))
9700 {
9701 if (!mips_elf_multi_got (output_bfd, info, s, page_gotno))
9702 return FALSE;
9703 }
9704 else
9705 {
9706 /* Record that all bfds use G. This also has the effect of freeing
9707 the per-bfd GOTs, which we no longer need. */
9708 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9709 if (mips_elf_bfd_got (ibfd, FALSE))
9710 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (ibfd, g);
9711 mips_elf_replace_bfd_got (output_bfd, g);
9712
9713 /* Set up TLS entries. */
9714 g->tls_assigned_gotno = g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno;
9715 tga.info = info;
9716 tga.g = g;
9717 tga.value = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
9718 htab_traverse (g->got_entries, mips_elf_initialize_tls_index, &tga);
9719 if (!tga.g)
9720 return FALSE;
9721 BFD_ASSERT (g->tls_assigned_gotno
9722 == g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno + g->tls_gotno);
9723
9724 /* Each VxWorks GOT entry needs an explicit relocation. */
9725 if (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info))
9726 g->relocs += g->global_gotno + g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
9727
9728 /* Allocate room for the TLS relocations. */
9729 if (g->relocs)
9730 mips_elf_allocate_dynamic_relocations (dynobj, info, g->relocs);
9731 }
9732
9733 return TRUE;
9734 }
9735
9736 /* Estimate the size of the .MIPS.stubs section. */
9737
9738 static void
9739 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
9740 {
9741 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9742 bfd_size_type dynsymcount;
9743
9744 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9745 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9746
9747 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
9748 return;
9749
9750 /* IRIX rld assumes that a function stub isn't at the end of the .text
9751 section, so add a dummy entry to the end. */
9752 htab->lazy_stub_count++;
9753
9754 /* Get a worst-case estimate of the number of dynamic symbols needed.
9755 At this point, dynsymcount does not account for section symbols
9756 and count_section_dynsyms may overestimate the number that will
9757 be needed. */
9758 dynsymcount = (elf_hash_table (info)->dynsymcount
9759 + count_section_dynsyms (output_bfd, info));
9760
9761 /* Determine the size of one stub entry. There's no disadvantage
9762 from using microMIPS code here, so for the sake of pure-microMIPS
9763 binaries we prefer it whenever there's any microMIPS code in
9764 output produced at all. This has a benefit of stubs being
9765 shorter by 4 bytes each too, unless in the insn32 mode. */
9766 if (!MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd))
9767 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9768 ? MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9769 : MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9770 else if (htab->insn32)
9771 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9772 ? MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9773 : MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9774 else
9775 htab->function_stub_size = (dynsymcount > 0x10000
9776 ? MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE
9777 : MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_NORMAL_SIZE);
9778
9779 htab->sstubs->size = htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size;
9780 }
9781
9782 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to a
9783 mips_htab_traverse_info. If H needs a traditional MIPS lazy-binding
9784 stub, allocate an entry in the stubs section. */
9785
9786 static bfd_boolean
9787 mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
9788 {
9789 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti = data;
9790 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9791 struct bfd_link_info *info;
9792 bfd *output_bfd;
9793
9794 info = hti->info;
9795 output_bfd = hti->output_bfd;
9796 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9797 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9798
9799 if (h->needs_lazy_stub)
9800 {
9801 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd);
9802 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
9803 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
9804
9805 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.dynobj != NULL);
9806 if (h->root.plt.plist == NULL)
9807 h->root.plt.plist = mips_elf_make_plt_record (htab->sstubs->owner);
9808 if (h->root.plt.plist == NULL)
9809 {
9810 hti->error = TRUE;
9811 return FALSE;
9812 }
9813 h->root.root.u.def.section = htab->sstubs;
9814 h->root.root.u.def.value = htab->sstubs->size + isa_bit;
9815 h->root.plt.plist->stub_offset = htab->sstubs->size;
9816 h->root.other = other;
9817 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
9818 }
9819 return TRUE;
9820 }
9821
9822 /* Allocate offsets in the stubs section to each symbol that needs one.
9823 Set the final size of the .MIPS.stub section. */
9824
9825 static bfd_boolean
9826 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9827 {
9828 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
9829 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd);
9830 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
9831 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
9832 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9833 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
9834 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9835 bfd *dynobj;
9836
9837 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9838 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9839
9840 if (htab->lazy_stub_count == 0)
9841 return TRUE;
9842
9843 htab->sstubs->size = 0;
9844 hti.info = info;
9845 hti.output_bfd = output_bfd;
9846 hti.error = FALSE;
9847 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_allocate_lazy_stub, &hti);
9848 if (hti.error)
9849 return FALSE;
9850 htab->sstubs->size += htab->function_stub_size;
9851 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size
9852 == htab->lazy_stub_count * htab->function_stub_size);
9853
9854 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9855 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
9856 h = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (dynobj, info, htab->sstubs, "_MIPS_STUBS_");
9857 if (h == NULL)
9858 return FALSE;
9859 h->root.u.def.value = isa_bit;
9860 h->other = other;
9861 h->type = STT_FUNC;
9862
9863 return TRUE;
9864 }
9865
9866 /* A mips_elf_link_hash_traverse callback for which DATA points to a
9867 bfd_link_info. If H uses the address of a PLT entry as the value
9868 of the symbol, then set the entry in the symbol table now. Prefer
9869 a standard MIPS PLT entry. */
9870
9871 static bfd_boolean
9872 mips_elf_set_plt_sym_value (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *data)
9873 {
9874 struct bfd_link_info *info = data;
9875 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (info->output_bfd);
9876 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9877 unsigned int other;
9878 bfd_vma isa_bit;
9879 bfd_vma val;
9880
9881 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9882 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9883
9884 if (h->use_plt_entry)
9885 {
9886 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.plt.plist != NULL);
9887 BFD_ASSERT (h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE
9888 || h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE);
9889
9890 val = htab->plt_header_size;
9891 if (h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
9892 {
9893 isa_bit = 0;
9894 val += h->root.plt.plist->mips_offset;
9895 other = 0;
9896 }
9897 else
9898 {
9899 isa_bit = 1;
9900 val += htab->plt_mips_offset + h->root.plt.plist->comp_offset;
9901 other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : STO_MIPS16;
9902 }
9903 val += isa_bit;
9904 /* For VxWorks, point at the PLT load stub rather than the lazy
9905 resolution stub; this stub will become the canonical function
9906 address. */
9907 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9908 val += 8;
9909
9910 h->root.root.u.def.section = htab->root.splt;
9911 h->root.root.u.def.value = val;
9912 h->root.other = other;
9913 }
9914
9915 return TRUE;
9916 }
9917
9918 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
9919
9920 bfd_boolean
9921 _bfd_mips_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9922 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9923 {
9924 bfd *dynobj;
9925 asection *s, *sreldyn;
9926 bfd_boolean reltext;
9927 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9928
9929 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
9930 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
9931 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
9932 BFD_ASSERT (dynobj != NULL);
9933
9934 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
9935 {
9936 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
9937 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
9938 {
9939 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".interp");
9940 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9941 s->size
9942 = strlen (ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd)) + 1;
9943 s->contents
9944 = (bfd_byte *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER (output_bfd);
9945 }
9946
9947 /* Figure out the size of the PLT header if we know that we
9948 are using it. For the sake of cache alignment always use
9949 a standard header whenever any standard entries are present
9950 even if microMIPS entries are present as well. This also
9951 lets the microMIPS header rely on the value of $v0 only set
9952 by microMIPS entries, for a small size reduction.
9953
9954 Set symbol table entry values for symbols that use the
9955 address of their PLT entry now that we can calculate it.
9956
9957 Also create the _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_ symbol if we
9958 haven't already in _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections. */
9959 if (htab->root.splt && htab->plt_mips_offset + htab->plt_comp_offset != 0)
9960 {
9961 bfd_boolean micromips_p = (MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd)
9962 && !htab->plt_mips_offset);
9963 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
9964 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
9965 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
9966 bfd_vma size;
9967
9968 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
9969 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.sgotplt->size == 0);
9970 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.splt->size == 0);
9971
9972 if (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info))
9973 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry);
9974 else if (htab->is_vxworks)
9975 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry);
9976 else if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
9977 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry);
9978 else if (ABI_N32_P (output_bfd))
9979 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry);
9980 else if (!micromips_p)
9981 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
9982 else if (htab->insn32)
9983 size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
9984 else
9985 size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
9986
9987 htab->plt_header_is_comp = micromips_p;
9988 htab->plt_header_size = size;
9989 htab->root.splt->size = (size
9990 + htab->plt_mips_offset
9991 + htab->plt_comp_offset);
9992 htab->root.sgotplt->size = (htab->plt_got_index
9993 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
9994
9995 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (htab, mips_elf_set_plt_sym_value, info);
9996
9997 if (htab->root.hplt == NULL)
9998 {
9999 h = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (dynobj, info, htab->root.splt,
10000 "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_");
10001 htab->root.hplt = h;
10002 if (h == NULL)
10003 return FALSE;
10004 }
10005
10006 h = htab->root.hplt;
10007 h->root.u.def.value = isa_bit;
10008 h->other = other;
10009 h->type = STT_FUNC;
10010 }
10011 }
10012
10013 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
10014 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->root, allocate_dynrelocs, info);
10015
10016 mips_elf_estimate_stub_size (output_bfd, info);
10017
10018 if (!mips_elf_lay_out_got (output_bfd, info))
10019 return FALSE;
10020
10021 mips_elf_lay_out_lazy_stubs (info);
10022
10023 /* The check_relocs and adjust_dynamic_symbol entry points have
10024 determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections. Allocate
10025 memory for them. */
10026 reltext = FALSE;
10027 for (s = dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
10028 {
10029 const char *name;
10030
10031 /* It's OK to base decisions on the section name, because none
10032 of the dynobj section names depend upon the input files. */
10033 name = bfd_get_section_name (dynobj, s);
10034
10035 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
10036 continue;
10037
10038 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rel"))
10039 {
10040 if (s->size != 0)
10041 {
10042 const char *outname;
10043 asection *target;
10044
10045 /* If this relocation section applies to a read only
10046 section, then we probably need a DT_TEXTREL entry.
10047 If the relocation section is .rel(a).dyn, we always
10048 assert a DT_TEXTREL entry rather than testing whether
10049 there exists a relocation to a read only section or
10050 not. */
10051 outname = bfd_get_section_name (output_bfd,
10052 s->output_section);
10053 target = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, outname + 4);
10054 if ((target != NULL
10055 && (target->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0
10056 && (target->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
10057 || strcmp (outname, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) == 0)
10058 reltext = TRUE;
10059
10060 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
10061 to copy relocs into the output file. */
10062 if (strcmp (name, MIPS_ELF_REL_DYN_NAME (info)) != 0)
10063 s->reloc_count = 0;
10064
10065 /* If combreloc is enabled, elf_link_sort_relocs() will
10066 sort relocations, but in a different way than we do,
10067 and before we're done creating relocations. Also, it
10068 will move them around between input sections'
10069 relocation's contents, so our sorting would be
10070 broken, so don't let it run. */
10071 info->combreloc = 0;
10072 }
10073 }
10074 else if (bfd_link_executable (info)
10075 && ! mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_rld_obj_head
10076 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".rld_map"))
10077 {
10078 /* We add a room for __rld_map. It will be filled in by the
10079 rtld to contain a pointer to the _r_debug structure. */
10080 s->size += MIPS_ELF_RLD_MAP_SIZE (output_bfd);
10081 }
10082 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
10083 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".compact_rel"))
10084 s->size += mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_rel_size;
10085 else if (s == htab->root.splt)
10086 {
10087 /* If the last PLT entry has a branch delay slot, allocate
10088 room for an extra nop to fill the delay slot. This is
10089 for CPUs without load interlocking. */
10090 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd)
10091 && ! htab->is_vxworks && s->size > 0)
10092 s->size += 4;
10093 }
10094 else if (! CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".init")
10095 && s != htab->root.sgot
10096 && s != htab->root.sgotplt
10097 && s != htab->sstubs
10098 && s != htab->root.sdynbss
10099 && s != htab->root.sdynrelro)
10100 {
10101 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
10102 continue;
10103 }
10104
10105 if (s->size == 0)
10106 {
10107 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
10108 continue;
10109 }
10110
10111 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
10112 continue;
10113
10114 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
10115 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (dynobj, s->size);
10116 if (s->contents == NULL)
10117 {
10118 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_memory);
10119 return FALSE;
10120 }
10121 }
10122
10123 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
10124 {
10125 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
10126 values later, in _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
10127 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
10128 the .dynamic section. */
10129
10130 /* SGI object has the equivalence of DT_DEBUG in the
10131 DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP entry. This must come first because glibc
10132 only fills in DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP (not DT_DEBUG) and some tools
10133 may only look at the first one they see. */
10134 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
10135 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP, 0))
10136 return FALSE;
10137
10138 if (bfd_link_executable (info)
10139 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL, 0))
10140 return FALSE;
10141
10142 /* The DT_DEBUG entry may be filled in by the dynamic linker and
10143 used by the debugger. */
10144 if (bfd_link_executable (info)
10145 && !SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd)
10146 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_DEBUG, 0))
10147 return FALSE;
10148
10149 if (reltext && (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd) || htab->is_vxworks))
10150 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
10151
10152 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
10153 {
10154 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_TEXTREL, 0))
10155 return FALSE;
10156
10157 /* Clear the DF_TEXTREL flag. It will be set again if we
10158 write out an actual text relocation; we may not, because
10159 at this point we do not know whether e.g. any .eh_frame
10160 absolute relocations have been converted to PC-relative. */
10161 info->flags &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
10162 }
10163
10164 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTGOT, 0))
10165 return FALSE;
10166
10167 sreldyn = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
10168 if (htab->is_vxworks)
10169 {
10170 /* VxWorks uses .rela.dyn instead of .rel.dyn. It does not
10171 use any of the DT_MIPS_* tags. */
10172 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0)
10173 {
10174 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELA, 0))
10175 return FALSE;
10176
10177 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELASZ, 0))
10178 return FALSE;
10179
10180 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELAENT, 0))
10181 return FALSE;
10182 }
10183 }
10184 else
10185 {
10186 if (sreldyn && sreldyn->size > 0
10187 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sreldyn->output_section))
10188 {
10189 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_REL, 0))
10190 return FALSE;
10191
10192 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELSZ, 0))
10193 return FALSE;
10194
10195 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_RELENT, 0))
10196 return FALSE;
10197 }
10198
10199 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION, 0))
10200 return FALSE;
10201
10202 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_FLAGS, 0))
10203 return FALSE;
10204
10205 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS, 0))
10206 return FALSE;
10207
10208 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO, 0))
10209 return FALSE;
10210
10211 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO, 0))
10212 return FALSE;
10213
10214 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO, 0))
10215 return FALSE;
10216
10217 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_GOTSYM, 0))
10218 return FALSE;
10219
10220 if (info->emit_gnu_hash
10221 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_XHASH, 0))
10222 return FALSE;
10223
10224 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix5
10225 && ! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO, 0))
10226 return FALSE;
10227
10228 if (IRIX_COMPAT (dynobj) == ict_irix6
10229 && (bfd_get_section_by_name
10230 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (dynobj)))
10231 && !MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_OPTIONS, 0))
10232 return FALSE;
10233 }
10234 if (htab->root.splt->size > 0)
10235 {
10236 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTREL, 0))
10237 return FALSE;
10238
10239 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_JMPREL, 0))
10240 return FALSE;
10241
10242 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_PLTRELSZ, 0))
10243 return FALSE;
10244
10245 if (! MIPS_ELF_ADD_DYNAMIC_ENTRY (info, DT_MIPS_PLTGOT, 0))
10246 return FALSE;
10247 }
10248 if (htab->is_vxworks
10249 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
10250 return FALSE;
10251 }
10252
10253 return TRUE;
10254 }
10255 \f
10256 /* REL is a relocation in INPUT_BFD that is being copied to OUTPUT_BFD.
10257 Adjust its R_ADDEND field so that it is correct for the output file.
10258 LOCAL_SYMS and LOCAL_SECTIONS are arrays of INPUT_BFD's local symbols
10259 and sections respectively; both use symbol indexes. */
10260
10261 static void
10262 mips_elf_adjust_addend (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
10263 bfd *input_bfd, Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
10264 asection **local_sections, Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
10265 {
10266 unsigned int r_type, r_symndx;
10267 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
10268 asection *sec;
10269
10270 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
10271 {
10272 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
10273 if (gprel16_reloc_p (r_type)
10274 || r_type == R_MIPS_GPREL32
10275 || literal_reloc_p (r_type))
10276 {
10277 rel->r_addend += _bfd_get_gp_value (input_bfd);
10278 rel->r_addend -= _bfd_get_gp_value (output_bfd);
10279 }
10280
10281 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
10282 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
10283
10284 /* Adjust REL's addend to account for section merging. */
10285 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info))
10286 {
10287 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
10288 _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
10289 }
10290
10291 /* This would normally be done by the rela_normal code in elflink.c. */
10292 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_SECTION)
10293 rel->r_addend += local_sections[r_symndx]->output_offset;
10294 }
10295 }
10296
10297 /* Handle relocations against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
10298 or sections discarded by a linker script. We use this wrapper around
10299 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION to handle triplets of compound relocs
10300 on 64-bit ELF targets. In this case for any relocation handled, which
10301 always be the first in a triplet, the remaining two have to be processed
10302 together with the first, even if they are R_MIPS_NONE. It is the symbol
10303 index referred by the first reloc that applies to all the three and the
10304 remaining two never refer to an object symbol. And it is the final
10305 relocation (the last non-null one) that determines the output field of
10306 the whole relocation so retrieve the corresponding howto structure for
10307 the relocatable field to be cleared by RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION.
10308
10309 Note that RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION is a macro that uses "continue"
10310 and therefore requires to be pasted in a loop. It also defines a block
10311 and does not protect any of its arguments, hence the extra brackets. */
10312
10313 static void
10314 mips_reloc_against_discarded_section (bfd *output_bfd,
10315 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10316 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
10317 Elf_Internal_Rela **rel,
10318 const Elf_Internal_Rela **relend,
10319 bfd_boolean rel_reloc,
10320 reloc_howto_type *howto,
10321 bfd_byte *contents)
10322 {
10323 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (output_bfd);
10324 int count = bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
10325 unsigned int r_type;
10326 int i;
10327
10328 for (i = count - 1; i > 0; i--)
10329 {
10330 r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, (*rel)[i].r_info);
10331 if (r_type != R_MIPS_NONE)
10332 {
10333 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
10334 break;
10335 }
10336 }
10337 do
10338 {
10339 RELOC_AGAINST_DISCARDED_SECTION (info, input_bfd, input_section,
10340 (*rel), count, (*relend),
10341 howto, i, contents);
10342 }
10343 while (0);
10344 }
10345
10346 /* Relocate a MIPS ELF section. */
10347
10348 bfd_boolean
10349 _bfd_mips_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info,
10350 bfd *input_bfd, asection *input_section,
10351 bfd_byte *contents, Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
10352 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
10353 asection **local_sections)
10354 {
10355 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
10356 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
10357 bfd_vma addend = 0;
10358 bfd_boolean use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
10359
10360 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
10361 for (rel = relocs; rel < relend; ++rel)
10362 {
10363 const char *name;
10364 bfd_vma value = 0;
10365 reloc_howto_type *howto;
10366 bfd_boolean cross_mode_jump_p = FALSE;
10367 /* TRUE if the relocation is a RELA relocation, rather than a
10368 REL relocation. */
10369 bfd_boolean rela_relocation_p = TRUE;
10370 unsigned int r_type = ELF_R_TYPE (output_bfd, rel->r_info);
10371 const char *msg;
10372 unsigned long r_symndx;
10373 asection *sec;
10374 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
10375 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
10376 bfd_boolean rel_reloc;
10377
10378 rel_reloc = (NEWABI_P (input_bfd)
10379 && mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
10380 relocs, rel));
10381 /* Find the relocation howto for this relocation. */
10382 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, r_type, !rel_reloc);
10383
10384 r_symndx = ELF_R_SYM (input_bfd, rel->r_info);
10385 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (input_bfd)->symtab_hdr;
10386 if (mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel, local_sections))
10387 {
10388 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
10389 h = NULL;
10390 }
10391 else
10392 {
10393 unsigned long extsymoff;
10394
10395 extsymoff = 0;
10396 if (!elf_bad_symtab (input_bfd))
10397 extsymoff = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
10398 h = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd) [r_symndx - extsymoff];
10399 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
10400 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
10401 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
10402
10403 sec = NULL;
10404 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
10405 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
10406 sec = h->root.u.def.section;
10407 }
10408
10409 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
10410 {
10411 mips_reloc_against_discarded_section (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
10412 input_section, &rel, &relend,
10413 rel_reloc, howto, contents);
10414 continue;
10415 }
10416
10417 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (input_bfd))
10418 {
10419 /* Some 32-bit code uses R_MIPS_64. In particular, people use
10420 64-bit code, but make sure all their addresses are in the
10421 lowermost or uppermost 32-bit section of the 64-bit address
10422 space. Thus, when they use an R_MIPS_64 they mean what is
10423 usually meant by R_MIPS_32, with the exception that the
10424 stored value is sign-extended to 64 bits. */
10425 howto = MIPS_ELF_RTYPE_TO_HOWTO (input_bfd, R_MIPS_32, FALSE);
10426
10427 /* On big-endian systems, we need to lie about the position
10428 of the reloc. */
10429 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10430 rel->r_offset += 4;
10431 }
10432
10433 if (!use_saved_addend_p)
10434 {
10435 /* If these relocations were originally of the REL variety,
10436 we must pull the addend out of the field that will be
10437 relocated. Otherwise, we simply use the contents of the
10438 RELA relocation. */
10439 if (mips_elf_rel_relocation_p (input_bfd, input_section,
10440 relocs, rel))
10441 {
10442 rela_relocation_p = FALSE;
10443 addend = mips_elf_read_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel,
10444 howto, contents);
10445 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type)
10446 || (got16_reloc_p (r_type)
10447 && mips_elf_local_relocation_p (input_bfd, rel,
10448 local_sections)))
10449 {
10450 if (!mips_elf_add_lo16_rel_addend (input_bfd, rel, relend,
10451 contents, &addend))
10452 {
10453 if (h)
10454 name = h->root.root.string;
10455 else
10456 name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr,
10457 local_syms + r_symndx,
10458 sec);
10459 _bfd_error_handler
10460 /* xgettext:c-format */
10461 (_("%pB: can't find matching LO16 reloc against `%s'"
10462 " for %s at %#" PRIx64 " in section `%pA'"),
10463 input_bfd, name,
10464 howto->name, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset, input_section);
10465 }
10466 }
10467 else
10468 addend <<= howto->rightshift;
10469 }
10470 else
10471 addend = rel->r_addend;
10472 mips_elf_adjust_addend (output_bfd, info, input_bfd,
10473 local_syms, local_sections, rel);
10474 }
10475
10476 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
10477 {
10478 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd)
10479 && bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10480 rel->r_offset -= 4;
10481
10482 if (!rela_relocation_p && rel->r_addend)
10483 {
10484 addend += rel->r_addend;
10485 if (hi16_reloc_p (r_type) || got16_reloc_p (r_type))
10486 addend = mips_elf_high (addend);
10487 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHER)
10488 addend = mips_elf_higher (addend);
10489 else if (r_type == R_MIPS_HIGHEST)
10490 addend = mips_elf_highest (addend);
10491 else
10492 addend >>= howto->rightshift;
10493
10494 /* We use the source mask, rather than the destination
10495 mask because the place to which we are writing will be
10496 source of the addend in the final link. */
10497 addend &= howto->src_mask;
10498
10499 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
10500 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
10501 ABI. Here, we need to update the addend. It would be
10502 possible to get away with just using the R_MIPS_32 reloc
10503 but for endianness. */
10504 {
10505 bfd_vma sign_bits;
10506 bfd_vma low_bits;
10507 bfd_vma high_bits;
10508
10509 if (addend & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
10510 #ifdef BFD64
10511 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
10512 #else
10513 sign_bits = -1;
10514 #endif
10515 else
10516 sign_bits = 0;
10517
10518 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
10519 do two separate stores. */
10520 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10521 {
10522 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
10523 first. */
10524 low_bits = sign_bits;
10525 high_bits = addend;
10526 }
10527 else
10528 {
10529 low_bits = addend;
10530 high_bits = sign_bits;
10531 }
10532 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
10533 contents + rel->r_offset);
10534 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
10535 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
10536 continue;
10537 }
10538
10539 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, addend,
10540 input_bfd, input_section,
10541 contents, FALSE))
10542 return FALSE;
10543 }
10544
10545 /* Go on to the next relocation. */
10546 continue;
10547 }
10548
10549 /* In the N32 and 64-bit ABIs there may be multiple consecutive
10550 relocations for the same offset. In that case we are
10551 supposed to treat the output of each relocation as the addend
10552 for the next. */
10553 if (rel + 1 < relend
10554 && rel->r_offset == rel[1].r_offset
10555 && ELF_R_TYPE (input_bfd, rel[1].r_info) != R_MIPS_NONE)
10556 use_saved_addend_p = TRUE;
10557 else
10558 use_saved_addend_p = FALSE;
10559
10560 /* Figure out what value we are supposed to relocate. */
10561 switch (mips_elf_calculate_relocation (output_bfd, input_bfd,
10562 input_section, contents,
10563 info, rel, addend, howto,
10564 local_syms, local_sections,
10565 &value, &name, &cross_mode_jump_p,
10566 use_saved_addend_p))
10567 {
10568 case bfd_reloc_continue:
10569 /* There's nothing to do. */
10570 continue;
10571
10572 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
10573 /* mips_elf_calculate_relocation already called the
10574 undefined_symbol callback. There's no real point in
10575 trying to perform the relocation at this point, so we
10576 just skip ahead to the next relocation. */
10577 continue;
10578
10579 case bfd_reloc_notsupported:
10580 msg = _("internal error: unsupported relocation error");
10581 info->callbacks->warning
10582 (info, msg, name, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
10583 return FALSE;
10584
10585 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
10586 if (use_saved_addend_p)
10587 /* Ignore overflow until we reach the last relocation for
10588 a given location. */
10589 ;
10590 else
10591 {
10592 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10593
10594 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10595 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10596 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
10597 if (!htab->small_data_overflow_reported
10598 && (gprel16_reloc_p (howto->type)
10599 || literal_reloc_p (howto->type)))
10600 {
10601 msg = _("small-data section exceeds 64KB;"
10602 " lower small-data size limit (see option -G)");
10603
10604 htab->small_data_overflow_reported = TRUE;
10605 (*info->callbacks->einfo) ("%P: %s\n", msg);
10606 }
10607 (*info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
10608 (info, NULL, name, howto->name, (bfd_vma) 0,
10609 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
10610 }
10611 break;
10612
10613 case bfd_reloc_ok:
10614 break;
10615
10616 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
10617 msg = NULL;
10618 if (jal_reloc_p (howto->type))
10619 msg = (cross_mode_jump_p
10620 ? _("cannot convert a jump to JALX "
10621 "for a non-word-aligned address")
10622 : (howto->type == R_MIPS16_26
10623 ? _("jump to a non-word-aligned address")
10624 : _("jump to a non-instruction-aligned address")));
10625 else if (b_reloc_p (howto->type))
10626 msg = (cross_mode_jump_p
10627 ? _("cannot convert a branch to JALX "
10628 "for a non-word-aligned address")
10629 : _("branch to a non-instruction-aligned address"));
10630 else if (aligned_pcrel_reloc_p (howto->type))
10631 msg = _("PC-relative load from unaligned address");
10632 if (msg)
10633 {
10634 info->callbacks->einfo
10635 ("%X%H: %s\n", input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, msg);
10636 break;
10637 }
10638 /* Fall through. */
10639
10640 default:
10641 abort ();
10642 break;
10643 }
10644
10645 /* If we've got another relocation for the address, keep going
10646 until we reach the last one. */
10647 if (use_saved_addend_p)
10648 {
10649 addend = value;
10650 continue;
10651 }
10652
10653 if (r_type == R_MIPS_64 && ! NEWABI_P (output_bfd))
10654 /* See the comment above about using R_MIPS_64 in the 32-bit
10655 ABI. Until now, we've been using the HOWTO for R_MIPS_32;
10656 that calculated the right value. Now, however, we
10657 sign-extend the 32-bit result to 64-bits, and store it as a
10658 64-bit value. We are especially generous here in that we
10659 go to extreme lengths to support this usage on systems with
10660 only a 32-bit VMA. */
10661 {
10662 bfd_vma sign_bits;
10663 bfd_vma low_bits;
10664 bfd_vma high_bits;
10665
10666 if (value & ((bfd_vma) 1 << 31))
10667 #ifdef BFD64
10668 sign_bits = ((bfd_vma) 1 << 32) - 1;
10669 #else
10670 sign_bits = -1;
10671 #endif
10672 else
10673 sign_bits = 0;
10674
10675 /* If we don't know that we have a 64-bit type,
10676 do two separate stores. */
10677 if (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd))
10678 {
10679 /* Undo what we did above. */
10680 rel->r_offset -= 4;
10681 /* Store the sign-bits (which are most significant)
10682 first. */
10683 low_bits = sign_bits;
10684 high_bits = value;
10685 }
10686 else
10687 {
10688 low_bits = value;
10689 high_bits = sign_bits;
10690 }
10691 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, low_bits,
10692 contents + rel->r_offset);
10693 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, high_bits,
10694 contents + rel->r_offset + 4);
10695 continue;
10696 }
10697
10698 /* Actually perform the relocation. */
10699 if (! mips_elf_perform_relocation (info, howto, rel, value,
10700 input_bfd, input_section,
10701 contents, cross_mode_jump_p))
10702 return FALSE;
10703 }
10704
10705 return TRUE;
10706 }
10707 \f
10708 /* A function that iterates over each entry in la25_stubs and fills
10709 in the code for each one. DATA points to a mips_htab_traverse_info. */
10710
10711 static int
10712 mips_elf_create_la25_stub (void **slot, void *data)
10713 {
10714 struct mips_htab_traverse_info *hti;
10715 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10716 struct mips_elf_la25_stub *stub;
10717 asection *s;
10718 bfd_byte *loc;
10719 bfd_vma offset, target, target_high, target_low;
10720 bfd_vma branch_pc;
10721 bfd_signed_vma pcrel_offset = 0;
10722
10723 stub = (struct mips_elf_la25_stub *) *slot;
10724 hti = (struct mips_htab_traverse_info *) data;
10725 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (hti->info);
10726 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10727
10728 /* Create the section contents, if we haven't already. */
10729 s = stub->stub_section;
10730 loc = s->contents;
10731 if (loc == NULL)
10732 {
10733 loc = bfd_malloc (s->size);
10734 if (loc == NULL)
10735 {
10736 hti->error = TRUE;
10737 return FALSE;
10738 }
10739 s->contents = loc;
10740 }
10741
10742 /* Work out where in the section this stub should go. */
10743 offset = stub->offset;
10744
10745 /* We add 8 here to account for the LUI/ADDIU instructions
10746 before the branch instruction. This cannot be moved down to
10747 where pcrel_offset is calculated as 's' is updated in
10748 mips_elf_get_la25_target. */
10749 branch_pc = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset + offset + 8;
10750
10751 /* Work out the target address. */
10752 target = mips_elf_get_la25_target (stub, &s);
10753 target += s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
10754
10755 target_high = ((target + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10756 target_low = (target & 0xffff);
10757
10758 /* Calculate the PC of the compact branch instruction (for the case where
10759 compact branches are used for either microMIPSR6 or MIPSR6 with
10760 compact branches. Add 4-bytes to account for BC using the PC of the
10761 next instruction as the base. */
10762 pcrel_offset = target - (branch_pc + 4);
10763
10764 if (stub->stub_section != htab->strampoline)
10765 {
10766 /* This is a simple LUI/ADDIU stub. Zero out the beginning
10767 of the section and write the two instructions at the end. */
10768 memset (loc, 0, offset);
10769 loc += offset;
10770 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
10771 {
10772 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10773 LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS (target_high),
10774 loc);
10775 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10776 LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS (target_low),
10777 loc + 4);
10778 }
10779 else
10780 {
10781 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
10782 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 4);
10783 }
10784 }
10785 else
10786 {
10787 /* This is trampoline. */
10788 loc += offset;
10789 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (stub->h->root.other))
10790 {
10791 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10792 LA25_LUI_MICROMIPS (target_high), loc);
10793 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10794 LA25_J_MICROMIPS (target), loc + 4);
10795 bfd_put_micromips_32 (hti->output_bfd,
10796 LA25_ADDIU_MICROMIPS (target_low), loc + 8);
10797 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
10798 }
10799 else
10800 {
10801 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_LUI (target_high), loc);
10802 if (MIPSR6_P (hti->output_bfd) && htab->compact_branches)
10803 {
10804 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 4);
10805 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_BC (pcrel_offset), loc + 8);
10806 }
10807 else
10808 {
10809 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_J (target), loc + 4);
10810 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, LA25_ADDIU (target_low), loc + 8);
10811 }
10812 bfd_put_32 (hti->output_bfd, 0, loc + 12);
10813 }
10814 }
10815 return TRUE;
10816 }
10817
10818 /* If NAME is one of the special IRIX6 symbols defined by the linker,
10819 adjust it appropriately now. */
10820
10821 static void
10822 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
10823 const char *name, Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
10824 {
10825 /* The linker script takes care of providing names and values for
10826 these, but we must place them into the right sections. */
10827 static const char* const text_section_symbols[] = {
10828 "_ftext",
10829 "_etext",
10830 "__dso_displacement",
10831 "__elf_header",
10832 "__program_header_table",
10833 NULL
10834 };
10835
10836 static const char* const data_section_symbols[] = {
10837 "_fdata",
10838 "_edata",
10839 "_end",
10840 "_fbss",
10841 NULL
10842 };
10843
10844 const char* const *p;
10845 int i;
10846
10847 for (i = 0; i < 2; ++i)
10848 for (p = (i == 0) ? text_section_symbols : data_section_symbols;
10849 *p;
10850 ++p)
10851 if (strcmp (*p, name) == 0)
10852 {
10853 /* All of these symbols are given type STT_SECTION by the
10854 IRIX6 linker. */
10855 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
10856 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
10857
10858 /* The IRIX linker puts these symbols in special sections. */
10859 if (i == 0)
10860 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
10861 else
10862 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
10863
10864 break;
10865 }
10866 }
10867
10868 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
10869 dynamic sections here. */
10870
10871 bfd_boolean
10872 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
10873 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10874 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
10875 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
10876 {
10877 bfd *dynobj;
10878 asection *sgot;
10879 struct mips_got_info *g, *gg;
10880 const char *name;
10881 int idx;
10882 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
10883 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
10884
10885 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
10886 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
10887 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
10888 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
10889
10890 BFD_ASSERT (!htab->is_vxworks);
10891
10892 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
10893 && (h->plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE
10894 || h->plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE))
10895 {
10896 /* We've decided to create a PLT entry for this symbol. */
10897 bfd_byte *loc;
10898 bfd_vma header_address, got_address;
10899 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low, load;
10900 bfd_vma got_index;
10901 bfd_vma isa_bit;
10902
10903 got_index = h->plt.plist->gotplt_index;
10904
10905 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
10906 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
10907 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.splt != NULL);
10908 BFD_ASSERT (got_index != MINUS_ONE);
10909 BFD_ASSERT (!h->def_regular);
10910
10911 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
10912 isa_bit = htab->plt_header_is_comp;
10913 header_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
10914 + htab->root.splt->output_offset + isa_bit);
10915
10916 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
10917 got_address = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
10918 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset
10919 + got_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
10920
10921 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
10922 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
10923
10924 /* The PLT sequence is not safe for N64 if .got.plt entry's address
10925 cannot be loaded in two instructions. */
10926 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
10927 && ((got_address + 0x80008000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffffffff) != 0)
10928 {
10929 _bfd_error_handler
10930 /* xgettext:c-format */
10931 (_("%pB: `%pA' entry VMA of %#" PRIx64 " outside the 32-bit range "
10932 "supported; consider using `-Ttext-segment=...'"),
10933 output_bfd,
10934 htab->root.sgotplt->output_section,
10935 (int64_t) got_address);
10936 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_error);
10937 return FALSE;
10938 }
10939
10940 /* Initially point the .got.plt entry at the PLT header. */
10941 loc = (htab->root.sgotplt->contents
10942 + got_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (dynobj));
10943 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
10944 bfd_put_64 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
10945 else
10946 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, header_address, loc);
10947
10948 /* Now handle the PLT itself. First the standard entry (the order
10949 does not matter, we just have to pick one). */
10950 if (h->plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
10951 {
10952 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
10953 bfd_vma plt_offset;
10954
10955 plt_offset = htab->plt_header_size + h->plt.plist->mips_offset;
10956
10957 BFD_ASSERT (plt_offset <= htab->root.splt->size);
10958
10959 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
10960 loc = htab->root.splt->contents + plt_offset;
10961
10962 /* Pick the load opcode. */
10963 load = MIPS_ELF_LOAD_WORD (output_bfd);
10964
10965 /* Fill in the PLT entry itself. */
10966
10967 if (MIPSR6_P (output_bfd))
10968 plt_entry = htab->compact_branches ? mipsr6_exec_plt_entry_compact
10969 : mipsr6_exec_plt_entry;
10970 else
10971 plt_entry = mips_exec_plt_entry;
10972 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_address_high, loc);
10973 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_address_low | load,
10974 loc + 4);
10975
10976 if (! LOAD_INTERLOCKS_P (output_bfd)
10977 || (MIPSR6_P (output_bfd) && htab->compact_branches))
10978 {
10979 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low, loc + 8);
10980 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
10981 }
10982 else
10983 {
10984 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 8);
10985 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_low,
10986 loc + 12);
10987 }
10988 }
10989
10990 /* Now the compressed entry. They come after any standard ones. */
10991 if (h->plt.plist->comp_offset != MINUS_ONE)
10992 {
10993 bfd_vma plt_offset;
10994
10995 plt_offset = (htab->plt_header_size + htab->plt_mips_offset
10996 + h->plt.plist->comp_offset);
10997
10998 BFD_ASSERT (plt_offset <= htab->root.splt->size);
10999
11000 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
11001 loc = htab->root.splt->contents + plt_offset;
11002
11003 /* Fill in the PLT entry itself. */
11004 if (!MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd))
11005 {
11006 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry;
11007
11008 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], loc);
11009 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], loc + 2);
11010 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
11011 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 6);
11012 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
11013 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 10);
11014 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, got_address, loc + 12);
11015 }
11016 else if (htab->insn32)
11017 {
11018 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry;
11019
11020 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], loc);
11021 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, got_address_high, loc + 2);
11022 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
11023 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, got_address_low, loc + 6);
11024 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
11025 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 10);
11026 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 12);
11027 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, got_address_low, loc + 14);
11028 }
11029 else
11030 {
11031 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry;
11032 bfd_signed_vma gotpc_offset;
11033 bfd_vma loc_address;
11034
11035 BFD_ASSERT (got_address % 4 == 0);
11036
11037 loc_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11038 + htab->root.splt->output_offset + plt_offset);
11039 gotpc_offset = got_address - ((loc_address | 3) ^ 3);
11040
11041 /* ADDIUPC has a span of +/-16MB, check we're in range. */
11042 if (gotpc_offset + 0x1000000 >= 0x2000000)
11043 {
11044 _bfd_error_handler
11045 /* xgettext:c-format */
11046 (_("%pB: `%pA' offset of %" PRId64 " from `%pA' "
11047 "beyond the range of ADDIUPC"),
11048 output_bfd,
11049 htab->root.sgotplt->output_section,
11050 (int64_t) gotpc_offset,
11051 htab->root.splt->output_section);
11052 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_error);
11053 return FALSE;
11054 }
11055 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd,
11056 plt_entry[0] | ((gotpc_offset >> 18) & 0x7f), loc);
11057 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, (gotpc_offset >> 2) & 0xffff, loc + 2);
11058 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
11059 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 6);
11060 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
11061 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 10);
11062 }
11063 }
11064
11065 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
11066 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, htab->root.srelplt,
11067 got_index - 2, h->dynindx,
11068 R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT, got_address);
11069
11070 /* We distinguish between PLT entries and lazy-binding stubs by
11071 giving the former an st_other value of STO_MIPS_PLT. Set the
11072 flag and leave the value if there are any relocations in the
11073 binary where pointer equality matters. */
11074 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
11075 if (h->pointer_equality_needed)
11076 sym->st_other = ELF_ST_SET_MIPS_PLT (sym->st_other);
11077 else
11078 {
11079 sym->st_value = 0;
11080 sym->st_other = 0;
11081 }
11082 }
11083
11084 if (h->plt.plist != NULL && h->plt.plist->stub_offset != MINUS_ONE)
11085 {
11086 /* We've decided to create a lazy-binding stub. */
11087 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (output_bfd);
11088 unsigned int other = micromips_p ? STO_MICROMIPS : 0;
11089 bfd_vma stub_size = htab->function_stub_size;
11090 bfd_byte stub[MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE];
11091 bfd_vma isa_bit = micromips_p;
11092 bfd_vma stub_big_size;
11093
11094 if (!micromips_p)
11095 stub_big_size = MIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE;
11096 else if (htab->insn32)
11097 stub_big_size = MICROMIPS_INSN32_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE;
11098 else
11099 stub_big_size = MICROMIPS_FUNCTION_STUB_BIG_SIZE;
11100
11101 /* This symbol has a stub. Set it up. */
11102
11103 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
11104
11105 BFD_ASSERT (stub_size == stub_big_size || h->dynindx <= 0xffff);
11106
11107 /* Values up to 2^31 - 1 are allowed. Larger values would cause
11108 sign extension at runtime in the stub, resulting in a negative
11109 index value. */
11110 if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fffffff)
11111 return FALSE;
11112
11113 /* Fill the stub. */
11114 if (micromips_p)
11115 {
11116 idx = 0;
11117 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW_MICROMIPS (output_bfd),
11118 stub + idx);
11119 idx += 4;
11120 if (htab->insn32)
11121 {
11122 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
11123 STUB_MOVE32_MICROMIPS, stub + idx);
11124 idx += 4;
11125 }
11126 else
11127 {
11128 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE_MICROMIPS, stub + idx);
11129 idx += 2;
11130 }
11131 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
11132 {
11133 long dynindx_hi = (h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff;
11134
11135 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
11136 STUB_LUI_MICROMIPS (dynindx_hi),
11137 stub + idx);
11138 idx += 4;
11139 }
11140 if (htab->insn32)
11141 {
11142 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR32_MICROMIPS,
11143 stub + idx);
11144 idx += 4;
11145 }
11146 else
11147 {
11148 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR_MICROMIPS, stub + idx);
11149 idx += 2;
11150 }
11151
11152 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
11153 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
11154 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
11155 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
11156 STUB_ORI_MICROMIPS (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
11157 stub + idx);
11158 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
11159 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
11160 STUB_LI16U_MICROMIPS (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
11161 stub + idx);
11162 else
11163 bfd_put_micromips_32 (output_bfd,
11164 STUB_LI16S_MICROMIPS (output_bfd,
11165 h->dynindx),
11166 stub + idx);
11167 }
11168 else
11169 {
11170 idx = 0;
11171 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LW (output_bfd), stub + idx);
11172 idx += 4;
11173 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_MOVE, stub + idx);
11174 idx += 4;
11175 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
11176 {
11177 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LUI ((h->dynindx >> 16) & 0x7fff),
11178 stub + idx);
11179 idx += 4;
11180 }
11181
11182 if (!(MIPSR6_P (output_bfd) && htab->compact_branches))
11183 {
11184 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALR, stub + idx);
11185 idx += 4;
11186 }
11187
11188 /* If a large stub is not required and sign extension is not a
11189 problem, then use legacy code in the stub. */
11190 if (stub_size == stub_big_size)
11191 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_ORI (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
11192 stub + idx);
11193 else if (h->dynindx & ~0x7fff)
11194 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16U (h->dynindx & 0xffff),
11195 stub + idx);
11196 else
11197 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_LI16S (output_bfd, h->dynindx),
11198 stub + idx);
11199 idx += 4;
11200
11201 if (MIPSR6_P (output_bfd) && htab->compact_branches)
11202 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, STUB_JALRC, stub + idx);
11203 }
11204
11205 BFD_ASSERT (h->plt.plist->stub_offset <= htab->sstubs->size);
11206 memcpy (htab->sstubs->contents + h->plt.plist->stub_offset,
11207 stub, stub_size);
11208
11209 /* Mark the symbol as undefined. stub_offset != -1 occurs
11210 only for the referenced symbol. */
11211 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
11212
11213 /* The run-time linker uses the st_value field of the symbol
11214 to reset the global offset table entry for this external
11215 to its stub address when unlinking a shared object. */
11216 sym->st_value = (htab->sstubs->output_section->vma
11217 + htab->sstubs->output_offset
11218 + h->plt.plist->stub_offset
11219 + isa_bit);
11220 sym->st_other = other;
11221 }
11222
11223 /* If we have a MIPS16 function with a stub, the dynamic symbol must
11224 refer to the stub, since only the stub uses the standard calling
11225 conventions. */
11226 if (h->dynindx != -1 && hmips->fn_stub != NULL)
11227 {
11228 BFD_ASSERT (hmips->need_fn_stub);
11229 sym->st_value = (hmips->fn_stub->output_section->vma
11230 + hmips->fn_stub->output_offset);
11231 sym->st_size = hmips->fn_stub->size;
11232 sym->st_other = ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (sym->st_other);
11233 }
11234
11235 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1
11236 || h->forced_local);
11237
11238 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
11239 g = htab->got_info;
11240 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
11241
11242 /* Run through the global symbol table, creating GOT entries for all
11243 the symbols that need them. */
11244 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
11245 {
11246 bfd_vma offset;
11247 bfd_vma value;
11248
11249 value = sym->st_value;
11250 offset = mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (output_bfd, info, h);
11251 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, value, sgot->contents + offset);
11252 }
11253
11254 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE && g->next)
11255 {
11256 struct mips_got_entry e, *p;
11257 bfd_vma entry;
11258 bfd_vma offset;
11259
11260 gg = g;
11261
11262 e.abfd = output_bfd;
11263 e.symndx = -1;
11264 e.d.h = hmips;
11265 e.tls_type = GOT_TLS_NONE;
11266
11267 for (g = g->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
11268 {
11269 if (g->got_entries
11270 && (p = (struct mips_got_entry *) htab_find (g->got_entries,
11271 &e)))
11272 {
11273 offset = p->gotidx;
11274 BFD_ASSERT (offset > 0 && offset < htab->root.sgot->size);
11275 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
11276 || (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created
11277 && p->d.h != NULL
11278 && p->d.h->root.def_dynamic
11279 && !p->d.h->root.def_regular))
11280 {
11281 /* Create an R_MIPS_REL32 relocation for this entry. Due to
11282 the various compatibility problems, it's easier to mock
11283 up an R_MIPS_32 or R_MIPS_64 relocation and leave
11284 mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation to calculate the
11285 appropriate addend. */
11286 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
11287
11288 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
11289 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
11290 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_64);
11291 else
11292 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_32);
11293 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset = offset;
11294
11295 entry = 0;
11296 if (! (mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
11297 (output_bfd, info, rel,
11298 e.d.h, NULL, sym->st_value, &entry, sgot)))
11299 return FALSE;
11300 }
11301 else
11302 entry = sym->st_value;
11303 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, entry, sgot->contents + offset);
11304 }
11305 }
11306 }
11307
11308 /* Mark _DYNAMIC and _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ as absolute. */
11309 name = h->root.root.string;
11310 if (h == elf_hash_table (info)->hdynamic
11311 || h == elf_hash_table (info)->hgot)
11312 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
11313 else if (strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINK") == 0
11314 || strcmp (name, "_DYNAMIC_LINKING") == 0)
11315 {
11316 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
11317 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
11318 sym->st_value = 1;
11319 }
11320 else if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
11321 {
11322 if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[0]) == 0
11323 || strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[1]) == 0)
11324 {
11325 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
11326 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
11327 sym->st_value = 0;
11328 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
11329 }
11330 else if (strcmp (name, mips_elf_dynsym_rtproc_names[2]) == 0)
11331 {
11332 sym->st_info = ELF_ST_INFO (STB_GLOBAL, STT_SECTION);
11333 sym->st_other = STO_PROTECTED;
11334 sym->st_value = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->procedure_count;
11335 sym->st_shndx = SHN_ABS;
11336 }
11337 else if (sym->st_shndx != SHN_UNDEF && sym->st_shndx != SHN_ABS)
11338 {
11339 if (h->type == STT_FUNC)
11340 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_TEXT;
11341 else if (h->type == STT_OBJECT)
11342 sym->st_shndx = SHN_MIPS_DATA;
11343 }
11344 }
11345
11346 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
11347 if (h->needs_copy)
11348 {
11349 asection *s;
11350 bfd_vma symval;
11351
11352 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
11353 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11354
11355 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
11356 symval = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
11357 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
11358 + h->root.u.def.value);
11359 mips_elf_output_dynamic_relocation (output_bfd, s, s->reloc_count++,
11360 h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY, symval);
11361 }
11362
11363 /* Handle the IRIX6-specific symbols. */
11364 if (IRIX_COMPAT (output_bfd) == ict_irix6)
11365 mips_elf_irix6_finish_dynamic_symbol (output_bfd, name, sym);
11366
11367 /* Keep dynamic compressed symbols odd. This allows the dynamic linker
11368 to treat compressed symbols like any other. */
11369 if (ELF_ST_IS_MIPS16 (sym->st_other))
11370 {
11371 BFD_ASSERT (sym->st_value & 1);
11372 sym->st_other -= STO_MIPS16;
11373 }
11374 else if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym->st_other))
11375 {
11376 BFD_ASSERT (sym->st_value & 1);
11377 sym->st_other -= STO_MICROMIPS;
11378 }
11379
11380 return TRUE;
11381 }
11382
11383 /* Likewise, for VxWorks. */
11384
11385 bfd_boolean
11386 _bfd_mips_vxworks_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
11387 struct bfd_link_info *info,
11388 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
11389 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
11390 {
11391 bfd *dynobj;
11392 asection *sgot;
11393 struct mips_got_info *g;
11394 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11395 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
11396
11397 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11398 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11399 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
11400 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
11401
11402 if (h->plt.plist != NULL && h->plt.plist->mips_offset != MINUS_ONE)
11403 {
11404 bfd_byte *loc;
11405 bfd_vma plt_address, got_address, got_offset, branch_offset;
11406 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
11407 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
11408 bfd_vma gotplt_index;
11409 bfd_vma plt_offset;
11410
11411 plt_offset = htab->plt_header_size + h->plt.plist->mips_offset;
11412 gotplt_index = h->plt.plist->gotplt_index;
11413
11414 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
11415 BFD_ASSERT (htab->root.splt != NULL);
11416 BFD_ASSERT (gotplt_index != MINUS_ONE);
11417 BFD_ASSERT (plt_offset <= htab->root.splt->size);
11418
11419 /* Calculate the address of the .plt entry. */
11420 plt_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11421 + htab->root.splt->output_offset
11422 + plt_offset);
11423
11424 /* Calculate the address of the .got.plt entry. */
11425 got_address = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
11426 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset
11427 + gotplt_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
11428
11429 /* Calculate the offset of the .got.plt entry from
11430 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
11431 got_offset = mips_elf_gotplt_index (info, h);
11432
11433 /* Calculate the offset for the branch at the start of the PLT
11434 entry. The branch jumps to the beginning of .plt. */
11435 branch_offset = -(plt_offset / 4 + 1) & 0xffff;
11436
11437 /* Fill in the initial value of the .got.plt entry. */
11438 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_address,
11439 (htab->root.sgotplt->contents
11440 + gotplt_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd)));
11441
11442 /* Find out where the .plt entry should go. */
11443 loc = htab->root.splt->contents + plt_offset;
11444
11445 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
11446 {
11447 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_shared_plt_entry;
11448 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
11449 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_index, loc + 4);
11450 }
11451 else
11452 {
11453 bfd_vma got_address_high, got_address_low;
11454
11455 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt_entry;
11456 got_address_high = ((got_address + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
11457 got_address_low = got_address & 0xffff;
11458
11459 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | branch_offset, loc);
11460 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_index, loc + 4);
11461 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | got_address_high, loc + 8);
11462 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3] | got_address_low, loc + 12);
11463 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
11464 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
11465 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
11466 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
11467
11468 loc = (htab->srelplt2->contents
11469 + (gotplt_index * 3 + 2) * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
11470
11471 /* Emit a relocation for the .got.plt entry. */
11472 rel.r_offset = got_address;
11473 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
11474 rel.r_addend = plt_offset;
11475 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11476
11477 /* Emit a relocation for the lui of %hi(<.got.plt slot>). */
11478 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11479 rel.r_offset = plt_address + 8;
11480 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
11481 rel.r_addend = got_offset;
11482 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11483
11484 /* Emit a relocation for the addiu of %lo(<.got.plt slot>). */
11485 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11486 rel.r_offset += 4;
11487 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
11488 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11489 }
11490
11491 /* Emit an R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT relocation against the .got.plt entry. */
11492 loc = (htab->root.srelplt->contents
11493 + gotplt_index * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
11494 rel.r_offset = got_address;
11495 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_JUMP_SLOT);
11496 rel.r_addend = 0;
11497 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11498
11499 if (!h->def_regular)
11500 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
11501 }
11502
11503 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1 || h->forced_local);
11504
11505 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
11506 g = htab->got_info;
11507 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
11508
11509 /* See if this symbol has an entry in the GOT. */
11510 if (hmips->global_got_area != GGA_NONE)
11511 {
11512 bfd_vma offset;
11513 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
11514 bfd_byte *loc;
11515 asection *s;
11516
11517 /* Install the symbol value in the GOT. */
11518 offset = mips_elf_primary_global_got_index (output_bfd, info, h);
11519 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, sym->st_value, sgot->contents + offset);
11520
11521 /* Add a dynamic relocation for it. */
11522 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
11523 loc = s->contents + (s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
11524 outrel.r_offset = (sgot->output_section->vma
11525 + sgot->output_offset
11526 + offset);
11527 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_32);
11528 outrel.r_addend = 0;
11529 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (dynobj, &outrel, loc);
11530 }
11531
11532 /* Emit a copy reloc, if needed. */
11533 if (h->needs_copy)
11534 {
11535 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
11536 asection *srel;
11537 bfd_byte *loc;
11538
11539 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
11540
11541 rel.r_offset = (h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
11542 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset
11543 + h->root.u.def.value);
11544 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_MIPS_COPY);
11545 rel.r_addend = 0;
11546 if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->root.sdynrelro)
11547 srel = htab->root.sreldynrelro;
11548 else
11549 srel = htab->root.srelbss;
11550 loc = srel->contents + srel->reloc_count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11551 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11552 ++srel->reloc_count;
11553 }
11554
11555 /* If this is a mips16/microMIPS symbol, force the value to be even. */
11556 if (ELF_ST_IS_COMPRESSED (sym->st_other))
11557 sym->st_value &= ~1;
11558
11559 return TRUE;
11560 }
11561
11562 /* Write out a plt0 entry to the beginning of .plt. */
11563
11564 static bfd_boolean
11565 mips_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11566 {
11567 bfd_byte *loc;
11568 bfd_vma gotplt_value, gotplt_value_high, gotplt_value_low;
11569 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
11570 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11571
11572 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11573 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11574
11575 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
11576 plt_entry = (htab->compact_branches
11577 ? mipsr6_n64_exec_plt0_entry_compact
11578 : mips_n64_exec_plt0_entry);
11579 else if (ABI_N32_P (output_bfd))
11580 plt_entry = (htab->compact_branches
11581 ? mipsr6_n32_exec_plt0_entry_compact
11582 : mips_n32_exec_plt0_entry);
11583 else if (!htab->plt_header_is_comp)
11584 plt_entry = (htab->compact_branches
11585 ? mipsr6_o32_exec_plt0_entry_compact
11586 : mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
11587 else if (htab->insn32)
11588 plt_entry = micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
11589 else
11590 plt_entry = micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry;
11591
11592 /* Calculate the value of .got.plt. */
11593 gotplt_value = (htab->root.sgotplt->output_section->vma
11594 + htab->root.sgotplt->output_offset);
11595 gotplt_value_high = ((gotplt_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
11596 gotplt_value_low = gotplt_value & 0xffff;
11597
11598 /* The PLT sequence is not safe for N64 if .got.plt's address can
11599 not be loaded in two instructions. */
11600 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
11601 && ((gotplt_value + 0x80008000) & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffffffff) != 0)
11602 {
11603 _bfd_error_handler
11604 /* xgettext:c-format */
11605 (_("%pB: `%pA' start VMA of %#" PRIx64 " outside the 32-bit range "
11606 "supported; consider using `-Ttext-segment=...'"),
11607 output_bfd,
11608 htab->root.sgotplt->output_section,
11609 (int64_t) gotplt_value);
11610 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_error);
11611 return FALSE;
11612 }
11613
11614 /* Install the PLT header. */
11615 loc = htab->root.splt->contents;
11616 if (plt_entry == micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
11617 {
11618 bfd_vma gotpc_offset;
11619 bfd_vma loc_address;
11620 size_t i;
11621
11622 BFD_ASSERT (gotplt_value % 4 == 0);
11623
11624 loc_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11625 + htab->root.splt->output_offset);
11626 gotpc_offset = gotplt_value - ((loc_address | 3) ^ 3);
11627
11628 /* ADDIUPC has a span of +/-16MB, check we're in range. */
11629 if (gotpc_offset + 0x1000000 >= 0x2000000)
11630 {
11631 _bfd_error_handler
11632 /* xgettext:c-format */
11633 (_("%pB: `%pA' offset of %" PRId64 " from `%pA' "
11634 "beyond the range of ADDIUPC"),
11635 output_bfd,
11636 htab->root.sgotplt->output_section,
11637 (int64_t) gotpc_offset,
11638 htab->root.splt->output_section);
11639 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_no_error);
11640 return FALSE;
11641 }
11642 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd,
11643 plt_entry[0] | ((gotpc_offset >> 18) & 0x7f), loc);
11644 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, (gotpc_offset >> 2) & 0xffff, loc + 2);
11645 for (i = 2; i < ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry); i++)
11646 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[i], loc + (i * 2));
11647 }
11648 else if (plt_entry == micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
11649 {
11650 size_t i;
11651
11652 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], loc);
11653 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, gotplt_value_high, loc + 2);
11654 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 4);
11655 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, gotplt_value_low, loc + 6);
11656 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 8);
11657 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, gotplt_value_low, loc + 10);
11658 for (i = 6; i < ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry); i++)
11659 bfd_put_16 (output_bfd, plt_entry[i], loc + (i * 2));
11660 }
11661 else
11662 {
11663 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | gotplt_value_high, loc);
11664 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 4);
11665 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2] | gotplt_value_low, loc + 8);
11666 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
11667 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
11668 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
11669 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], loc + 24);
11670 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], loc + 28);
11671 }
11672
11673 return TRUE;
11674 }
11675
11676 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks executable and finalize the
11677 contents of .rela.plt.unloaded. */
11678
11679 static void
11680 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11681 {
11682 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
11683 bfd_byte *loc;
11684 bfd_vma got_value, got_value_high, got_value_low, plt_address;
11685 static const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
11686 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11687
11688 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11689 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11690
11691 plt_entry = mips_vxworks_exec_plt0_entry;
11692
11693 /* Calculate the value of _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
11694 got_value = (htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
11695 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.section->output_offset
11696 + htab->root.hgot->root.u.def.value);
11697
11698 got_value_high = ((got_value + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
11699 got_value_low = got_value & 0xffff;
11700
11701 /* Calculate the address of the PLT header. */
11702 plt_address = (htab->root.splt->output_section->vma
11703 + htab->root.splt->output_offset);
11704
11705 /* Install the PLT header. */
11706 loc = htab->root.splt->contents;
11707 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | got_value_high, loc);
11708 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | got_value_low, loc + 4);
11709 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], loc + 8);
11710 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], loc + 12);
11711 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], loc + 16);
11712 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], loc + 20);
11713
11714 /* Output the relocation for the lui of %hi(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
11715 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
11716 rela.r_offset = plt_address;
11717 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
11718 rela.r_addend = 0;
11719 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
11720 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11721
11722 /* Output the relocation for the following addiu of
11723 %lo(_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_). */
11724 rela.r_offset += 4;
11725 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
11726 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
11727 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11728
11729 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
11730 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
11731 in which symbols were output. */
11732 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
11733 {
11734 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
11735
11736 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
11737 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hplt->indx, R_MIPS_32);
11738 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11739 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11740
11741 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
11742 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_HI16);
11743 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11744 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11745
11746 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
11747 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->root.hgot->indx, R_MIPS_LO16);
11748 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
11749 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
11750 }
11751 }
11752
11753 /* Install the PLT header for a VxWorks shared library. */
11754
11755 static void
11756 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (bfd *output_bfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
11757 {
11758 unsigned int i;
11759 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11760
11761 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11762 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11763
11764 /* We just need to copy the entry byte-by-byte. */
11765 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry); i++)
11766 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, mips_vxworks_shared_plt0_entry[i],
11767 htab->root.splt->contents + i * 4);
11768 }
11769
11770 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
11771
11772 bfd_boolean
11773 _bfd_mips_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
11774 struct bfd_link_info *info)
11775 {
11776 bfd *dynobj;
11777 asection *sdyn;
11778 asection *sgot;
11779 struct mips_got_info *gg, *g;
11780 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
11781
11782 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
11783 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
11784
11785 dynobj = elf_hash_table (info)->dynobj;
11786
11787 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
11788
11789 sgot = htab->root.sgot;
11790 gg = htab->got_info;
11791
11792 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
11793 {
11794 bfd_byte *b;
11795 int dyn_to_skip = 0, dyn_skipped = 0;
11796
11797 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
11798 BFD_ASSERT (gg != NULL);
11799
11800 g = mips_elf_bfd_got (output_bfd, FALSE);
11801 BFD_ASSERT (g != NULL);
11802
11803 for (b = sdyn->contents;
11804 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
11805 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
11806 {
11807 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
11808 const char *name;
11809 size_t elemsize;
11810 asection *s;
11811 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
11812
11813 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
11814 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
11815
11816 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
11817 swap_out_p = TRUE;
11818
11819 switch (dyn.d_tag)
11820 {
11821 case DT_RELENT:
11822 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (dynobj);
11823 break;
11824
11825 case DT_RELAENT:
11826 BFD_ASSERT (htab->is_vxworks);
11827 dyn.d_un.d_val = MIPS_ELF_RELA_SIZE (dynobj);
11828 break;
11829
11830 case DT_STRSZ:
11831 /* Rewrite DT_STRSZ. */
11832 dyn.d_un.d_val =
11833 _bfd_elf_strtab_size (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr);
11834 break;
11835
11836 case DT_PLTGOT:
11837 s = htab->root.sgot;
11838 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
11839 break;
11840
11841 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
11842 s = htab->root.sgotplt;
11843 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
11844 break;
11845
11846 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
11847 dyn.d_un.d_val = 1; /* XXX */
11848 break;
11849
11850 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
11851 dyn.d_un.d_val = RHF_NOTPOT; /* XXX */
11852 break;
11853
11854 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
11855 {
11856 time_t t;
11857 time (&t);
11858 dyn.d_un.d_val = t;
11859 }
11860 break;
11861
11862 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
11863 /* XXX FIXME: */
11864 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11865 break;
11866
11867 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
11868 /* XXX FIXME: */
11869 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11870 break;
11871
11872 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
11873 s = output_bfd->sections;
11874 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
11875 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma & ~(bfd_vma) 0xffff;
11876 break;
11877
11878 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
11879 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno;
11880 break;
11881
11882 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
11883 /* The index into the dynamic symbol table which is the
11884 entry of the first external symbol that is not
11885 referenced within the same object. */
11886 dyn.d_un.d_val = bfd_count_sections (output_bfd) + 1;
11887 break;
11888
11889 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
11890 if (htab->global_gotsym)
11891 {
11892 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->global_gotsym->dynindx;
11893 break;
11894 }
11895 /* In case if we don't have global got symbols we default
11896 to setting DT_MIPS_GOTSYM to the same value as
11897 DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO. */
11898 /* Fall through. */
11899
11900 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
11901 name = ".dynsym";
11902 elemsize = MIPS_ELF_SYM_SIZE (output_bfd);
11903 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, name);
11904
11905 if (s != NULL)
11906 dyn.d_un.d_val = s->size / elemsize;
11907 else
11908 dyn.d_un.d_val = 0;
11909 break;
11910
11911 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
11912 dyn.d_un.d_val = g->local_gotno - htab->reserved_gotno;
11913 break;
11914
11915 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
11916 {
11917 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11918 h = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol;
11919 if (!h)
11920 {
11921 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
11922 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11923 break;
11924 }
11925 s = h->root.u.def.section;
11926
11927 /* The MIPS_RLD_MAP tag stores the absolute address of the
11928 debug pointer. */
11929 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
11930 + h->root.u.def.value);
11931 }
11932 break;
11933
11934 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL:
11935 {
11936 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
11937 bfd_vma dt_addr, rld_addr;
11938 h = mips_elf_hash_table (info)->rld_symbol;
11939 if (!h)
11940 {
11941 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
11942 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11943 break;
11944 }
11945 s = h->root.u.def.section;
11946
11947 /* The MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL tag stores the offset to the debug
11948 pointer, relative to the address of the tag. */
11949 dt_addr = (sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset
11950 + (b - sdyn->contents));
11951 rld_addr = (s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset
11952 + h->root.u.def.value);
11953 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = rld_addr - dt_addr;
11954 }
11955 break;
11956
11957 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
11958 s = (bfd_get_section_by_name
11959 (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (output_bfd)));
11960 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->vma;
11961 break;
11962
11963 case DT_PLTREL:
11964 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11965 if (htab->is_vxworks)
11966 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_RELA;
11967 else
11968 dyn.d_un.d_val = DT_REL;
11969 break;
11970
11971 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
11972 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11973 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->root.srelplt->size;
11974 break;
11975
11976 case DT_JMPREL:
11977 BFD_ASSERT (htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs);
11978 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = (htab->root.srelplt->output_section->vma
11979 + htab->root.srelplt->output_offset);
11980 break;
11981
11982 case DT_TEXTREL:
11983 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, delete
11984 the dynamic tag. */
11985 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
11986 {
11987 dyn_to_skip = MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj);
11988 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11989 }
11990 break;
11991
11992 case DT_FLAGS:
11993 /* If we didn't need any text relocations after all, clear
11994 DF_TEXTREL from DT_FLAGS. */
11995 if (!(info->flags & DF_TEXTREL))
11996 dyn.d_un.d_val &= ~DF_TEXTREL;
11997 else
11998 swap_out_p = FALSE;
11999 break;
12000
12001 case DT_MIPS_XHASH:
12002 name = ".MIPS.xhash";
12003 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, name);
12004 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
12005 break;
12006
12007 default:
12008 swap_out_p = FALSE;
12009 if (htab->is_vxworks
12010 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
12011 swap_out_p = TRUE;
12012 break;
12013 }
12014
12015 if (swap_out_p || dyn_skipped)
12016 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
12017 (dynobj, &dyn, b - dyn_skipped);
12018
12019 if (dyn_to_skip)
12020 {
12021 dyn_skipped += dyn_to_skip;
12022 dyn_to_skip = 0;
12023 }
12024 }
12025
12026 /* Wipe out any trailing entries if we shifted down a dynamic tag. */
12027 if (dyn_skipped > 0)
12028 memset (b - dyn_skipped, 0, dyn_skipped);
12029 }
12030
12031 if (sgot != NULL && sgot->size > 0
12032 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sgot->output_section))
12033 {
12034 if (htab->is_vxworks)
12035 {
12036 /* The first entry of the global offset table points to the
12037 ".dynamic" section. The second is initialized by the
12038 loader and contains the shared library identifier.
12039 The third is also initialized by the loader and points
12040 to the lazy resolution stub. */
12041 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd,
12042 sdyn->output_offset + sdyn->output_section->vma,
12043 sgot->contents);
12044 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
12045 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
12046 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0,
12047 sgot->contents
12048 + 2 * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
12049 }
12050 else
12051 {
12052 /* The first entry of the global offset table will be filled at
12053 runtime. The second entry will be used by some runtime loaders.
12054 This isn't the case of IRIX rld. */
12055 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, (bfd_vma) 0, sgot->contents);
12056 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
12057 sgot->contents + MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
12058 }
12059
12060 elf_section_data (sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize
12061 = MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
12062 }
12063
12064 /* Generate dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots. */
12065 if (gg != NULL && gg->next)
12066 {
12067 Elf_Internal_Rela rel[3];
12068 bfd_vma addend = 0;
12069
12070 memset (rel, 0, sizeof (rel));
12071 rel[0].r_info = ELF_R_INFO (output_bfd, 0, R_MIPS_REL32);
12072
12073 for (g = gg->next; g->next != gg; g = g->next)
12074 {
12075 bfd_vma got_index = g->next->local_gotno + g->next->global_gotno
12076 + g->next->tls_gotno;
12077
12078 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, 0, sgot->contents
12079 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
12080 MIPS_ELF_PUT_WORD (output_bfd, MIPS_ELF_GNU_GOT1_MASK (output_bfd),
12081 sgot->contents
12082 + got_index++ * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd));
12083
12084 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
12085 continue;
12086
12087 for (; got_index < g->local_gotno; got_index++)
12088 {
12089 if (got_index >= g->assigned_low_gotno
12090 && got_index <= g->assigned_high_gotno)
12091 continue;
12092
12093 rel[0].r_offset = rel[1].r_offset = rel[2].r_offset
12094 = got_index * MIPS_ELF_GOT_SIZE (output_bfd);
12095 if (!(mips_elf_create_dynamic_relocation
12096 (output_bfd, info, rel, NULL,
12097 bfd_abs_section_ptr,
12098 0, &addend, sgot)))
12099 return FALSE;
12100 BFD_ASSERT (addend == 0);
12101 }
12102 }
12103 }
12104
12105 /* The generation of dynamic relocations for the non-primary gots
12106 adds more dynamic relocations. We cannot count them until
12107 here. */
12108
12109 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
12110 {
12111 bfd_byte *b;
12112 bfd_boolean swap_out_p;
12113
12114 BFD_ASSERT (sdyn != NULL);
12115
12116 for (b = sdyn->contents;
12117 b < sdyn->contents + sdyn->size;
12118 b += MIPS_ELF_DYN_SIZE (dynobj))
12119 {
12120 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
12121 asection *s;
12122
12123 /* Read in the current dynamic entry. */
12124 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_in) (dynobj, b, &dyn);
12125
12126 /* Assume that we're going to modify it and write it out. */
12127 swap_out_p = TRUE;
12128
12129 switch (dyn.d_tag)
12130 {
12131 case DT_RELSZ:
12132 /* Reduce DT_RELSZ to account for any relocations we
12133 decided not to make. This is for the n64 irix rld,
12134 which doesn't seem to apply any relocations if there
12135 are trailing null entries. */
12136 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
12137 dyn.d_un.d_val = (s->reloc_count
12138 * (ABI_64_P (output_bfd)
12139 ? sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel)
12140 : sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel)));
12141 /* Adjust the section size too. Tools like the prelinker
12142 can reasonably expect the values to the same. */
12143 BFD_ASSERT (!bfd_is_abs_section (s->output_section));
12144 elf_section_data (s->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_size
12145 = dyn.d_un.d_val;
12146 break;
12147
12148 default:
12149 swap_out_p = FALSE;
12150 break;
12151 }
12152
12153 if (swap_out_p)
12154 (*get_elf_backend_data (dynobj)->s->swap_dyn_out)
12155 (dynobj, &dyn, b);
12156 }
12157 }
12158
12159 {
12160 asection *s;
12161 Elf32_compact_rel cpt;
12162
12163 if (SGI_COMPAT (output_bfd))
12164 {
12165 /* Write .compact_rel section out. */
12166 s = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".compact_rel");
12167 if (s != NULL)
12168 {
12169 cpt.id1 = 1;
12170 cpt.num = s->reloc_count;
12171 cpt.id2 = 2;
12172 cpt.offset = (s->output_section->filepos
12173 + sizeof (Elf32_External_compact_rel));
12174 cpt.reserved0 = 0;
12175 cpt.reserved1 = 0;
12176 bfd_elf32_swap_compact_rel_out (output_bfd, &cpt,
12177 ((Elf32_External_compact_rel *)
12178 s->contents));
12179
12180 /* Clean up a dummy stub function entry in .text. */
12181 if (htab->sstubs != NULL)
12182 {
12183 file_ptr dummy_offset;
12184
12185 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sstubs->size >= htab->function_stub_size);
12186 dummy_offset = htab->sstubs->size - htab->function_stub_size;
12187 memset (htab->sstubs->contents + dummy_offset, 0,
12188 htab->function_stub_size);
12189 }
12190 }
12191 }
12192
12193 /* The psABI says that the dynamic relocations must be sorted in
12194 increasing order of r_symndx. The VxWorks EABI doesn't require
12195 this, and because the code below handles REL rather than RELA
12196 relocations, using it for VxWorks would be outright harmful. */
12197 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
12198 {
12199 s = mips_elf_rel_dyn_section (info, FALSE);
12200 if (s != NULL
12201 && s->size > (bfd_vma)2 * MIPS_ELF_REL_SIZE (output_bfd))
12202 {
12203 reldyn_sorting_bfd = output_bfd;
12204
12205 if (ABI_64_P (output_bfd))
12206 qsort ((Elf64_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
12207 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf64_Mips_External_Rel),
12208 sort_dynamic_relocs_64);
12209 else
12210 qsort ((Elf32_External_Rel *) s->contents + 1,
12211 s->reloc_count - 1, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rel),
12212 sort_dynamic_relocs);
12213 }
12214 }
12215 }
12216
12217 if (htab->root.splt && htab->root.splt->size > 0)
12218 {
12219 if (htab->is_vxworks)
12220 {
12221 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
12222 mips_vxworks_finish_shared_plt (output_bfd, info);
12223 else
12224 mips_vxworks_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info);
12225 }
12226 else
12227 {
12228 BFD_ASSERT (!bfd_link_pic (info));
12229 if (!mips_finish_exec_plt (output_bfd, info))
12230 return FALSE;
12231 }
12232 }
12233 return TRUE;
12234 }
12235
12236
12237 /* Set ABFD's EF_MIPS_ARCH and EF_MIPS_MACH flags. */
12238
12239 static void
12240 mips_set_isa_flags (bfd *abfd)
12241 {
12242 flagword val;
12243
12244 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
12245 {
12246 default:
12247 if (ABI_N32_P (abfd) || ABI_64_P (abfd))
12248 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
12249 else
12250 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
12251 break;
12252
12253 case bfd_mach_mips3000:
12254 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1;
12255 break;
12256
12257 case bfd_mach_mips3900:
12258 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_1 | E_MIPS_MACH_3900;
12259 break;
12260
12261 case bfd_mach_mips6000:
12262 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2;
12263 break;
12264
12265 case bfd_mach_mips4010:
12266 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_2 | E_MIPS_MACH_4010;
12267 break;
12268
12269 case bfd_mach_mips4000:
12270 case bfd_mach_mips4300:
12271 case bfd_mach_mips4400:
12272 case bfd_mach_mips4600:
12273 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3;
12274 break;
12275
12276 case bfd_mach_mips4100:
12277 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4100;
12278 break;
12279
12280 case bfd_mach_mips4111:
12281 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4111;
12282 break;
12283
12284 case bfd_mach_mips4120:
12285 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4120;
12286 break;
12287
12288 case bfd_mach_mips4650:
12289 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_4650;
12290 break;
12291
12292 case bfd_mach_mips5400:
12293 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5400;
12294 break;
12295
12296 case bfd_mach_mips5500:
12297 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_5500;
12298 break;
12299
12300 case bfd_mach_mips5900:
12301 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_5900;
12302 break;
12303
12304 case bfd_mach_mips9000:
12305 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4 | E_MIPS_MACH_9000;
12306 break;
12307
12308 case bfd_mach_mips5000:
12309 case bfd_mach_mips7000:
12310 case bfd_mach_mips8000:
12311 case bfd_mach_mips10000:
12312 case bfd_mach_mips12000:
12313 case bfd_mach_mips14000:
12314 case bfd_mach_mips16000:
12315 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_4;
12316 break;
12317
12318 case bfd_mach_mips5:
12319 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_5;
12320 break;
12321
12322 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e:
12323 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2E;
12324 break;
12325
12326 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f:
12327 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_3 | E_MIPS_MACH_LS2F;
12328 break;
12329
12330 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1:
12331 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_SB1;
12332 break;
12333
12334 case bfd_mach_mips_gs464:
12335 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_GS464;
12336 break;
12337
12338 case bfd_mach_mips_gs464e:
12339 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_GS464E;
12340 break;
12341
12342 case bfd_mach_mips_gs264e:
12343 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_GS264E;
12344 break;
12345
12346 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon:
12347 case bfd_mach_mips_octeonp:
12348 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON;
12349 break;
12350
12351 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon3:
12352 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON3;
12353 break;
12354
12355 case bfd_mach_mips_xlr:
12356 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64 | E_MIPS_MACH_XLR;
12357 break;
12358
12359 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon2:
12360 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_OCTEON2;
12361 break;
12362
12363 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32:
12364 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32;
12365 break;
12366
12367 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64:
12368 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64;
12369 break;
12370
12371 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2:
12372 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r3:
12373 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r5:
12374 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2;
12375 break;
12376
12377 case bfd_mach_mips_interaptiv_mr2:
12378 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2 | E_MIPS_MACH_IAMR2;
12379 break;
12380
12381 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2:
12382 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r3:
12383 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r5:
12384 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2;
12385 break;
12386
12387 case bfd_mach_mipsisa32r6:
12388 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6;
12389 break;
12390
12391 case bfd_mach_mipsisa64r6:
12392 val = E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6;
12393 break;
12394 }
12395 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
12396 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags |= val;
12397
12398 }
12399
12400
12401 /* Whether to sort relocs output by ld -r or ld --emit-relocs, by r_offset.
12402 Don't do so for code sections. We want to keep ordering of HI16/LO16
12403 as is. On the other hand, elf-eh-frame.c processing requires .eh_frame
12404 relocs to be sorted. */
12405
12406 bfd_boolean
12407 _bfd_mips_elf_sort_relocs_p (asection *sec)
12408 {
12409 return (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0;
12410 }
12411
12412
12413 /* The final processing done just before writing out a MIPS ELF object
12414 file. This gets the MIPS architecture right based on the machine
12415 number. This is used by both the 32-bit and the 64-bit ABI. */
12416
12417 void
12418 _bfd_mips_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
12419 {
12420 unsigned int i;
12421 Elf_Internal_Shdr **hdrpp;
12422 const char *name;
12423 asection *sec;
12424
12425 /* Keep the existing EF_MIPS_MACH and EF_MIPS_ARCH flags if the former
12426 is nonzero. This is for compatibility with old objects, which used
12427 a combination of a 32-bit EF_MIPS_ARCH and a 64-bit EF_MIPS_MACH. */
12428 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_MACH) == 0)
12429 mips_set_isa_flags (abfd);
12430
12431 /* Set the sh_info field for .gptab sections and other appropriate
12432 info for each special section. */
12433 for (i = 1, hdrpp = elf_elfsections (abfd) + 1;
12434 i < elf_numsections (abfd);
12435 i++, hdrpp++)
12436 {
12437 switch ((*hdrpp)->sh_type)
12438 {
12439 case SHT_MIPS_MSYM:
12440 case SHT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
12441 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynstr");
12442 if (sec != NULL)
12443 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12444 break;
12445
12446 case SHT_MIPS_GPTAB:
12447 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
12448 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
12449 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
12450 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".gptab."));
12451 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1);
12452 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
12453 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12454 break;
12455
12456 case SHT_MIPS_CONTENT:
12457 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
12458 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
12459 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL
12460 && CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.content"));
12461 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12462 name + sizeof ".MIPS.content" - 1);
12463 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
12464 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12465 break;
12466
12467 case SHT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
12468 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
12469 if (sec != NULL)
12470 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12471 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".liblist");
12472 if (sec != NULL)
12473 (*hdrpp)->sh_info = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12474 break;
12475
12476 case SHT_MIPS_EVENTS:
12477 BFD_ASSERT ((*hdrpp)->bfd_section != NULL);
12478 name = bfd_get_section_name (abfd, (*hdrpp)->bfd_section);
12479 BFD_ASSERT (name != NULL);
12480 if (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.events"))
12481 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12482 name + sizeof ".MIPS.events" - 1);
12483 else
12484 {
12485 BFD_ASSERT (CONST_STRNEQ (name, ".MIPS.post_rel"));
12486 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12487 (name
12488 + sizeof ".MIPS.post_rel" - 1));
12489 }
12490 BFD_ASSERT (sec != NULL);
12491 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12492 break;
12493
12494 case SHT_MIPS_XHASH:
12495 sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynsym");
12496 if (sec != NULL)
12497 (*hdrpp)->sh_link = elf_section_data (sec)->this_idx;
12498 }
12499 }
12500 }
12501
12502 bfd_boolean
12503 _bfd_mips_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
12504 {
12505 _bfd_mips_final_write_processing (abfd);
12506 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
12507 }
12508 \f
12509 /* When creating an IRIX5 executable, we need REGINFO and RTPROC
12510 segments. */
12511
12512 int
12513 _bfd_mips_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
12514 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12515 {
12516 asection *s;
12517 int ret = 0;
12518
12519 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO segment. */
12520 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
12521 if (s && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD))
12522 ++ret;
12523
12524 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS segment. */
12525 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".MIPS.abiflags"))
12526 ++ret;
12527
12528 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment. */
12529 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6
12530 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd,
12531 MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME (abfd)))
12532 ++ret;
12533
12534 /* See if we need a PT_MIPS_RTPROC segment. */
12535 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5
12536 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic")
12537 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug"))
12538 ++ret;
12539
12540 /* Allocate a PT_NULL header in dynamic objects. See
12541 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map for details. */
12542 if (!SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
12543 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
12544 ++ret;
12545
12546 return ret;
12547 }
12548
12549 /* Modify the segment map for an IRIX5 executable. */
12550
12551 bfd_boolean
12552 _bfd_mips_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
12553 struct bfd_link_info *info)
12554 {
12555 asection *s;
12556 struct elf_segment_map *m, **pm;
12557 bfd_size_type amt;
12558
12559 /* If there is a .reginfo section, we need a PT_MIPS_REGINFO
12560 segment. */
12561 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".reginfo");
12562 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
12563 {
12564 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
12565 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_REGINFO)
12566 break;
12567 if (m == NULL)
12568 {
12569 amt = sizeof *m;
12570 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12571 if (m == NULL)
12572 return FALSE;
12573
12574 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_REGINFO;
12575 m->count = 1;
12576 m->sections[0] = s;
12577
12578 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
12579 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12580 while (*pm != NULL
12581 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
12582 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
12583 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12584
12585 m->next = *pm;
12586 *pm = m;
12587 }
12588 }
12589
12590 /* If there is a .MIPS.abiflags section, we need a PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS
12591 segment. */
12592 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".MIPS.abiflags");
12593 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
12594 {
12595 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
12596 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS)
12597 break;
12598 if (m == NULL)
12599 {
12600 amt = sizeof *m;
12601 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12602 if (m == NULL)
12603 return FALSE;
12604
12605 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_ABIFLAGS;
12606 m->count = 1;
12607 m->sections[0] = s;
12608
12609 /* We want to put it after the PHDR and INTERP segments. */
12610 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12611 while (*pm != NULL
12612 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
12613 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
12614 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12615
12616 m->next = *pm;
12617 *pm = m;
12618 }
12619 }
12620
12621 /* For IRIX 6, we don't have .mdebug sections, nor does anything but
12622 .dynamic end up in PT_DYNAMIC. However, we do have to insert a
12623 PT_MIPS_OPTIONS segment immediately following the program header
12624 table. */
12625 if (NEWABI_P (abfd)
12626 /* On non-IRIX6 new abi, we'll have already created a segment
12627 for this section, so don't create another. I'm not sure this
12628 is not also the case for IRIX 6, but I can't test it right
12629 now. */
12630 && IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix6)
12631 {
12632 for (s = abfd->sections; s; s = s->next)
12633 if (elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_type == SHT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
12634 break;
12635
12636 if (s)
12637 {
12638 struct elf_segment_map *options_segment;
12639
12640 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12641 while (*pm != NULL
12642 && ((*pm)->p_type == PT_PHDR
12643 || (*pm)->p_type == PT_INTERP))
12644 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12645
12646 if (*pm == NULL || (*pm)->p_type != PT_MIPS_OPTIONS)
12647 {
12648 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
12649 options_segment = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12650 options_segment->next = *pm;
12651 options_segment->p_type = PT_MIPS_OPTIONS;
12652 options_segment->p_flags = PF_R;
12653 options_segment->p_flags_valid = TRUE;
12654 options_segment->count = 1;
12655 options_segment->sections[0] = s;
12656 *pm = options_segment;
12657 }
12658 }
12659 }
12660 else
12661 {
12662 if (IRIX_COMPAT (abfd) == ict_irix5)
12663 {
12664 /* If there are .dynamic and .mdebug sections, we make a room
12665 for the RTPROC header. FIXME: Rewrite without section names. */
12666 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".interp") == NULL
12667 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic") != NULL
12668 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug") != NULL)
12669 {
12670 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
12671 if (m->p_type == PT_MIPS_RTPROC)
12672 break;
12673 if (m == NULL)
12674 {
12675 amt = sizeof *m;
12676 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12677 if (m == NULL)
12678 return FALSE;
12679
12680 m->p_type = PT_MIPS_RTPROC;
12681
12682 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
12683 if (s == NULL)
12684 {
12685 m->count = 0;
12686 m->p_flags = 0;
12687 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
12688 }
12689 else
12690 {
12691 m->count = 1;
12692 m->sections[0] = s;
12693 }
12694
12695 /* We want to put it after the DYNAMIC segment. */
12696 pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd);
12697 while (*pm != NULL && (*pm)->p_type != PT_DYNAMIC)
12698 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12699 if (*pm != NULL)
12700 pm = &(*pm)->next;
12701
12702 m->next = *pm;
12703 *pm = m;
12704 }
12705 }
12706 }
12707 /* On IRIX5, the PT_DYNAMIC segment includes the .dynamic,
12708 .dynstr, .dynsym, and .hash sections, and everything in
12709 between. */
12710 for (pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd); *pm != NULL;
12711 pm = &(*pm)->next)
12712 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_DYNAMIC)
12713 break;
12714 m = *pm;
12715 /* GNU/Linux binaries do not need the extended PT_DYNAMIC section.
12716 glibc's dynamic linker has traditionally derived the number of
12717 tags from the p_filesz field, and sometimes allocates stack
12718 arrays of that size. An overly-big PT_DYNAMIC segment can
12719 be actively harmful in such cases. Making PT_DYNAMIC contain
12720 other sections can also make life hard for the prelinker,
12721 which might move one of the other sections to a different
12722 PT_LOAD segment. */
12723 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
12724 && m != NULL
12725 && m->count == 1
12726 && strcmp (m->sections[0]->name, ".dynamic") == 0)
12727 {
12728 static const char *sec_names[] =
12729 {
12730 ".dynamic", ".dynstr", ".dynsym", ".hash"
12731 };
12732 bfd_vma low, high;
12733 unsigned int i, c;
12734 struct elf_segment_map *n;
12735
12736 low = ~(bfd_vma) 0;
12737 high = 0;
12738 for (i = 0; i < sizeof sec_names / sizeof sec_names[0]; i++)
12739 {
12740 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, sec_names[i]);
12741 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
12742 {
12743 bfd_size_type sz;
12744
12745 if (low > s->vma)
12746 low = s->vma;
12747 sz = s->size;
12748 if (high < s->vma + sz)
12749 high = s->vma + sz;
12750 }
12751 }
12752
12753 c = 0;
12754 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12755 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
12756 && s->vma >= low
12757 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
12758 ++c;
12759
12760 amt = sizeof *n + (bfd_size_type) (c - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
12761 n = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
12762 if (n == NULL)
12763 return FALSE;
12764 *n = *m;
12765 n->count = c;
12766
12767 i = 0;
12768 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
12769 {
12770 if ((s->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0
12771 && s->vma >= low
12772 && s->vma + s->size <= high)
12773 {
12774 n->sections[i] = s;
12775 ++i;
12776 }
12777 }
12778
12779 *pm = n;
12780 }
12781 }
12782
12783 /* Allocate a spare program header in dynamic objects so that tools
12784 like the prelinker can add an extra PT_LOAD entry.
12785
12786 If the prelinker needs to make room for a new PT_LOAD entry, its
12787 standard procedure is to move the first (read-only) sections into
12788 the new (writable) segment. However, the MIPS ABI requires
12789 .dynamic to be in a read-only segment, and the section will often
12790 start within sizeof (ElfNN_Phdr) bytes of the last program header.
12791
12792 Although the prelinker could in principle move .dynamic to a
12793 writable segment, it seems better to allocate a spare program
12794 header instead, and avoid the need to move any sections.
12795 There is a long tradition of allocating spare dynamic tags,
12796 so allocating a spare program header seems like a natural
12797 extension.
12798
12799 If INFO is NULL, we may be copying an already prelinked binary
12800 with objcopy or strip, so do not add this header. */
12801 if (info != NULL
12802 && !SGI_COMPAT (abfd)
12803 && bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic"))
12804 {
12805 for (pm = &elf_seg_map (abfd); *pm != NULL; pm = &(*pm)->next)
12806 if ((*pm)->p_type == PT_NULL)
12807 break;
12808 if (*pm == NULL)
12809 {
12810 m = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (*m));
12811 if (m == NULL)
12812 return FALSE;
12813
12814 m->p_type = PT_NULL;
12815 *pm = m;
12816 }
12817 }
12818
12819 return TRUE;
12820 }
12821 \f
12822 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
12823 relocation. */
12824
12825 asection *
12826 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
12827 struct bfd_link_info *info,
12828 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
12829 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
12830 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
12831 {
12832 /* ??? Do mips16 stub sections need to be handled special? */
12833
12834 if (h != NULL)
12835 switch (ELF_R_TYPE (sec->owner, rel->r_info))
12836 {
12837 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTINHERIT:
12838 case R_MIPS_GNU_VTENTRY:
12839 return NULL;
12840 }
12841
12842 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
12843 }
12844
12845 /* Prevent .MIPS.abiflags from being discarded with --gc-sections. */
12846
12847 bfd_boolean
12848 _bfd_mips_elf_gc_mark_extra_sections (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12849 elf_gc_mark_hook_fn gc_mark_hook)
12850 {
12851 bfd *sub;
12852
12853 _bfd_elf_gc_mark_extra_sections (info, gc_mark_hook);
12854
12855 for (sub = info->input_bfds; sub != NULL; sub = sub->link.next)
12856 {
12857 asection *o;
12858
12859 if (! is_mips_elf (sub))
12860 continue;
12861
12862 for (o = sub->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
12863 if (!o->gc_mark
12864 && MIPS_ELF_ABIFLAGS_SECTION_NAME_P
12865 (bfd_get_section_name (sub, o)))
12866 {
12867 if (!_bfd_elf_gc_mark (info, o, gc_mark_hook))
12868 return FALSE;
12869 }
12870 }
12871
12872 return TRUE;
12873 }
12874 \f
12875 /* Copy data from a MIPS ELF indirect symbol to its direct symbol,
12876 hiding the old indirect symbol. Process additional relocation
12877 information. Also called for weakdefs, in which case we just let
12878 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect copy the flags for us. */
12879
12880 void
12881 _bfd_mips_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12882 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
12883 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
12884 {
12885 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *dirmips, *indmips;
12886
12887 _bfd_elf_link_hash_copy_indirect (info, dir, ind);
12888
12889 dirmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
12890 indmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
12891 /* Any absolute non-dynamic relocations against an indirect or weak
12892 definition will be against the target symbol. */
12893 if (indmips->has_static_relocs)
12894 dirmips->has_static_relocs = TRUE;
12895
12896 if (ind->root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
12897 return;
12898
12899 dirmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs += indmips->possibly_dynamic_relocs;
12900 if (indmips->readonly_reloc)
12901 dirmips->readonly_reloc = TRUE;
12902 if (indmips->no_fn_stub)
12903 dirmips->no_fn_stub = TRUE;
12904 if (indmips->fn_stub)
12905 {
12906 dirmips->fn_stub = indmips->fn_stub;
12907 indmips->fn_stub = NULL;
12908 }
12909 if (indmips->need_fn_stub)
12910 {
12911 dirmips->need_fn_stub = TRUE;
12912 indmips->need_fn_stub = FALSE;
12913 }
12914 if (indmips->call_stub)
12915 {
12916 dirmips->call_stub = indmips->call_stub;
12917 indmips->call_stub = NULL;
12918 }
12919 if (indmips->call_fp_stub)
12920 {
12921 dirmips->call_fp_stub = indmips->call_fp_stub;
12922 indmips->call_fp_stub = NULL;
12923 }
12924 if (indmips->global_got_area < dirmips->global_got_area)
12925 dirmips->global_got_area = indmips->global_got_area;
12926 if (indmips->global_got_area < GGA_NONE)
12927 indmips->global_got_area = GGA_NONE;
12928 if (indmips->has_nonpic_branches)
12929 dirmips->has_nonpic_branches = TRUE;
12930 }
12931
12932 /* Take care of the special `__gnu_absolute_zero' symbol and ignore attempts
12933 to hide it. It has to remain global (it will also be protected) so as to
12934 be assigned a global GOT entry, which will then remain unchanged at load
12935 time. */
12936
12937 void
12938 _bfd_mips_elf_hide_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
12939 struct elf_link_hash_entry *entry,
12940 bfd_boolean force_local)
12941 {
12942 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
12943
12944 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
12945 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
12946 if (htab->use_absolute_zero
12947 && strcmp (entry->root.root.string, "__gnu_absolute_zero") == 0)
12948 return;
12949
12950 _bfd_elf_link_hash_hide_symbol (info, entry, force_local);
12951 }
12952 \f
12953 #define PDR_SIZE 32
12954
12955 bfd_boolean
12956 _bfd_mips_elf_discard_info (bfd *abfd, struct elf_reloc_cookie *cookie,
12957 struct bfd_link_info *info)
12958 {
12959 asection *o;
12960 bfd_boolean ret = FALSE;
12961 unsigned char *tdata;
12962 size_t i, skip;
12963
12964 o = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".pdr");
12965 if (! o)
12966 return FALSE;
12967 if (o->size == 0)
12968 return FALSE;
12969 if (o->size % PDR_SIZE != 0)
12970 return FALSE;
12971 if (o->output_section != NULL
12972 && bfd_is_abs_section (o->output_section))
12973 return FALSE;
12974
12975 tdata = bfd_zmalloc (o->size / PDR_SIZE);
12976 if (! tdata)
12977 return FALSE;
12978
12979 cookie->rels = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, o, NULL, NULL,
12980 info->keep_memory);
12981 if (!cookie->rels)
12982 {
12983 free (tdata);
12984 return FALSE;
12985 }
12986
12987 cookie->rel = cookie->rels;
12988 cookie->relend = cookie->rels + o->reloc_count;
12989
12990 for (i = 0, skip = 0; i < o->size / PDR_SIZE; i ++)
12991 {
12992 if (bfd_elf_reloc_symbol_deleted_p (i * PDR_SIZE, cookie))
12993 {
12994 tdata[i] = 1;
12995 skip ++;
12996 }
12997 }
12998
12999 if (skip != 0)
13000 {
13001 mips_elf_section_data (o)->u.tdata = tdata;
13002 if (o->rawsize == 0)
13003 o->rawsize = o->size;
13004 o->size -= skip * PDR_SIZE;
13005 ret = TRUE;
13006 }
13007 else
13008 free (tdata);
13009
13010 if (! info->keep_memory)
13011 free (cookie->rels);
13012
13013 return ret;
13014 }
13015
13016 bfd_boolean
13017 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_discarded_relocs (asection *sec)
13018 {
13019 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") == 0)
13020 return TRUE;
13021 return FALSE;
13022 }
13023
13024 bfd_boolean
13025 _bfd_mips_elf_write_section (bfd *output_bfd,
13026 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13027 asection *sec, bfd_byte *contents)
13028 {
13029 bfd_byte *to, *from, *end;
13030 int i;
13031
13032 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".pdr") != 0)
13033 return FALSE;
13034
13035 if (mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata == NULL)
13036 return FALSE;
13037
13038 to = contents;
13039 end = contents + sec->size;
13040 for (from = contents, i = 0;
13041 from < end;
13042 from += PDR_SIZE, i++)
13043 {
13044 if ((mips_elf_section_data (sec)->u.tdata)[i] == 1)
13045 continue;
13046 if (to != from)
13047 memcpy (to, from, PDR_SIZE);
13048 to += PDR_SIZE;
13049 }
13050 bfd_set_section_contents (output_bfd, sec->output_section, contents,
13051 sec->output_offset, sec->size);
13052 return TRUE;
13053 }
13054 \f
13055 /* microMIPS code retains local labels for linker relaxation. Omit them
13056 from output by default for clarity. */
13057
13058 bfd_boolean
13059 _bfd_mips_elf_is_target_special_symbol (bfd *abfd, asymbol *sym)
13060 {
13061 return _bfd_elf_is_local_label_name (abfd, sym->name);
13062 }
13063
13064 /* MIPS ELF uses a special find_nearest_line routine in order the
13065 handle the ECOFF debugging information. */
13066
13067 struct mips_elf_find_line
13068 {
13069 struct ecoff_debug_info d;
13070 struct ecoff_find_line i;
13071 };
13072
13073 bfd_boolean
13074 _bfd_mips_elf_find_nearest_line (bfd *abfd, asymbol **symbols,
13075 asection *section, bfd_vma offset,
13076 const char **filename_ptr,
13077 const char **functionname_ptr,
13078 unsigned int *line_ptr,
13079 unsigned int *discriminator_ptr)
13080 {
13081 asection *msec;
13082
13083 if (_bfd_dwarf2_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, NULL, section, offset,
13084 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
13085 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr,
13086 dwarf_debug_sections,
13087 &elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info)
13088 || _bfd_dwarf1_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
13089 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
13090 line_ptr))
13091 {
13092 /* PR 22789: If the function name or filename was not found through
13093 the debug information, then try an ordinary lookup instead. */
13094 if ((functionname_ptr != NULL && *functionname_ptr == NULL)
13095 || (filename_ptr != NULL && *filename_ptr == NULL))
13096 {
13097 /* Do not override already discovered names. */
13098 if (functionname_ptr != NULL && *functionname_ptr != NULL)
13099 functionname_ptr = NULL;
13100
13101 if (filename_ptr != NULL && *filename_ptr != NULL)
13102 filename_ptr = NULL;
13103
13104 _bfd_elf_find_function (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
13105 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr);
13106 }
13107
13108 return TRUE;
13109 }
13110
13111 msec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".mdebug");
13112 if (msec != NULL)
13113 {
13114 flagword origflags;
13115 struct mips_elf_find_line *fi;
13116 const struct ecoff_debug_swap * const swap =
13117 get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
13118
13119 /* If we are called during a link, mips_elf_final_link may have
13120 cleared the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS field. We force it back on here
13121 if appropriate (which it normally will be). */
13122 origflags = msec->flags;
13123 if (elf_section_data (msec)->this_hdr.sh_type != SHT_NOBITS)
13124 msec->flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
13125
13126 fi = mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info;
13127 if (fi == NULL)
13128 {
13129 bfd_size_type external_fdr_size;
13130 char *fraw_src;
13131 char *fraw_end;
13132 struct fdr *fdr_ptr;
13133 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_find_line);
13134
13135 fi = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
13136 if (fi == NULL)
13137 {
13138 msec->flags = origflags;
13139 return FALSE;
13140 }
13141
13142 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (abfd, msec, &fi->d))
13143 {
13144 msec->flags = origflags;
13145 return FALSE;
13146 }
13147
13148 /* Swap in the FDR information. */
13149 amt = fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * sizeof (struct fdr);
13150 fi->d.fdr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
13151 if (fi->d.fdr == NULL)
13152 {
13153 msec->flags = origflags;
13154 return FALSE;
13155 }
13156 external_fdr_size = swap->external_fdr_size;
13157 fdr_ptr = fi->d.fdr;
13158 fraw_src = (char *) fi->d.external_fdr;
13159 fraw_end = (fraw_src
13160 + fi->d.symbolic_header.ifdMax * external_fdr_size);
13161 for (; fraw_src < fraw_end; fraw_src += external_fdr_size, fdr_ptr++)
13162 (*swap->swap_fdr_in) (abfd, fraw_src, fdr_ptr);
13163
13164 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->find_line_info = fi;
13165
13166 /* Note that we don't bother to ever free this information.
13167 find_nearest_line is either called all the time, as in
13168 objdump -l, so the information should be saved, or it is
13169 rarely called, as in ld error messages, so the memory
13170 wasted is unimportant. Still, it would probably be a
13171 good idea for free_cached_info to throw it away. */
13172 }
13173
13174 if (_bfd_ecoff_locate_line (abfd, section, offset, &fi->d, swap,
13175 &fi->i, filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
13176 line_ptr))
13177 {
13178 msec->flags = origflags;
13179 return TRUE;
13180 }
13181
13182 msec->flags = origflags;
13183 }
13184
13185 /* Fall back on the generic ELF find_nearest_line routine. */
13186
13187 return _bfd_elf_find_nearest_line (abfd, symbols, section, offset,
13188 filename_ptr, functionname_ptr,
13189 line_ptr, discriminator_ptr);
13190 }
13191
13192 bfd_boolean
13193 _bfd_mips_elf_find_inliner_info (bfd *abfd,
13194 const char **filename_ptr,
13195 const char **functionname_ptr,
13196 unsigned int *line_ptr)
13197 {
13198 bfd_boolean found;
13199 found = _bfd_dwarf2_find_inliner_info (abfd, filename_ptr,
13200 functionname_ptr, line_ptr,
13201 & elf_tdata (abfd)->dwarf2_find_line_info);
13202 return found;
13203 }
13204
13205 \f
13206 /* When are writing out the .options or .MIPS.options section,
13207 remember the bytes we are writing out, so that we can install the
13208 GP value in the section_processing routine. */
13209
13210 bfd_boolean
13211 _bfd_mips_elf_set_section_contents (bfd *abfd, sec_ptr section,
13212 const void *location,
13213 file_ptr offset, bfd_size_type count)
13214 {
13215 if (MIPS_ELF_OPTIONS_SECTION_NAME_P (section->name))
13216 {
13217 bfd_byte *c;
13218
13219 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
13220 {
13221 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct bfd_elf_section_data);
13222 section->used_by_bfd = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
13223 if (elf_section_data (section) == NULL)
13224 return FALSE;
13225 }
13226 c = mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata;
13227 if (c == NULL)
13228 {
13229 c = bfd_zalloc (abfd, section->size);
13230 if (c == NULL)
13231 return FALSE;
13232 mips_elf_section_data (section)->u.tdata = c;
13233 }
13234
13235 memcpy (c + offset, location, count);
13236 }
13237
13238 return _bfd_elf_set_section_contents (abfd, section, location, offset,
13239 count);
13240 }
13241
13242 /* This is almost identical to bfd_generic_get_... except that some
13243 MIPS relocations need to be handled specially. Sigh. */
13244
13245 bfd_byte *
13246 _bfd_elf_mips_get_relocated_section_contents
13247 (bfd *abfd,
13248 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
13249 struct bfd_link_order *link_order,
13250 bfd_byte *data,
13251 bfd_boolean relocatable,
13252 asymbol **symbols)
13253 {
13254 /* Get enough memory to hold the stuff */
13255 bfd *input_bfd = link_order->u.indirect.section->owner;
13256 asection *input_section = link_order->u.indirect.section;
13257 bfd_size_type sz;
13258
13259 long reloc_size = bfd_get_reloc_upper_bound (input_bfd, input_section);
13260 arelent **reloc_vector = NULL;
13261 long reloc_count;
13262
13263 if (reloc_size < 0)
13264 goto error_return;
13265
13266 reloc_vector = bfd_malloc (reloc_size);
13267 if (reloc_vector == NULL && reloc_size != 0)
13268 goto error_return;
13269
13270 /* read in the section */
13271 sz = input_section->rawsize ? input_section->rawsize : input_section->size;
13272 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section, data, 0, sz))
13273 goto error_return;
13274
13275 reloc_count = bfd_canonicalize_reloc (input_bfd,
13276 input_section,
13277 reloc_vector,
13278 symbols);
13279 if (reloc_count < 0)
13280 goto error_return;
13281
13282 if (reloc_count > 0)
13283 {
13284 arelent **parent;
13285 /* for mips */
13286 int gp_found;
13287 bfd_vma gp = 0x12345678; /* initialize just to shut gcc up */
13288
13289 {
13290 struct bfd_hash_entry *h;
13291 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *lh;
13292 /* Skip all this stuff if we aren't mixing formats. */
13293 if (abfd && input_bfd
13294 && abfd->xvec == input_bfd->xvec)
13295 lh = 0;
13296 else
13297 {
13298 h = bfd_hash_lookup (&link_info->hash->table, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE);
13299 lh = (struct bfd_link_hash_entry *) h;
13300 }
13301 lookup:
13302 if (lh)
13303 {
13304 switch (lh->type)
13305 {
13306 case bfd_link_hash_undefined:
13307 case bfd_link_hash_undefweak:
13308 case bfd_link_hash_common:
13309 gp_found = 0;
13310 break;
13311 case bfd_link_hash_defined:
13312 case bfd_link_hash_defweak:
13313 gp_found = 1;
13314 gp = lh->u.def.value;
13315 break;
13316 case bfd_link_hash_indirect:
13317 case bfd_link_hash_warning:
13318 lh = lh->u.i.link;
13319 /* @@FIXME ignoring warning for now */
13320 goto lookup;
13321 case bfd_link_hash_new:
13322 default:
13323 abort ();
13324 }
13325 }
13326 else
13327 gp_found = 0;
13328 }
13329 /* end mips */
13330 for (parent = reloc_vector; *parent != NULL; parent++)
13331 {
13332 char *error_message = NULL;
13333 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
13334
13335 /* Specific to MIPS: Deal with relocation types that require
13336 knowing the gp of the output bfd. */
13337 asymbol *sym = *(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr;
13338
13339 /* If we've managed to find the gp and have a special
13340 function for the relocation then go ahead, else default
13341 to the generic handling. */
13342 if (gp_found
13343 && (*parent)->howto->special_function
13344 == _bfd_mips_elf32_gprel16_reloc)
13345 r = _bfd_mips_elf_gprel16_with_gp (input_bfd, sym, *parent,
13346 input_section, relocatable,
13347 data, gp);
13348 else
13349 r = bfd_perform_relocation (input_bfd, *parent, data,
13350 input_section,
13351 relocatable ? abfd : NULL,
13352 &error_message);
13353
13354 if (relocatable)
13355 {
13356 asection *os = input_section->output_section;
13357
13358 /* A partial link, so keep the relocs */
13359 os->orelocation[os->reloc_count] = *parent;
13360 os->reloc_count++;
13361 }
13362
13363 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
13364 {
13365 switch (r)
13366 {
13367 case bfd_reloc_undefined:
13368 (*link_info->callbacks->undefined_symbol)
13369 (link_info, bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
13370 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address, TRUE);
13371 break;
13372 case bfd_reloc_dangerous:
13373 BFD_ASSERT (error_message != NULL);
13374 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_dangerous)
13375 (link_info, error_message,
13376 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address);
13377 break;
13378 case bfd_reloc_overflow:
13379 (*link_info->callbacks->reloc_overflow)
13380 (link_info, NULL,
13381 bfd_asymbol_name (*(*parent)->sym_ptr_ptr),
13382 (*parent)->howto->name, (*parent)->addend,
13383 input_bfd, input_section, (*parent)->address);
13384 break;
13385 case bfd_reloc_outofrange:
13386 default:
13387 abort ();
13388 break;
13389 }
13390
13391 }
13392 }
13393 }
13394 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
13395 free (reloc_vector);
13396 return data;
13397
13398 error_return:
13399 if (reloc_vector != NULL)
13400 free (reloc_vector);
13401 return NULL;
13402 }
13403 \f
13404 static bfd_boolean
13405 mips_elf_relax_delete_bytes (bfd *abfd,
13406 asection *sec, bfd_vma addr, int count)
13407 {
13408 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13409 unsigned int sec_shndx;
13410 bfd_byte *contents;
13411 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
13412 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
13413 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymend;
13414 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
13415 struct elf_link_hash_entry **end_hashes;
13416 struct elf_link_hash_entry **start_hashes;
13417 unsigned int symcount;
13418
13419 sec_shndx = _bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section (abfd, sec);
13420 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
13421
13422 irel = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs;
13423 irelend = irel + sec->reloc_count;
13424
13425 /* Actually delete the bytes. */
13426 memmove (contents + addr, contents + addr + count,
13427 (size_t) (sec->size - addr - count));
13428 sec->size -= count;
13429
13430 /* Adjust all the relocs. */
13431 for (irel = elf_section_data (sec)->relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
13432 {
13433 /* Get the new reloc address. */
13434 if (irel->r_offset > addr)
13435 irel->r_offset -= count;
13436 }
13437
13438 BFD_ASSERT (addr % 2 == 0);
13439 BFD_ASSERT (count % 2 == 0);
13440
13441 /* Adjust the local symbols defined in this section. */
13442 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
13443 isym = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
13444 for (isymend = isym + symtab_hdr->sh_info; isym < isymend; isym++)
13445 if (isym->st_shndx == sec_shndx && isym->st_value > addr)
13446 isym->st_value -= count;
13447
13448 /* Now adjust the global symbols defined in this section. */
13449 symcount = (symtab_hdr->sh_size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Sym)
13450 - symtab_hdr->sh_info);
13451 sym_hashes = start_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
13452 end_hashes = sym_hashes + symcount;
13453
13454 for (; sym_hashes < end_hashes; sym_hashes++)
13455 {
13456 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym_hash = *sym_hashes;
13457
13458 if ((sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
13459 || sym_hash->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13460 && sym_hash->root.u.def.section == sec)
13461 {
13462 bfd_vma value = sym_hash->root.u.def.value;
13463
13464 if (ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (sym_hash->other))
13465 value &= MINUS_TWO;
13466 if (value > addr)
13467 sym_hash->root.u.def.value -= count;
13468 }
13469 }
13470
13471 return TRUE;
13472 }
13473
13474
13475 /* Opcodes needed for microMIPS relaxation as found in
13476 opcodes/micromips-opc.c. */
13477
13478 struct opcode_descriptor {
13479 unsigned long match;
13480 unsigned long mask;
13481 };
13482
13483 /* The $ra register aka $31. */
13484
13485 #define RA 31
13486
13487 /* 32-bit instruction format register fields. */
13488
13489 #define OP32_SREG(opcode) (((opcode) >> 16) & 0x1f)
13490 #define OP32_TREG(opcode) (((opcode) >> 21) & 0x1f)
13491
13492 /* Check if a 5-bit register index can be abbreviated to 3 bits. */
13493
13494 #define OP16_VALID_REG(r) \
13495 ((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) || (16 <= (r) && (r) <= 17))
13496
13497
13498 /* 32-bit and 16-bit branches. */
13499
13500 static const struct opcode_descriptor b_insns_32[] = {
13501 { /* "b", "p", */ 0x40400000, 0xffff0000 }, /* bgez 0 */
13502 { /* "b", "p", */ 0x94000000, 0xffff0000 }, /* beq 0, 0 */
13503 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13504 };
13505
13506 static const struct opcode_descriptor bc_insn_32 =
13507 { /* "bc(1|2)(ft)", "N,p", */ 0x42800000, 0xfec30000 };
13508
13509 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insn_32 =
13510 { /* "b(g|l)(e|t)z", "s,p", */ 0x40000000, 0xff200000 };
13511
13512 static const struct opcode_descriptor bzal_insn_32 =
13513 { /* "b(ge|lt)zal", "s,p", */ 0x40200000, 0xffa00000 };
13514
13515 static const struct opcode_descriptor beq_insn_32 =
13516 { /* "b(eq|ne)", "s,t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xdc000000 };
13517
13518 static const struct opcode_descriptor b_insn_16 =
13519 { /* "b", "mD", */ 0xcc00, 0xfc00 };
13520
13521 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insn_16 =
13522 { /* "b(eq|ne)z", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xdc00 };
13523
13524
13525 /* 32-bit and 16-bit branch EQ and NE zero. */
13526
13527 /* NOTE: All opcode tables have BEQ/BNE in the same order: first the
13528 eq and second the ne. This convention is used when replacing a
13529 32-bit BEQ/BNE with the 16-bit version. */
13530
13531 #define BZC32_REG_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) << 16)
13532
13533 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_rs_insns_32[] = {
13534 { /* "beqz", "s,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xffe00000 },
13535 { /* "bnez", "s,p", */ 0xb4000000, 0xffe00000 },
13536 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13537 };
13538
13539 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_rt_insns_32[] = {
13540 { /* "beqz", "t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xfc01f000 },
13541 { /* "bnez", "t,p", */ 0xb4000000, 0xfc01f000 },
13542 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13543 };
13544
13545 static const struct opcode_descriptor bzc_insns_32[] = {
13546 { /* "beqzc", "s,p", */ 0x40e00000, 0xffe00000 },
13547 { /* "bnezc", "s,p", */ 0x40a00000, 0xffe00000 },
13548 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13549 };
13550
13551 static const struct opcode_descriptor bz_insns_16[] = {
13552 { /* "beqz", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xfc00 },
13553 { /* "bnez", "md,mE", */ 0xac00, 0xfc00 },
13554 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13555 };
13556
13557 /* Switch between a 5-bit register index and its 3-bit shorthand. */
13558
13559 #define BZ16_REG(opcode) ((((((opcode) >> 7) & 7) + 0x1e) & 0xf) + 2)
13560 #define BZ16_REG_FIELD(r) (((r) & 7) << 7)
13561
13562
13563 /* 32-bit instructions with a delay slot. */
13564
13565 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_insn_32_bd16 =
13566 { /* "jals", "a", */ 0x74000000, 0xfc000000 };
13567
13568 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_insn_32_bd32 =
13569 { /* "jal", "a", */ 0xf4000000, 0xfc000000 };
13570
13571 static const struct opcode_descriptor jal_x_insn_32_bd32 =
13572 { /* "jal[x]", "a", */ 0xf0000000, 0xf8000000 };
13573
13574 static const struct opcode_descriptor j_insn_32 =
13575 { /* "j", "a", */ 0xd4000000, 0xfc000000 };
13576
13577 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_32 =
13578 { /* "jalr[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00000f3c, 0xfc00efff };
13579
13580 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
13581
13582 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_32_bd16[] = {
13583 { /* "jals", "a", */ 0x74000000, 0xfc000000 },
13584
13585 { /* "jalrs[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00004f3c, 0xfc00efff },
13586 { /* "b(ge|lt)zals", "s,p", */ 0x42200000, 0xffa00000 },
13587
13588 { /* "b(g|l)(e|t)z", "s,p", */ 0x40000000, 0xff200000 },
13589 { /* "b(eq|ne)", "s,t,p", */ 0x94000000, 0xdc000000 },
13590 { /* "j", "a", */ 0xd4000000, 0xfc000000 },
13591 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13592 };
13593
13594 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
13595
13596 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_32_bd32[] = {
13597 { /* "jal[x]", "a", */ 0xf0000000, 0xf8000000 },
13598
13599 { /* "jalr[.hb]", "t,s", */ 0x00000f3c, 0xfc00efff },
13600 { /* "b(ge|lt)zal", "s,p", */ 0x40200000, 0xffa00000 },
13601 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13602 };
13603
13604
13605 /* 16-bit instructions with a delay slot. */
13606
13607 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_16_bd16 =
13608 { /* "jalrs", "my,mj", */ 0x45e0, 0xffe0 };
13609
13610 static const struct opcode_descriptor jalr_insn_16_bd32 =
13611 { /* "jalr", "my,mj", */ 0x45c0, 0xffe0 };
13612
13613 static const struct opcode_descriptor jr_insn_16 =
13614 { /* "jr", "mj", */ 0x4580, 0xffe0 };
13615
13616 #define JR16_REG(opcode) ((opcode) & 0x1f)
13617
13618 /* This table can be compacted, because no opcode replacement is made. */
13619
13620 static const struct opcode_descriptor ds_insns_16_bd16[] = {
13621 { /* "jalrs", "my,mj", */ 0x45e0, 0xffe0 },
13622
13623 { /* "b", "mD", */ 0xcc00, 0xfc00 },
13624 { /* "b(eq|ne)z", "md,mE", */ 0x8c00, 0xdc00 },
13625 { /* "jr", "mj", */ 0x4580, 0xffe0 },
13626 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13627 };
13628
13629
13630 /* LUI instruction. */
13631
13632 static const struct opcode_descriptor lui_insn =
13633 { /* "lui", "s,u", */ 0x41a00000, 0xffe00000 };
13634
13635
13636 /* ADDIU instruction. */
13637
13638 static const struct opcode_descriptor addiu_insn =
13639 { /* "addiu", "t,r,j", */ 0x30000000, 0xfc000000 };
13640
13641 static const struct opcode_descriptor addiupc_insn =
13642 { /* "addiu", "mb,$pc,mQ", */ 0x78000000, 0xfc000000 };
13643
13644 #define ADDIUPC_REG_FIELD(r) \
13645 (((2 <= (r) && (r) <= 7) ? (r) : ((r) - 16)) << 23)
13646
13647
13648 /* Relaxable instructions in a JAL delay slot: MOVE. */
13649
13650 /* The 16-bit move has rd in 9:5 and rs in 4:0. The 32-bit moves
13651 (ADDU, OR) have rd in 15:11 and rs in 10:16. */
13652 #define MOVE32_RD(opcode) (((opcode) >> 11) & 0x1f)
13653 #define MOVE32_RS(opcode) (((opcode) >> 16) & 0x1f)
13654
13655 #define MOVE16_RD_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) << 5)
13656 #define MOVE16_RS_FIELD(r) (((r) & 0x1f) )
13657
13658 static const struct opcode_descriptor move_insns_32[] = {
13659 { /* "move", "d,s", */ 0x00000290, 0xffe007ff }, /* or d,s,$0 */
13660 { /* "move", "d,s", */ 0x00000150, 0xffe007ff }, /* addu d,s,$0 */
13661 { 0, 0 } /* End marker for find_match(). */
13662 };
13663
13664 static const struct opcode_descriptor move_insn_16 =
13665 { /* "move", "mp,mj", */ 0x0c00, 0xfc00 };
13666
13667
13668 /* NOP instructions. */
13669
13670 static const struct opcode_descriptor nop_insn_32 =
13671 { /* "nop", "", */ 0x00000000, 0xffffffff };
13672
13673 static const struct opcode_descriptor nop_insn_16 =
13674 { /* "nop", "", */ 0x0c00, 0xffff };
13675
13676
13677 /* Instruction match support. */
13678
13679 #define MATCH(opcode, insn) ((opcode & insn.mask) == insn.match)
13680
13681 static int
13682 find_match (unsigned long opcode, const struct opcode_descriptor insn[])
13683 {
13684 unsigned long indx;
13685
13686 for (indx = 0; insn[indx].mask != 0; indx++)
13687 if (MATCH (opcode, insn[indx]))
13688 return indx;
13689
13690 return -1;
13691 }
13692
13693
13694 /* Branch and delay slot decoding support. */
13695
13696 /* If PTR points to what *might* be a 16-bit branch or jump, then
13697 return the minimum length of its delay slot, otherwise return 0.
13698 Non-zero results are not definitive as we might be checking against
13699 the second half of another instruction. */
13700
13701 static int
13702 check_br16_dslot (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr)
13703 {
13704 unsigned long opcode;
13705 int bdsize;
13706
13707 opcode = bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr);
13708 if (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd32) != 0)
13709 /* 16-bit branch/jump with a 32-bit delay slot. */
13710 bdsize = 4;
13711 else if (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd16) != 0
13712 || find_match (opcode, ds_insns_16_bd16) >= 0)
13713 /* 16-bit branch/jump with a 16-bit delay slot. */
13714 bdsize = 2;
13715 else
13716 /* No delay slot. */
13717 bdsize = 0;
13718
13719 return bdsize;
13720 }
13721
13722 /* If PTR points to what *might* be a 32-bit branch or jump, then
13723 return the minimum length of its delay slot, otherwise return 0.
13724 Non-zero results are not definitive as we might be checking against
13725 the second half of another instruction. */
13726
13727 static int
13728 check_br32_dslot (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr)
13729 {
13730 unsigned long opcode;
13731 int bdsize;
13732
13733 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13734 if (find_match (opcode, ds_insns_32_bd32) >= 0)
13735 /* 32-bit branch/jump with a 32-bit delay slot. */
13736 bdsize = 4;
13737 else if (find_match (opcode, ds_insns_32_bd16) >= 0)
13738 /* 32-bit branch/jump with a 16-bit delay slot. */
13739 bdsize = 2;
13740 else
13741 /* No delay slot. */
13742 bdsize = 0;
13743
13744 return bdsize;
13745 }
13746
13747 /* If PTR points to a 16-bit branch or jump with a 32-bit delay slot
13748 that doesn't fiddle with REG, then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
13749
13750 static bfd_boolean
13751 check_br16 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr, unsigned long reg)
13752 {
13753 unsigned long opcode;
13754
13755 opcode = bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr);
13756 if (MATCH (opcode, b_insn_16)
13757 /* B16 */
13758 || (MATCH (opcode, jr_insn_16) && reg != JR16_REG (opcode))
13759 /* JR16 */
13760 || (MATCH (opcode, bz_insn_16) && reg != BZ16_REG (opcode))
13761 /* BEQZ16, BNEZ16 */
13762 || (MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_16_bd32)
13763 /* JALR16 */
13764 && reg != JR16_REG (opcode) && reg != RA))
13765 return TRUE;
13766
13767 return FALSE;
13768 }
13769
13770 /* If PTR points to a 32-bit branch or jump that doesn't fiddle with REG,
13771 then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
13772
13773 static bfd_boolean
13774 check_br32 (bfd *abfd, bfd_byte *ptr, unsigned long reg)
13775 {
13776 unsigned long opcode;
13777
13778 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13779 if (MATCH (opcode, j_insn_32)
13780 /* J */
13781 || MATCH (opcode, bc_insn_32)
13782 /* BC1F, BC1T, BC2F, BC2T */
13783 || (MATCH (opcode, jal_x_insn_32_bd32) && reg != RA)
13784 /* JAL, JALX */
13785 || (MATCH (opcode, bz_insn_32) && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode))
13786 /* BGEZ, BGTZ, BLEZ, BLTZ */
13787 || (MATCH (opcode, bzal_insn_32)
13788 /* BGEZAL, BLTZAL */
13789 && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode) && reg != RA)
13790 || ((MATCH (opcode, jalr_insn_32) || MATCH (opcode, beq_insn_32))
13791 /* JALR, JALR.HB, BEQ, BNE */
13792 && reg != OP32_SREG (opcode) && reg != OP32_TREG (opcode)))
13793 return TRUE;
13794
13795 return FALSE;
13796 }
13797
13798 /* If the instruction encoding at PTR and relocations [INTERNAL_RELOCS,
13799 IRELEND) at OFFSET indicate that there must be a compact branch there,
13800 then return TRUE, otherwise FALSE. */
13801
13802 static bfd_boolean
13803 check_relocated_bzc (bfd *abfd, const bfd_byte *ptr, bfd_vma offset,
13804 const Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs,
13805 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irelend)
13806 {
13807 const Elf_Internal_Rela *irel;
13808 unsigned long opcode;
13809
13810 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13811 if (find_match (opcode, bzc_insns_32) < 0)
13812 return FALSE;
13813
13814 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
13815 if (irel->r_offset == offset
13816 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1)
13817 return TRUE;
13818
13819 return FALSE;
13820 }
13821
13822 /* Bitsize checking. */
13823 #define IS_BITSIZE(val, N) \
13824 (((((val) & ((1ULL << (N)) - 1)) ^ (1ULL << ((N) - 1))) \
13825 - (1ULL << ((N) - 1))) == (val))
13826
13827 \f
13828 bfd_boolean
13829 _bfd_mips_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd, asection *sec,
13830 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
13831 bfd_boolean *again)
13832 {
13833 bfd_boolean insn32 = mips_elf_hash_table (link_info)->insn32;
13834 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
13835 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs;
13836 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend;
13837 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
13838 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
13839
13840 /* Assume nothing changes. */
13841 *again = FALSE;
13842
13843 /* We don't have to do anything for a relocatable link, if
13844 this section does not have relocs, or if this is not a
13845 code section. */
13846
13847 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
13848 || (sec->flags & SEC_RELOC) == 0
13849 || sec->reloc_count == 0
13850 || (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0)
13851 return TRUE;
13852
13853 symtab_hdr = &elf_tdata (abfd)->symtab_hdr;
13854
13855 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
13856 internal_relocs = (_bfd_elf_link_read_relocs
13857 (abfd, sec, NULL, (Elf_Internal_Rela *) NULL,
13858 link_info->keep_memory));
13859 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
13860 goto error_return;
13861
13862 /* Walk through them looking for relaxing opportunities. */
13863 irelend = internal_relocs + sec->reloc_count;
13864 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
13865 {
13866 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
13867 unsigned int r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
13868 bfd_boolean target_is_micromips_code_p;
13869 unsigned long opcode;
13870 bfd_vma symval;
13871 bfd_vma pcrval;
13872 bfd_byte *ptr;
13873 int fndopc;
13874
13875 /* The number of bytes to delete for relaxation and from where
13876 to delete these bytes starting at irel->r_offset. */
13877 int delcnt = 0;
13878 int deloff = 0;
13879
13880 /* If this isn't something that can be relaxed, then ignore
13881 this reloc. */
13882 if (r_type != R_MICROMIPS_HI16
13883 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
13884 && r_type != R_MICROMIPS_26_S1)
13885 continue;
13886
13887 /* Get the section contents if we haven't done so already. */
13888 if (contents == NULL)
13889 {
13890 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
13891 if (elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
13892 contents = elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents;
13893 /* Go get them off disk. */
13894 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, sec, &contents))
13895 goto error_return;
13896 }
13897 ptr = contents + irel->r_offset;
13898
13899 /* Read this BFD's local symbols if we haven't done so already. */
13900 if (isymbuf == NULL && symtab_hdr->sh_info != 0)
13901 {
13902 isymbuf = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
13903 if (isymbuf == NULL)
13904 isymbuf = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (abfd, symtab_hdr,
13905 symtab_hdr->sh_info, 0,
13906 NULL, NULL, NULL);
13907 if (isymbuf == NULL)
13908 goto error_return;
13909 }
13910
13911 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
13912 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
13913 {
13914 /* A local symbol. */
13915 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
13916 asection *sym_sec;
13917
13918 isym = isymbuf + r_symndx;
13919 if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_UNDEF)
13920 sym_sec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
13921 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
13922 sym_sec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
13923 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON)
13924 sym_sec = bfd_com_section_ptr;
13925 else
13926 sym_sec = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
13927 symval = (isym->st_value
13928 + sym_sec->output_section->vma
13929 + sym_sec->output_offset);
13930 target_is_micromips_code_p = ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (isym->st_other);
13931 }
13932 else
13933 {
13934 unsigned long indx;
13935 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
13936
13937 /* An external symbol. */
13938 indx = r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
13939 h = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[indx];
13940 BFD_ASSERT (h != NULL);
13941
13942 if (h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defined
13943 && h->root.type != bfd_link_hash_defweak)
13944 /* This appears to be a reference to an undefined
13945 symbol. Just ignore it -- it will be caught by the
13946 regular reloc processing. */
13947 continue;
13948
13949 symval = (h->root.u.def.value
13950 + h->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma
13951 + h->root.u.def.section->output_offset);
13952 target_is_micromips_code_p = (!h->needs_plt
13953 && ELF_ST_IS_MICROMIPS (h->other));
13954 }
13955
13956
13957 /* For simplicity of coding, we are going to modify the
13958 section contents, the section relocs, and the BFD symbol
13959 table. We must tell the rest of the code not to free up this
13960 information. It would be possible to instead create a table
13961 of changes which have to be made, as is done in coff-mips.c;
13962 that would be more work, but would require less memory when
13963 the linker is run. */
13964
13965 /* Only 32-bit instructions relaxed. */
13966 if (irel->r_offset + 4 > sec->size)
13967 continue;
13968
13969 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr);
13970
13971 /* This is the pc-relative distance from the instruction the
13972 relocation is applied to, to the symbol referred. */
13973 pcrval = (symval
13974 - (sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset)
13975 - irel->r_offset);
13976
13977 /* R_MICROMIPS_HI16 / LUI relaxation to nil, performing relaxation
13978 of corresponding R_MICROMIPS_LO16 to R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16 or
13979 R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2. The R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2 condition is
13980
13981 (symval % 4 == 0 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval, 25))
13982
13983 where pcrval has first to be adjusted to apply against the LO16
13984 location (we make the adjustment later on, when we have figured
13985 out the offset). */
13986 if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_HI16 && MATCH (opcode, lui_insn))
13987 {
13988 bfd_boolean bzc = FALSE;
13989 unsigned long nextopc;
13990 unsigned long reg;
13991 bfd_vma offset;
13992
13993 /* Give up if the previous reloc was a HI16 against this symbol
13994 too. */
13995 if (irel > internal_relocs
13996 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_HI16
13997 && ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info) == r_symndx)
13998 continue;
13999
14000 /* Or if the next reloc is not a LO16 against this symbol. */
14001 if (irel + 1 >= irelend
14002 || ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[1].r_info) != R_MICROMIPS_LO16
14003 || ELF32_R_SYM (irel[1].r_info) != r_symndx)
14004 continue;
14005
14006 /* Or if the second next reloc is a LO16 against this symbol too. */
14007 if (irel + 2 >= irelend
14008 && ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[2].r_info) == R_MICROMIPS_LO16
14009 && ELF32_R_SYM (irel[2].r_info) == r_symndx)
14010 continue;
14011
14012 /* See if the LUI instruction *might* be in a branch delay slot.
14013 We check whether what looks like a 16-bit branch or jump is
14014 actually an immediate argument to a compact branch, and let
14015 it through if so. */
14016 if (irel->r_offset >= 2
14017 && check_br16_dslot (abfd, ptr - 2)
14018 && !(irel->r_offset >= 4
14019 && (bzc = check_relocated_bzc (abfd,
14020 ptr - 4, irel->r_offset - 4,
14021 internal_relocs, irelend))))
14022 continue;
14023 if (irel->r_offset >= 4
14024 && !bzc
14025 && check_br32_dslot (abfd, ptr - 4))
14026 continue;
14027
14028 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode);
14029
14030 /* We only relax adjacent instructions or ones separated with
14031 a branch or jump that has a delay slot. The branch or jump
14032 must not fiddle with the register used to hold the address.
14033 Subtract 4 for the LUI itself. */
14034 offset = irel[1].r_offset - irel[0].r_offset;
14035 switch (offset - 4)
14036 {
14037 case 0:
14038 break;
14039 case 2:
14040 if (check_br16 (abfd, ptr + 4, reg))
14041 break;
14042 continue;
14043 case 4:
14044 if (check_br32 (abfd, ptr + 4, reg))
14045 break;
14046 continue;
14047 default:
14048 continue;
14049 }
14050
14051 nextopc = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, contents + irel[1].r_offset);
14052
14053 /* Give up unless the same register is used with both
14054 relocations. */
14055 if (OP32_SREG (nextopc) != reg)
14056 continue;
14057
14058 /* Now adjust pcrval, subtracting the offset to the LO16 reloc
14059 and rounding up to take masking of the two LSBs into account. */
14060 pcrval = ((pcrval - offset + 3) | 3) ^ 3;
14061
14062 /* R_MICROMIPS_LO16 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16. */
14063 if (IS_BITSIZE (symval, 16))
14064 {
14065 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
14066 irel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_HI0_LO16);
14067
14068 /* Instructions using R_MICROMIPS_LO16 have the base or
14069 source register in bits 20:16. This register becomes $0
14070 (zero) as the result of the R_MICROMIPS_HI16 being 0. */
14071 nextopc &= ~0x001f0000;
14072 bfd_put_16 (abfd, (nextopc >> 16) & 0xffff,
14073 contents + irel[1].r_offset);
14074 }
14075
14076 /* R_MICROMIPS_LO16 / ADDIU relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2.
14077 We add 4 to take LUI deletion into account while checking
14078 the PC-relative distance. */
14079 else if (symval % 4 == 0
14080 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval + 4, 25)
14081 && MATCH (nextopc, addiu_insn)
14082 && OP32_TREG (nextopc) == OP32_SREG (nextopc)
14083 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_TREG (nextopc)))
14084 {
14085 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
14086 irel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC23_S2);
14087
14088 /* Replace ADDIU with the ADDIUPC version. */
14089 nextopc = (addiupc_insn.match
14090 | ADDIUPC_REG_FIELD (OP32_TREG (nextopc)));
14091
14092 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, nextopc,
14093 contents + irel[1].r_offset);
14094 }
14095
14096 /* Can't do anything, give up, sigh... */
14097 else
14098 continue;
14099
14100 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
14101 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MIPS_NONE);
14102
14103 /* Delete the LUI instruction: 4 bytes at irel->r_offset. */
14104 delcnt = 4;
14105 deloff = 0;
14106 }
14107
14108 /* Compact branch relaxation -- due to the multitude of macros
14109 employed by the compiler/assembler, compact branches are not
14110 always generated. Obviously, this can/will be fixed elsewhere,
14111 but there is no drawback in double checking it here. */
14112 else if (r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
14113 && irel->r_offset + 5 < sec->size
14114 && ((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rs_insns_32)) >= 0
14115 || (fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rt_insns_32)) >= 0)
14116 && ((!insn32
14117 && (delcnt = MATCH (bfd_get_16 (abfd, ptr + 4),
14118 nop_insn_16) ? 2 : 0))
14119 || (irel->r_offset + 7 < sec->size
14120 && (delcnt = MATCH (bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd,
14121 ptr + 4),
14122 nop_insn_32) ? 4 : 0))))
14123 {
14124 unsigned long reg;
14125
14126 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode) ? OP32_SREG (opcode) : OP32_TREG (opcode);
14127
14128 /* Replace BEQZ/BNEZ with the compact version. */
14129 opcode = (bzc_insns_32[fndopc].match
14130 | BZC32_REG_FIELD (reg)
14131 | (opcode & 0xffff)); /* Addend value. */
14132
14133 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, opcode, ptr);
14134
14135 /* Delete the delay slot NOP: two or four bytes from
14136 irel->offset + 4; delcnt has already been set above. */
14137 deloff = 4;
14138 }
14139
14140 /* R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1. We need
14141 to check the distance from the next instruction, so subtract 2. */
14142 else if (!insn32
14143 && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
14144 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval - 2, 11)
14145 && find_match (opcode, b_insns_32) >= 0)
14146 {
14147 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
14148 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC10_S1);
14149
14150 /* Replace the 32-bit opcode with a 16-bit opcode. */
14151 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
14152 (b_insn_16.match
14153 | (opcode & 0x3ff)), /* Addend value. */
14154 ptr);
14155
14156 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 2. */
14157 delcnt = 2;
14158 deloff = 2;
14159 }
14160
14161 /* R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1 relaxation to R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1. We need
14162 to check the distance from the next instruction, so subtract 2. */
14163 else if (!insn32
14164 && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_PC16_S1
14165 && IS_BITSIZE (pcrval - 2, 8)
14166 && (((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rs_insns_32)) >= 0
14167 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_SREG (opcode)))
14168 || ((fndopc = find_match (opcode, bz_rt_insns_32)) >= 0
14169 && OP16_VALID_REG (OP32_TREG (opcode)))))
14170 {
14171 unsigned long reg;
14172
14173 reg = OP32_SREG (opcode) ? OP32_SREG (opcode) : OP32_TREG (opcode);
14174
14175 /* Fix the relocation's type. */
14176 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_MICROMIPS_PC7_S1);
14177
14178 /* Replace the 32-bit opcode with a 16-bit opcode. */
14179 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
14180 (bz_insns_16[fndopc].match
14181 | BZ16_REG_FIELD (reg)
14182 | (opcode & 0x7f)), /* Addend value. */
14183 ptr);
14184
14185 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 2. */
14186 delcnt = 2;
14187 deloff = 2;
14188 }
14189
14190 /* R_MICROMIPS_26_S1 -- JAL to JALS relaxation for microMIPS targets. */
14191 else if (!insn32
14192 && r_type == R_MICROMIPS_26_S1
14193 && target_is_micromips_code_p
14194 && irel->r_offset + 7 < sec->size
14195 && MATCH (opcode, jal_insn_32_bd32))
14196 {
14197 unsigned long n32opc;
14198 bfd_boolean relaxed = FALSE;
14199
14200 n32opc = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, ptr + 4);
14201
14202 if (MATCH (n32opc, nop_insn_32))
14203 {
14204 /* Replace delay slot 32-bit NOP with a 16-bit NOP. */
14205 bfd_put_16 (abfd, nop_insn_16.match, ptr + 4);
14206
14207 relaxed = TRUE;
14208 }
14209 else if (find_match (n32opc, move_insns_32) >= 0)
14210 {
14211 /* Replace delay slot 32-bit MOVE with 16-bit MOVE. */
14212 bfd_put_16 (abfd,
14213 (move_insn_16.match
14214 | MOVE16_RD_FIELD (MOVE32_RD (n32opc))
14215 | MOVE16_RS_FIELD (MOVE32_RS (n32opc))),
14216 ptr + 4);
14217
14218 relaxed = TRUE;
14219 }
14220 /* Other 32-bit instructions relaxable to 16-bit
14221 instructions will be handled here later. */
14222
14223 if (relaxed)
14224 {
14225 /* JAL with 32-bit delay slot that is changed to a JALS
14226 with 16-bit delay slot. */
14227 bfd_put_micromips_32 (abfd, jal_insn_32_bd16.match, ptr);
14228
14229 /* Delete 2 bytes from irel->r_offset + 6. */
14230 delcnt = 2;
14231 deloff = 6;
14232 }
14233 }
14234
14235 if (delcnt != 0)
14236 {
14237 /* Note that we've changed the relocs, section contents, etc. */
14238 elf_section_data (sec)->relocs = internal_relocs;
14239 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
14240 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
14241
14242 /* Delete bytes depending on the delcnt and deloff. */
14243 if (!mips_elf_relax_delete_bytes (abfd, sec,
14244 irel->r_offset + deloff, delcnt))
14245 goto error_return;
14246
14247 /* That will change things, so we should relax again.
14248 Note that this is not required, and it may be slow. */
14249 *again = TRUE;
14250 }
14251 }
14252
14253 if (isymbuf != NULL
14254 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
14255 {
14256 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
14257 free (isymbuf);
14258 else
14259 {
14260 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
14261 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
14262 }
14263 }
14264
14265 if (contents != NULL
14266 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
14267 {
14268 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
14269 free (contents);
14270 else
14271 {
14272 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
14273 elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
14274 }
14275 }
14276
14277 if (internal_relocs != NULL
14278 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
14279 free (internal_relocs);
14280
14281 return TRUE;
14282
14283 error_return:
14284 if (isymbuf != NULL
14285 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
14286 free (isymbuf);
14287 if (contents != NULL
14288 && elf_section_data (sec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
14289 free (contents);
14290 if (internal_relocs != NULL
14291 && elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
14292 free (internal_relocs);
14293
14294 return FALSE;
14295 }
14296 \f
14297 /* Create a MIPS ELF linker hash table. */
14298
14299 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
14300 _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
14301 {
14302 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
14303 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table);
14304
14305 ret = bfd_zmalloc (amt);
14306 if (ret == NULL)
14307 return NULL;
14308
14309 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->root, abfd,
14310 mips_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
14311 sizeof (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry),
14312 MIPS_ELF_DATA))
14313 {
14314 free (ret);
14315 return NULL;
14316 }
14317 ret->root.init_plt_refcount.plist = NULL;
14318 ret->root.init_plt_offset.plist = NULL;
14319
14320 return &ret->root.root;
14321 }
14322
14323 /* Likewise, but indicate that the target is VxWorks. */
14324
14325 struct bfd_link_hash_table *
14326 _bfd_mips_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
14327 {
14328 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
14329
14330 ret = _bfd_mips_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
14331 if (ret)
14332 {
14333 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
14334
14335 htab = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *) ret;
14336 htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
14337 htab->is_vxworks = TRUE;
14338 }
14339 return ret;
14340 }
14341
14342 /* A function that the linker calls if we are allowed to use PLTs
14343 and copy relocs. */
14344
14345 void
14346 _bfd_mips_elf_use_plts_and_copy_relocs (struct bfd_link_info *info)
14347 {
14348 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->use_plts_and_copy_relocs = TRUE;
14349 }
14350
14351 /* A function that the linker calls to select between all or only
14352 32-bit microMIPS instructions, and between making or ignoring
14353 branch relocation checks for invalid transitions between ISA modes.
14354 Also record whether we have been configured for a GNU target. */
14355
14356 void
14357 _bfd_mips_elf_linker_flags (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean insn32,
14358 bfd_boolean ignore_branch_isa,
14359 bfd_boolean gnu_target)
14360 {
14361 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->insn32 = insn32;
14362 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->ignore_branch_isa = ignore_branch_isa;
14363 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->gnu_target = gnu_target;
14364 }
14365
14366 /* A function that the linker calls to enable use of compact branches in
14367 linker generated code for MIPSR6. */
14368
14369 void
14370 _bfd_mips_elf_compact_branches (struct bfd_link_info *info, bfd_boolean on)
14371 {
14372 mips_elf_hash_table (info)->compact_branches = on;
14373 }
14374
14375 \f
14376 /* Structure for saying that BFD machine EXTENSION extends BASE. */
14377
14378 struct mips_mach_extension
14379 {
14380 unsigned long extension, base;
14381 };
14382
14383
14384 /* An array describing how BFD machines relate to one another. The entries
14385 are ordered topologically with MIPS I extensions listed last. */
14386
14387 static const struct mips_mach_extension mips_mach_extensions[] =
14388 {
14389 /* MIPS64r2 extensions. */
14390 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon3, bfd_mach_mips_octeon2 },
14391 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon2, bfd_mach_mips_octeonp },
14392 { bfd_mach_mips_octeonp, bfd_mach_mips_octeon },
14393 { bfd_mach_mips_octeon, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
14394 { bfd_mach_mips_gs264e, bfd_mach_mips_gs464e },
14395 { bfd_mach_mips_gs464e, bfd_mach_mips_gs464 },
14396 { bfd_mach_mips_gs464, bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2 },
14397
14398 /* MIPS64 extensions. */
14399 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
14400 { bfd_mach_mips_sb1, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
14401 { bfd_mach_mips_xlr, bfd_mach_mipsisa64 },
14402
14403 /* MIPS V extensions. */
14404 { bfd_mach_mipsisa64, bfd_mach_mips5 },
14405
14406 /* R10000 extensions. */
14407 { bfd_mach_mips12000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
14408 { bfd_mach_mips14000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
14409 { bfd_mach_mips16000, bfd_mach_mips10000 },
14410
14411 /* R5000 extensions. Note: the vr5500 ISA is an extension of the core
14412 vr5400 ISA, but doesn't include the multimedia stuff. It seems
14413 better to allow vr5400 and vr5500 code to be merged anyway, since
14414 many libraries will just use the core ISA. Perhaps we could add
14415 some sort of ASE flag if this ever proves a problem. */
14416 { bfd_mach_mips5500, bfd_mach_mips5400 },
14417 { bfd_mach_mips5400, bfd_mach_mips5000 },
14418
14419 /* MIPS IV extensions. */
14420 { bfd_mach_mips5, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14421 { bfd_mach_mips10000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14422 { bfd_mach_mips5000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14423 { bfd_mach_mips7000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14424 { bfd_mach_mips9000, bfd_mach_mips8000 },
14425
14426 /* VR4100 extensions. */
14427 { bfd_mach_mips4120, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
14428 { bfd_mach_mips4111, bfd_mach_mips4100 },
14429
14430 /* MIPS III extensions. */
14431 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14432 { bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14433 { bfd_mach_mips8000, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14434 { bfd_mach_mips4650, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14435 { bfd_mach_mips4600, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14436 { bfd_mach_mips4400, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14437 { bfd_mach_mips4300, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14438 { bfd_mach_mips4100, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14439 { bfd_mach_mips5900, bfd_mach_mips4000 },
14440
14441 /* MIPS32r3 extensions. */
14442 { bfd_mach_mips_interaptiv_mr2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32r3 },
14443
14444 /* MIPS32r2 extensions. */
14445 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r3, bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2 },
14446
14447 /* MIPS32 extensions. */
14448 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2, bfd_mach_mipsisa32 },
14449
14450 /* MIPS II extensions. */
14451 { bfd_mach_mips4000, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
14452 { bfd_mach_mipsisa32, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
14453 { bfd_mach_mips4010, bfd_mach_mips6000 },
14454
14455 /* MIPS I extensions. */
14456 { bfd_mach_mips6000, bfd_mach_mips3000 },
14457 { bfd_mach_mips3900, bfd_mach_mips3000 }
14458 };
14459
14460 /* Return true if bfd machine EXTENSION is an extension of machine BASE. */
14461
14462 static bfd_boolean
14463 mips_mach_extends_p (unsigned long base, unsigned long extension)
14464 {
14465 size_t i;
14466
14467 if (extension == base)
14468 return TRUE;
14469
14470 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32
14471 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64, extension))
14472 return TRUE;
14473
14474 if (base == bfd_mach_mipsisa32r2
14475 && mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mach_mipsisa64r2, extension))
14476 return TRUE;
14477
14478 for (i = 0; i < ARRAY_SIZE (mips_mach_extensions); i++)
14479 if (extension == mips_mach_extensions[i].extension)
14480 {
14481 extension = mips_mach_extensions[i].base;
14482 if (extension == base)
14483 return TRUE;
14484 }
14485
14486 return FALSE;
14487 }
14488
14489 /* Return the BFD mach for each .MIPS.abiflags ISA Extension. */
14490
14491 static unsigned long
14492 bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (unsigned int isa_ext)
14493 {
14494 switch (isa_ext)
14495 {
14496 case AFL_EXT_3900: return bfd_mach_mips3900;
14497 case AFL_EXT_4010: return bfd_mach_mips4010;
14498 case AFL_EXT_4100: return bfd_mach_mips4100;
14499 case AFL_EXT_4111: return bfd_mach_mips4111;
14500 case AFL_EXT_4120: return bfd_mach_mips4120;
14501 case AFL_EXT_4650: return bfd_mach_mips4650;
14502 case AFL_EXT_5400: return bfd_mach_mips5400;
14503 case AFL_EXT_5500: return bfd_mach_mips5500;
14504 case AFL_EXT_5900: return bfd_mach_mips5900;
14505 case AFL_EXT_10000: return bfd_mach_mips10000;
14506 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2E: return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e;
14507 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2F: return bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f;
14508 case AFL_EXT_SB1: return bfd_mach_mips_sb1;
14509 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON: return bfd_mach_mips_octeon;
14510 case AFL_EXT_OCTEONP: return bfd_mach_mips_octeonp;
14511 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON2: return bfd_mach_mips_octeon2;
14512 case AFL_EXT_XLR: return bfd_mach_mips_xlr;
14513 default: return bfd_mach_mips3000;
14514 }
14515 }
14516
14517 /* Return the .MIPS.abiflags value representing each ISA Extension. */
14518
14519 unsigned int
14520 bfd_mips_isa_ext (bfd *abfd)
14521 {
14522 switch (bfd_get_mach (abfd))
14523 {
14524 case bfd_mach_mips3900: return AFL_EXT_3900;
14525 case bfd_mach_mips4010: return AFL_EXT_4010;
14526 case bfd_mach_mips4100: return AFL_EXT_4100;
14527 case bfd_mach_mips4111: return AFL_EXT_4111;
14528 case bfd_mach_mips4120: return AFL_EXT_4120;
14529 case bfd_mach_mips4650: return AFL_EXT_4650;
14530 case bfd_mach_mips5400: return AFL_EXT_5400;
14531 case bfd_mach_mips5500: return AFL_EXT_5500;
14532 case bfd_mach_mips5900: return AFL_EXT_5900;
14533 case bfd_mach_mips10000: return AFL_EXT_10000;
14534 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2e: return AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2E;
14535 case bfd_mach_mips_loongson_2f: return AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2F;
14536 case bfd_mach_mips_sb1: return AFL_EXT_SB1;
14537 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon: return AFL_EXT_OCTEON;
14538 case bfd_mach_mips_octeonp: return AFL_EXT_OCTEONP;
14539 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon3: return AFL_EXT_OCTEON3;
14540 case bfd_mach_mips_octeon2: return AFL_EXT_OCTEON2;
14541 case bfd_mach_mips_xlr: return AFL_EXT_XLR;
14542 case bfd_mach_mips_interaptiv_mr2:
14543 return AFL_EXT_INTERAPTIV_MR2;
14544 default: return 0;
14545 }
14546 }
14547
14548 /* Encode ISA level and revision as a single value. */
14549 #define LEVEL_REV(LEV,REV) ((LEV) << 3 | (REV))
14550
14551 /* Decode a single value into level and revision. */
14552 #define ISA_LEVEL(LEVREV) ((LEVREV) >> 3)
14553 #define ISA_REV(LEVREV) ((LEVREV) & 0x7)
14554
14555 /* Update the isa_level, isa_rev, isa_ext fields of abiflags. */
14556
14557 static void
14558 update_mips_abiflags_isa (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *abiflags)
14559 {
14560 int new_isa = 0;
14561 switch (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH)
14562 {
14563 case E_MIPS_ARCH_1: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (1, 0); break;
14564 case E_MIPS_ARCH_2: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (2, 0); break;
14565 case E_MIPS_ARCH_3: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (3, 0); break;
14566 case E_MIPS_ARCH_4: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (4, 0); break;
14567 case E_MIPS_ARCH_5: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (5, 0); break;
14568 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (32, 1); break;
14569 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (32, 2); break;
14570 case E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (32, 6); break;
14571 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (64, 1); break;
14572 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (64, 2); break;
14573 case E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6: new_isa = LEVEL_REV (64, 6); break;
14574 default:
14575 _bfd_error_handler
14576 /* xgettext:c-format */
14577 (_("%pB: unknown architecture %s"),
14578 abfd, bfd_printable_name (abfd));
14579 }
14580
14581 if (new_isa > LEVEL_REV (abiflags->isa_level, abiflags->isa_rev))
14582 {
14583 abiflags->isa_level = ISA_LEVEL (new_isa);
14584 abiflags->isa_rev = ISA_REV (new_isa);
14585 }
14586
14587 /* Update the isa_ext if ABFD describes a further extension. */
14588 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (abiflags->isa_ext),
14589 bfd_get_mach (abfd)))
14590 abiflags->isa_ext = bfd_mips_isa_ext (abfd);
14591 }
14592
14593 /* Return true if the given ELF header flags describe a 32-bit binary. */
14594
14595 static bfd_boolean
14596 mips_32bit_flags_p (flagword flags)
14597 {
14598 return ((flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE) != 0
14599 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32
14600 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32
14601 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1
14602 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2
14603 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32
14604 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2
14605 || (flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6);
14606 }
14607
14608 /* Infer the content of the ABI flags based on the elf header. */
14609
14610 static void
14611 infer_mips_abiflags (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0* abiflags)
14612 {
14613 obj_attribute *in_attr;
14614
14615 memset (abiflags, 0, sizeof (Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0));
14616 update_mips_abiflags_isa (abfd, abiflags);
14617
14618 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags))
14619 abiflags->gpr_size = AFL_REG_32;
14620 else
14621 abiflags->gpr_size = AFL_REG_64;
14622
14623 abiflags->cpr1_size = AFL_REG_NONE;
14624
14625 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (abfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
14626 abiflags->fp_abi = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
14627
14628 if (abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SINGLE
14629 || abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX
14630 || (abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
14631 && abiflags->gpr_size == AFL_REG_32))
14632 abiflags->cpr1_size = AFL_REG_32;
14633 else if (abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
14634 || abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
14635 || abiflags->fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A)
14636 abiflags->cpr1_size = AFL_REG_64;
14637
14638 abiflags->cpr2_size = AFL_REG_NONE;
14639
14640 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
14641 abiflags->ases |= AFL_ASE_MDMX;
14642 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
14643 abiflags->ases |= AFL_ASE_MIPS16;
14644 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS)
14645 abiflags->ases |= AFL_ASE_MICROMIPS;
14646
14647 if (abiflags->fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY
14648 && abiflags->fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT
14649 && abiflags->fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A
14650 && abiflags->isa_level >= 32
14651 && abiflags->ases != AFL_ASE_LOONGSON_EXT)
14652 abiflags->flags1 |= AFL_FLAGS1_ODDSPREG;
14653 }
14654
14655 /* We need to use a special link routine to handle the .reginfo and
14656 the .mdebug sections. We need to merge all instances of these
14657 sections together, not write them all out sequentially. */
14658
14659 bfd_boolean
14660 _bfd_mips_elf_final_link (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
14661 {
14662 asection *o;
14663 struct bfd_link_order *p;
14664 asection *reginfo_sec, *mdebug_sec, *gptab_data_sec, *gptab_bss_sec;
14665 asection *rtproc_sec, *abiflags_sec;
14666 Elf32_RegInfo reginfo;
14667 struct ecoff_debug_info debug;
14668 struct mips_htab_traverse_info hti;
14669 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
14670 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *swap = bed->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap;
14671 HDRR *symhdr = &debug.symbolic_header;
14672 void *mdebug_handle = NULL;
14673 asection *s;
14674 EXTR esym;
14675 unsigned int i;
14676 bfd_size_type amt;
14677 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
14678
14679 static const char * const secname[] =
14680 {
14681 ".text", ".init", ".fini", ".data",
14682 ".rodata", ".sdata", ".sbss", ".bss"
14683 };
14684 static const int sc[] =
14685 {
14686 scText, scInit, scFini, scData,
14687 scRData, scSData, scSBss, scBss
14688 };
14689
14690 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (info);
14691 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
14692
14693 /* Sort the dynamic symbols so that those with GOT entries come after
14694 those without. */
14695 if (!mips_elf_sort_hash_table (abfd, info))
14696 return FALSE;
14697
14698 /* Create any scheduled LA25 stubs. */
14699 hti.info = info;
14700 hti.output_bfd = abfd;
14701 hti.error = FALSE;
14702 htab_traverse (htab->la25_stubs, mips_elf_create_la25_stub, &hti);
14703 if (hti.error)
14704 return FALSE;
14705
14706 /* Get a value for the GP register. */
14707 if (elf_gp (abfd) == 0)
14708 {
14709 struct bfd_link_hash_entry *h;
14710
14711 h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash, "_gp", FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
14712 if (h != NULL && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
14713 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.value
14714 + h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
14715 + h->u.def.section->output_offset);
14716 else if (htab->is_vxworks
14717 && (h = bfd_link_hash_lookup (info->hash,
14718 "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_",
14719 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE))
14720 && h->type == bfd_link_hash_defined)
14721 elf_gp (abfd) = (h->u.def.section->output_section->vma
14722 + h->u.def.section->output_offset
14723 + h->u.def.value);
14724 else if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
14725 {
14726 bfd_vma lo = MINUS_ONE;
14727
14728 /* Find the GP-relative section with the lowest offset. */
14729 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
14730 if (o->vma < lo
14731 && (elf_section_data (o)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_MIPS_GPREL))
14732 lo = o->vma;
14733
14734 /* And calculate GP relative to that. */
14735 elf_gp (abfd) = lo + ELF_MIPS_GP_OFFSET (info);
14736 }
14737 else
14738 {
14739 /* If the relocate_section function needs to do a reloc
14740 involving the GP value, it should make a reloc_dangerous
14741 callback to warn that GP is not defined. */
14742 }
14743 }
14744
14745 /* Go through the sections and collect the .reginfo and .mdebug
14746 information. */
14747 abiflags_sec = NULL;
14748 reginfo_sec = NULL;
14749 mdebug_sec = NULL;
14750 gptab_data_sec = NULL;
14751 gptab_bss_sec = NULL;
14752 for (o = abfd->sections; o != NULL; o = o->next)
14753 {
14754 if (strcmp (o->name, ".MIPS.abiflags") == 0)
14755 {
14756 /* We have found the .MIPS.abiflags section in the output file.
14757 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and remove them.
14758 The data is merged in _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data. */
14759 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14760 {
14761 asection *input_section;
14762
14763 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14764 {
14765 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14766 continue;
14767 abort ();
14768 }
14769
14770 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14771
14772 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14773 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14774 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14775 }
14776
14777 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
14778 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0));
14779
14780 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
14781 matters, but someday it might). */
14782 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14783
14784 abiflags_sec = o;
14785 }
14786
14787 if (strcmp (o->name, ".reginfo") == 0)
14788 {
14789 memset (&reginfo, 0, sizeof reginfo);
14790
14791 /* We have found the .reginfo section in the output file.
14792 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
14793 the information together. */
14794 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14795 {
14796 asection *input_section;
14797 bfd *input_bfd;
14798 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
14799 Elf32_RegInfo sub;
14800 bfd_size_type sz;
14801
14802 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14803 {
14804 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14805 continue;
14806 abort ();
14807 }
14808
14809 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14810 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
14811
14812 sz = (input_section->size < sizeof (ext)
14813 ? input_section->size : sizeof (ext));
14814 memset (&ext, 0, sizeof (ext));
14815 if (! bfd_get_section_contents (input_bfd, input_section,
14816 &ext, 0, sz))
14817 return FALSE;
14818
14819 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_in (input_bfd, &ext, &sub);
14820
14821 reginfo.ri_gprmask |= sub.ri_gprmask;
14822 reginfo.ri_cprmask[0] |= sub.ri_cprmask[0];
14823 reginfo.ri_cprmask[1] |= sub.ri_cprmask[1];
14824 reginfo.ri_cprmask[2] |= sub.ri_cprmask[2];
14825 reginfo.ri_cprmask[3] |= sub.ri_cprmask[3];
14826
14827 /* ri_gp_value is set by the function
14828 `_bfd_mips_elf_section_processing' when the section is
14829 finally written out. */
14830
14831 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
14832 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
14833 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
14834 }
14835
14836 /* Size has been set in _bfd_mips_elf_always_size_sections. */
14837 BFD_ASSERT(o->size == sizeof (Elf32_External_RegInfo));
14838
14839 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
14840 matters, but someday it might). */
14841 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
14842
14843 reginfo_sec = o;
14844 }
14845
14846 if (strcmp (o->name, ".mdebug") == 0)
14847 {
14848 struct extsym_info einfo;
14849 bfd_vma last;
14850
14851 /* We have found the .mdebug section in the output file.
14852 Look through all the link_orders comprising it and merge
14853 the information together. */
14854 symhdr->magic = swap->sym_magic;
14855 /* FIXME: What should the version stamp be? */
14856 symhdr->vstamp = 0;
14857 symhdr->ilineMax = 0;
14858 symhdr->cbLine = 0;
14859 symhdr->idnMax = 0;
14860 symhdr->ipdMax = 0;
14861 symhdr->isymMax = 0;
14862 symhdr->ioptMax = 0;
14863 symhdr->iauxMax = 0;
14864 symhdr->issMax = 0;
14865 symhdr->issExtMax = 0;
14866 symhdr->ifdMax = 0;
14867 symhdr->crfd = 0;
14868 symhdr->iextMax = 0;
14869
14870 /* We accumulate the debugging information itself in the
14871 debug_info structure. */
14872 debug.line = NULL;
14873 debug.external_dnr = NULL;
14874 debug.external_pdr = NULL;
14875 debug.external_sym = NULL;
14876 debug.external_opt = NULL;
14877 debug.external_aux = NULL;
14878 debug.ss = NULL;
14879 debug.ssext = debug.ssext_end = NULL;
14880 debug.external_fdr = NULL;
14881 debug.external_rfd = NULL;
14882 debug.external_ext = debug.external_ext_end = NULL;
14883
14884 mdebug_handle = bfd_ecoff_debug_init (abfd, &debug, swap, info);
14885 if (mdebug_handle == NULL)
14886 return FALSE;
14887
14888 esym.jmptbl = 0;
14889 esym.cobol_main = 0;
14890 esym.weakext = 0;
14891 esym.reserved = 0;
14892 esym.ifd = ifdNil;
14893 esym.asym.iss = issNil;
14894 esym.asym.st = stLocal;
14895 esym.asym.reserved = 0;
14896 esym.asym.index = indexNil;
14897 last = 0;
14898 for (i = 0; i < sizeof (secname) / sizeof (secname[0]); i++)
14899 {
14900 esym.asym.sc = sc[i];
14901 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, secname[i]);
14902 if (s != NULL)
14903 {
14904 esym.asym.value = s->vma;
14905 last = s->vma + s->size;
14906 }
14907 else
14908 esym.asym.value = last;
14909 if (!bfd_ecoff_debug_one_external (abfd, &debug, swap,
14910 secname[i], &esym))
14911 return FALSE;
14912 }
14913
14914 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
14915 {
14916 asection *input_section;
14917 bfd *input_bfd;
14918 const struct ecoff_debug_swap *input_swap;
14919 struct ecoff_debug_info input_debug;
14920 char *eraw_src;
14921 char *eraw_end;
14922
14923 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
14924 {
14925 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
14926 continue;
14927 abort ();
14928 }
14929
14930 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
14931 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
14932
14933 if (!is_mips_elf (input_bfd))
14934 {
14935 /* I don't know what a non MIPS ELF bfd would be
14936 doing with a .mdebug section, but I don't really
14937 want to deal with it. */
14938 continue;
14939 }
14940
14941 input_swap = (get_elf_backend_data (input_bfd)
14942 ->elf_backend_ecoff_debug_swap);
14943
14944 BFD_ASSERT (p->size == input_section->size);
14945
14946 /* The ECOFF linking code expects that we have already
14947 read in the debugging information and set up an
14948 ecoff_debug_info structure, so we do that now. */
14949 if (! _bfd_mips_elf_read_ecoff_info (input_bfd, input_section,
14950 &input_debug))
14951 return FALSE;
14952
14953 if (! (bfd_ecoff_debug_accumulate
14954 (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, input_bfd,
14955 &input_debug, input_swap, info)))
14956 return FALSE;
14957
14958 /* Loop through the external symbols. For each one with
14959 interesting information, try to find the symbol in
14960 the linker global hash table and save the information
14961 for the output external symbols. */
14962 eraw_src = input_debug.external_ext;
14963 eraw_end = (eraw_src
14964 + (input_debug.symbolic_header.iextMax
14965 * input_swap->external_ext_size));
14966 for (;
14967 eraw_src < eraw_end;
14968 eraw_src += input_swap->external_ext_size)
14969 {
14970 EXTR ext;
14971 const char *name;
14972 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *h;
14973
14974 (*input_swap->swap_ext_in) (input_bfd, eraw_src, &ext);
14975 if (ext.asym.sc == scNil
14976 || ext.asym.sc == scUndefined
14977 || ext.asym.sc == scSUndefined)
14978 continue;
14979
14980 name = input_debug.ssext + ext.asym.iss;
14981 h = mips_elf_link_hash_lookup (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
14982 name, FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
14983 if (h == NULL || h->esym.ifd != -2)
14984 continue;
14985
14986 if (ext.ifd != -1)
14987 {
14988 BFD_ASSERT (ext.ifd
14989 < input_debug.symbolic_header.ifdMax);
14990 ext.ifd = input_debug.ifdmap[ext.ifd];
14991 }
14992
14993 h->esym = ext;
14994 }
14995
14996 /* Free up the information we just read. */
14997 free (input_debug.line);
14998 free (input_debug.external_dnr);
14999 free (input_debug.external_pdr);
15000 free (input_debug.external_sym);
15001 free (input_debug.external_opt);
15002 free (input_debug.external_aux);
15003 free (input_debug.ss);
15004 free (input_debug.ssext);
15005 free (input_debug.external_fdr);
15006 free (input_debug.external_rfd);
15007 free (input_debug.external_ext);
15008
15009 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
15010 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
15011 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
15012 }
15013
15014 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd) && bfd_link_pic (info))
15015 {
15016 /* Create .rtproc section. */
15017 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_linker_section (abfd, ".rtproc");
15018 if (rtproc_sec == NULL)
15019 {
15020 flagword flags = (SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
15021 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED | SEC_READONLY);
15022
15023 rtproc_sec = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd,
15024 ".rtproc",
15025 flags);
15026 if (rtproc_sec == NULL
15027 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (abfd, rtproc_sec, 4))
15028 return FALSE;
15029 }
15030
15031 if (! mips_elf_create_procedure_table (mdebug_handle, abfd,
15032 info, rtproc_sec,
15033 &debug))
15034 return FALSE;
15035 }
15036
15037 /* Build the external symbol information. */
15038 einfo.abfd = abfd;
15039 einfo.info = info;
15040 einfo.debug = &debug;
15041 einfo.swap = swap;
15042 einfo.failed = FALSE;
15043 mips_elf_link_hash_traverse (mips_elf_hash_table (info),
15044 mips_elf_output_extsym, &einfo);
15045 if (einfo.failed)
15046 return FALSE;
15047
15048 /* Set the size of the .mdebug section. */
15049 o->size = bfd_ecoff_debug_size (abfd, &debug, swap);
15050
15051 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
15052 matters, but someday it might). */
15053 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
15054
15055 mdebug_sec = o;
15056 }
15057
15058 if (CONST_STRNEQ (o->name, ".gptab."))
15059 {
15060 const char *subname;
15061 unsigned int c;
15062 Elf32_gptab *tab;
15063 Elf32_External_gptab *ext_tab;
15064 unsigned int j;
15065
15066 /* The .gptab.sdata and .gptab.sbss sections hold
15067 information describing how the small data area would
15068 change depending upon the -G switch. These sections
15069 not used in executables files. */
15070 if (! bfd_link_relocatable (info))
15071 {
15072 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
15073 {
15074 asection *input_section;
15075
15076 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
15077 {
15078 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
15079 continue;
15080 abort ();
15081 }
15082
15083 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
15084
15085 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
15086 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
15087 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
15088 }
15089
15090 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this
15091 currently matters, but someday it might). */
15092 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
15093
15094 /* Really remove the section. */
15095 bfd_section_list_remove (abfd, o);
15096 --abfd->section_count;
15097
15098 continue;
15099 }
15100
15101 /* There is one gptab for initialized data, and one for
15102 uninitialized data. */
15103 if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sdata") == 0)
15104 gptab_data_sec = o;
15105 else if (strcmp (o->name, ".gptab.sbss") == 0)
15106 gptab_bss_sec = o;
15107 else
15108 {
15109 _bfd_error_handler
15110 /* xgettext:c-format */
15111 (_("%pB: illegal section name `%pA'"), abfd, o);
15112 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_nonrepresentable_section);
15113 return FALSE;
15114 }
15115
15116 /* The linker script always combines .gptab.data and
15117 .gptab.sdata into .gptab.sdata, and likewise for
15118 .gptab.bss and .gptab.sbss. It is possible that there is
15119 no .sdata or .sbss section in the output file, in which
15120 case we must change the name of the output section. */
15121 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
15122 if (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) == NULL)
15123 {
15124 if (o == gptab_data_sec)
15125 o->name = ".gptab.data";
15126 else
15127 o->name = ".gptab.bss";
15128 subname = o->name + sizeof ".gptab" - 1;
15129 BFD_ASSERT (bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, subname) != NULL);
15130 }
15131
15132 /* Set up the first entry. */
15133 c = 1;
15134 amt = c * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
15135 tab = bfd_malloc (amt);
15136 if (tab == NULL)
15137 return FALSE;
15138 tab[0].gt_header.gt_current_g_value = elf_gp_size (abfd);
15139 tab[0].gt_header.gt_unused = 0;
15140
15141 /* Combine the input sections. */
15142 for (p = o->map_head.link_order; p != NULL; p = p->next)
15143 {
15144 asection *input_section;
15145 bfd *input_bfd;
15146 bfd_size_type size;
15147 unsigned long last;
15148 bfd_size_type gpentry;
15149
15150 if (p->type != bfd_indirect_link_order)
15151 {
15152 if (p->type == bfd_data_link_order)
15153 continue;
15154 abort ();
15155 }
15156
15157 input_section = p->u.indirect.section;
15158 input_bfd = input_section->owner;
15159
15160 /* Combine the gptab entries for this input section one
15161 by one. We know that the input gptab entries are
15162 sorted by ascending -G value. */
15163 size = input_section->size;
15164 last = 0;
15165 for (gpentry = sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
15166 gpentry < size;
15167 gpentry += sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))
15168 {
15169 Elf32_External_gptab ext_gptab;
15170 Elf32_gptab int_gptab;
15171 unsigned long val;
15172 unsigned long add;
15173 bfd_boolean exact;
15174 unsigned int look;
15175
15176 if (! (bfd_get_section_contents
15177 (input_bfd, input_section, &ext_gptab, gpentry,
15178 sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab))))
15179 {
15180 free (tab);
15181 return FALSE;
15182 }
15183
15184 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_in (input_bfd, &ext_gptab,
15185 &int_gptab);
15186 val = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_g_value;
15187 add = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes - last;
15188
15189 exact = FALSE;
15190 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
15191 {
15192 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value >= val)
15193 tab[look].gt_entry.gt_bytes += add;
15194
15195 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value == val)
15196 exact = TRUE;
15197 }
15198
15199 if (! exact)
15200 {
15201 Elf32_gptab *new_tab;
15202 unsigned int max;
15203
15204 /* We need a new table entry. */
15205 amt = (bfd_size_type) (c + 1) * sizeof (Elf32_gptab);
15206 new_tab = bfd_realloc (tab, amt);
15207 if (new_tab == NULL)
15208 {
15209 free (tab);
15210 return FALSE;
15211 }
15212 tab = new_tab;
15213 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_g_value = val;
15214 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes = add;
15215
15216 /* Merge in the size for the next smallest -G
15217 value, since that will be implied by this new
15218 value. */
15219 max = 0;
15220 for (look = 1; look < c; look++)
15221 {
15222 if (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value < val
15223 && (max == 0
15224 || (tab[look].gt_entry.gt_g_value
15225 > tab[max].gt_entry.gt_g_value)))
15226 max = look;
15227 }
15228 if (max != 0)
15229 tab[c].gt_entry.gt_bytes +=
15230 tab[max].gt_entry.gt_bytes;
15231
15232 ++c;
15233 }
15234
15235 last = int_gptab.gt_entry.gt_bytes;
15236 }
15237
15238 /* Hack: reset the SEC_HAS_CONTENTS flag so that
15239 elf_link_input_bfd ignores this section. */
15240 input_section->flags &= ~SEC_HAS_CONTENTS;
15241 }
15242
15243 /* The table must be sorted by -G value. */
15244 if (c > 2)
15245 qsort (tab + 1, c - 1, sizeof (tab[0]), gptab_compare);
15246
15247 /* Swap out the table. */
15248 amt = (bfd_size_type) c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
15249 ext_tab = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
15250 if (ext_tab == NULL)
15251 {
15252 free (tab);
15253 return FALSE;
15254 }
15255
15256 for (j = 0; j < c; j++)
15257 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_gptab_out (abfd, tab + j, ext_tab + j);
15258 free (tab);
15259
15260 o->size = c * sizeof (Elf32_External_gptab);
15261 o->contents = (bfd_byte *) ext_tab;
15262
15263 /* Skip this section later on (I don't think this currently
15264 matters, but someday it might). */
15265 o->map_head.link_order = NULL;
15266 }
15267 }
15268
15269 /* Invoke the regular ELF backend linker to do all the work. */
15270 if (!bfd_elf_final_link (abfd, info))
15271 return FALSE;
15272
15273 /* Now write out the computed sections. */
15274
15275 if (abiflags_sec != NULL)
15276 {
15277 Elf_External_ABIFlags_v0 ext;
15278 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *abiflags;
15279
15280 abiflags = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags;
15281
15282 /* Set up the abiflags if no valid input sections were found. */
15283 if (!mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid)
15284 {
15285 infer_mips_abiflags (abfd, abiflags);
15286 mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
15287 }
15288 bfd_mips_elf_swap_abiflags_v0_out (abfd, abiflags, &ext);
15289 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, abiflags_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
15290 return FALSE;
15291 }
15292
15293 if (reginfo_sec != NULL)
15294 {
15295 Elf32_External_RegInfo ext;
15296
15297 bfd_mips_elf32_swap_reginfo_out (abfd, &reginfo, &ext);
15298 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, reginfo_sec, &ext, 0, sizeof ext))
15299 return FALSE;
15300 }
15301
15302 if (mdebug_sec != NULL)
15303 {
15304 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->output_has_begun);
15305 if (! bfd_ecoff_write_accumulated_debug (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug,
15306 swap, info,
15307 mdebug_sec->filepos))
15308 return FALSE;
15309
15310 bfd_ecoff_debug_free (mdebug_handle, abfd, &debug, swap, info);
15311 }
15312
15313 if (gptab_data_sec != NULL)
15314 {
15315 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_data_sec,
15316 gptab_data_sec->contents,
15317 0, gptab_data_sec->size))
15318 return FALSE;
15319 }
15320
15321 if (gptab_bss_sec != NULL)
15322 {
15323 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, gptab_bss_sec,
15324 gptab_bss_sec->contents,
15325 0, gptab_bss_sec->size))
15326 return FALSE;
15327 }
15328
15329 if (SGI_COMPAT (abfd))
15330 {
15331 rtproc_sec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rtproc");
15332 if (rtproc_sec != NULL)
15333 {
15334 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, rtproc_sec,
15335 rtproc_sec->contents,
15336 0, rtproc_sec->size))
15337 return FALSE;
15338 }
15339 }
15340
15341 return TRUE;
15342 }
15343 \f
15344 /* Merge object file header flags from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error
15345 if there are conflicting settings. */
15346
15347 static bfd_boolean
15348 mips_elf_merge_obj_e_flags (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
15349 {
15350 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
15351 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *out_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (obfd);
15352 flagword old_flags;
15353 flagword new_flags;
15354 bfd_boolean ok;
15355
15356 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
15357 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
15358 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
15359
15360 /* Check flag compatibility. */
15361
15362 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
15363 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NOREORDER;
15364
15365 /* Some IRIX 6 BSD-compatibility objects have this bit set. It
15366 doesn't seem to matter. */
15367 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
15368 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_XGOT;
15369
15370 /* MIPSpro generates ucode info in n64 objects. Again, we should
15371 just be able to ignore this. */
15372 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
15373 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_UCODE;
15374
15375 /* DSOs should only be linked with CPIC code. */
15376 if ((ibfd->flags & DYNAMIC) != 0)
15377 new_flags |= EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC;
15378
15379 if (new_flags == old_flags)
15380 return TRUE;
15381
15382 ok = TRUE;
15383
15384 if (((new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0)
15385 != ((old_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC)) != 0))
15386 {
15387 _bfd_error_handler
15388 (_("%pB: warning: linking abicalls files with non-abicalls files"),
15389 ibfd);
15390 ok = TRUE;
15391 }
15392
15393 if (new_flags & (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC))
15394 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_MIPS_CPIC;
15395 if (! (new_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC))
15396 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_PIC;
15397
15398 new_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
15399 old_flags &= ~ (EF_MIPS_PIC | EF_MIPS_CPIC);
15400
15401 /* Compare the ISAs. */
15402 if (mips_32bit_flags_p (old_flags) != mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags))
15403 {
15404 _bfd_error_handler
15405 (_("%pB: linking 32-bit code with 64-bit code"),
15406 ibfd);
15407 ok = FALSE;
15408 }
15409 else if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (ibfd), bfd_get_mach (obfd)))
15410 {
15411 /* OBFD's ISA isn't the same as, or an extension of, IBFD's. */
15412 if (mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd), bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
15413 {
15414 /* Copy the architecture info from IBFD to OBFD. Also copy
15415 the 32-bit flag (if set) so that we continue to recognise
15416 OBFD as a 32-bit binary. */
15417 bfd_set_arch_info (obfd, bfd_get_arch_info (ibfd));
15418 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH);
15419 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags
15420 |= new_flags & (EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
15421
15422 /* Update the ABI flags isa_level, isa_rev, isa_ext fields. */
15423 update_mips_abiflags_isa (obfd, &out_tdata->abiflags);
15424
15425 /* Copy across the ABI flags if OBFD doesn't use them
15426 and if that was what caused us to treat IBFD as 32-bit. */
15427 if ((old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == 0
15428 && mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags)
15429 && !mips_32bit_flags_p (new_flags & ~EF_MIPS_ABI))
15430 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI;
15431 }
15432 else
15433 {
15434 /* The ISAs aren't compatible. */
15435 _bfd_error_handler
15436 /* xgettext:c-format */
15437 (_("%pB: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15438 ibfd,
15439 bfd_printable_name (ibfd),
15440 bfd_printable_name (obfd));
15441 ok = FALSE;
15442 }
15443 }
15444
15445 new_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
15446 old_flags &= ~(EF_MIPS_ARCH | EF_MIPS_MACH | EF_MIPS_32BITMODE);
15447
15448 /* Compare ABIs. The 64-bit ABI does not use EF_MIPS_ABI. But, it
15449 does set EI_CLASS differently from any 32-bit ABI. */
15450 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI)
15451 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
15452 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
15453 {
15454 /* Only error if both are set (to different values). */
15455 if (((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) && (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
15456 || (elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
15457 != elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]))
15458 {
15459 _bfd_error_handler
15460 /* xgettext:c-format */
15461 (_("%pB: ABI mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15462 ibfd,
15463 elf_mips_abi_name (ibfd),
15464 elf_mips_abi_name (obfd));
15465 ok = FALSE;
15466 }
15467 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
15468 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_ABI;
15469 }
15470
15471 /* Compare ASEs. Forbid linking MIPS16 and microMIPS ASE modules together
15472 and allow arbitrary mixing of the remaining ASEs (retain the union). */
15473 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE))
15474 {
15475 int old_micro = old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
15476 int new_micro = new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS;
15477 int old_m16 = old_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
15478 int new_m16 = new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16;
15479 int micro_mis = old_m16 && new_micro;
15480 int m16_mis = old_micro && new_m16;
15481
15482 if (m16_mis || micro_mis)
15483 {
15484 _bfd_error_handler
15485 /* xgettext:c-format */
15486 (_("%pB: ASE mismatch: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15487 ibfd,
15488 m16_mis ? "MIPS16" : "microMIPS",
15489 m16_mis ? "microMIPS" : "MIPS16");
15490 ok = FALSE;
15491 }
15492
15493 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= new_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
15494
15495 new_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
15496 old_flags &= ~ EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE;
15497 }
15498
15499 /* Compare NaN encodings. */
15500 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008))
15501 {
15502 /* xgettext:c-format */
15503 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15504 ibfd,
15505 (new_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008
15506 ? "-mnan=2008" : "-mnan=legacy"),
15507 (old_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008
15508 ? "-mnan=2008" : "-mnan=legacy"));
15509 ok = FALSE;
15510 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NAN2008;
15511 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_NAN2008;
15512 }
15513
15514 /* Compare FP64 state. */
15515 if ((new_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64) != (old_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64))
15516 {
15517 /* xgettext:c-format */
15518 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: linking %s module with previous %s modules"),
15519 ibfd,
15520 (new_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64
15521 ? "-mfp64" : "-mfp32"),
15522 (old_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64
15523 ? "-mfp64" : "-mfp32"));
15524 ok = FALSE;
15525 new_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_FP64;
15526 old_flags &= ~EF_MIPS_FP64;
15527 }
15528
15529 /* Warn about any other mismatches */
15530 if (new_flags != old_flags)
15531 {
15532 /* xgettext:c-format */
15533 _bfd_error_handler
15534 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields than previous modules "
15535 "(%#x)"),
15536 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
15537 ok = FALSE;
15538 }
15539
15540 return ok;
15541 }
15542
15543 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
15544 there are conflicting attributes. */
15545 static bfd_boolean
15546 mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
15547 {
15548 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
15549 obj_attribute *in_attr;
15550 obj_attribute *out_attr;
15551 bfd *abi_fp_bfd;
15552 bfd *abi_msa_bfd;
15553
15554 abi_fp_bfd = mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd;
15555 in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15556 if (!abi_fp_bfd && in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15557 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
15558
15559 abi_msa_bfd = mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_msa_bfd;
15560 if (!abi_msa_bfd
15561 && in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_ANY)
15562 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_msa_bfd = ibfd;
15563
15564 if (!elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i)
15565 {
15566 /* This is the first object. Copy the attributes. */
15567 _bfd_elf_copy_obj_attributes (ibfd, obfd);
15568
15569 /* Use the Tag_null value to indicate the attributes have been
15570 initialized. */
15571 elf_known_obj_attributes_proc (obfd)[0].i = 1;
15572
15573 return TRUE;
15574 }
15575
15576 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP attributes and merge
15577 non-conflicting ones. */
15578 out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15579 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i)
15580 {
15581 int out_fp, in_fp;
15582
15583 out_fp = out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15584 in_fp = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15585 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].type = 1;
15586 if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15587 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_fp;
15588 else if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX
15589 && (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
15590 || in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
15591 || in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A))
15592 {
15593 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
15594 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15595 }
15596 else if (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX
15597 && (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE
15598 || out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
15599 || out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A))
15600 /* Keep the current setting. */;
15601 else if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A
15602 && in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64)
15603 {
15604 mips_elf_tdata (obfd)->abi_fp_bfd = ibfd;
15605 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15606 }
15607 else if (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A
15608 && out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64)
15609 /* Keep the current setting. */;
15610 else if (in_fp != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15611 {
15612 const char *out_string, *in_string;
15613
15614 out_string = _bfd_mips_fp_abi_string (out_fp);
15615 in_string = _bfd_mips_fp_abi_string (in_fp);
15616 /* First warn about cases involving unrecognised ABIs. */
15617 if (!out_string && !in_string)
15618 /* xgettext:c-format */
15619 _bfd_error_handler
15620 (_("warning: %pB uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
15621 "(set by %pB), %pB uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
15622 obfd, out_fp, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, in_fp);
15623 else if (!out_string)
15624 _bfd_error_handler
15625 /* xgettext:c-format */
15626 (_("warning: %pB uses unknown floating point ABI %d "
15627 "(set by %pB), %pB uses %s"),
15628 obfd, out_fp, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, in_string);
15629 else if (!in_string)
15630 _bfd_error_handler
15631 /* xgettext:c-format */
15632 (_("warning: %pB uses %s (set by %pB), "
15633 "%pB uses unknown floating point ABI %d"),
15634 obfd, out_string, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, in_fp);
15635 else
15636 {
15637 /* If one of the bfds is soft-float, the other must be
15638 hard-float. The exact choice of hard-float ABI isn't
15639 really relevant to the error message. */
15640 if (in_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT)
15641 out_string = "-mhard-float";
15642 else if (out_fp == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT)
15643 in_string = "-mhard-float";
15644 _bfd_error_handler
15645 /* xgettext:c-format */
15646 (_("warning: %pB uses %s (set by %pB), %pB uses %s"),
15647 obfd, out_string, abi_fp_bfd, ibfd, in_string);
15648 }
15649 }
15650 }
15651
15652 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA attributes and merge
15653 non-conflicting ones. */
15654 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i != out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i)
15655 {
15656 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].type = 1;
15657 if (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_ANY)
15658 out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i = in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i;
15659 else if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_ANY)
15660 switch (out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i)
15661 {
15662 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_128:
15663 _bfd_error_handler
15664 /* xgettext:c-format */
15665 (_("warning: %pB uses %s (set by %pB), "
15666 "%pB uses unknown MSA ABI %d"),
15667 obfd, "-mmsa", abi_msa_bfd,
15668 ibfd, in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i);
15669 break;
15670
15671 default:
15672 switch (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i)
15673 {
15674 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA_128:
15675 _bfd_error_handler
15676 /* xgettext:c-format */
15677 (_("warning: %pB uses unknown MSA ABI %d "
15678 "(set by %pB), %pB uses %s"),
15679 obfd, out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i,
15680 abi_msa_bfd, ibfd, "-mmsa");
15681 break;
15682
15683 default:
15684 _bfd_error_handler
15685 /* xgettext:c-format */
15686 (_("warning: %pB uses unknown MSA ABI %d "
15687 "(set by %pB), %pB uses unknown MSA ABI %d"),
15688 obfd, out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i,
15689 abi_msa_bfd, ibfd, in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_MSA].i);
15690 break;
15691 }
15692 }
15693 }
15694
15695 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
15696 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
15697 }
15698
15699 /* Merge object ABI flags from IBFD into OBFD. Raise an error if
15700 there are conflicting settings. */
15701
15702 static bfd_boolean
15703 mips_elf_merge_obj_abiflags (bfd *ibfd, bfd *obfd)
15704 {
15705 obj_attribute *out_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15706 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *out_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (obfd);
15707 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *in_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (ibfd);
15708
15709 /* Update the output abiflags fp_abi using the computed fp_abi. */
15710 out_tdata->abiflags.fp_abi = out_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i;
15711
15712 #define max(a, b) ((a) > (b) ? (a) : (b))
15713 /* Merge abiflags. */
15714 out_tdata->abiflags.isa_level = max (out_tdata->abiflags.isa_level,
15715 in_tdata->abiflags.isa_level);
15716 out_tdata->abiflags.isa_rev = max (out_tdata->abiflags.isa_rev,
15717 in_tdata->abiflags.isa_rev);
15718 out_tdata->abiflags.gpr_size = max (out_tdata->abiflags.gpr_size,
15719 in_tdata->abiflags.gpr_size);
15720 out_tdata->abiflags.cpr1_size = max (out_tdata->abiflags.cpr1_size,
15721 in_tdata->abiflags.cpr1_size);
15722 out_tdata->abiflags.cpr2_size = max (out_tdata->abiflags.cpr2_size,
15723 in_tdata->abiflags.cpr2_size);
15724 #undef max
15725 out_tdata->abiflags.ases |= in_tdata->abiflags.ases;
15726 out_tdata->abiflags.flags1 |= in_tdata->abiflags.flags1;
15727
15728 return TRUE;
15729 }
15730
15731 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
15732 object file when linking. */
15733
15734 bfd_boolean
15735 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
15736 {
15737 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
15738 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *out_tdata;
15739 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *in_tdata;
15740 bfd_boolean null_input_bfd = TRUE;
15741 asection *sec;
15742 bfd_boolean ok;
15743
15744 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
15745 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
15746 {
15747 _bfd_error_handler
15748 (_("%pB: endianness incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
15749 ibfd);
15750 return FALSE;
15751 }
15752
15753 if (!is_mips_elf (ibfd) || !is_mips_elf (obfd))
15754 return TRUE;
15755
15756 in_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (ibfd);
15757 out_tdata = mips_elf_tdata (obfd);
15758
15759 if (strcmp (bfd_get_target (ibfd), bfd_get_target (obfd)) != 0)
15760 {
15761 _bfd_error_handler
15762 (_("%pB: ABI is incompatible with that of the selected emulation"),
15763 ibfd);
15764 return FALSE;
15765 }
15766
15767 /* Check to see if the input BFD actually contains any sections. If not,
15768 then it has no attributes, and its flags may not have been initialized
15769 either, but it cannot actually cause any incompatibility. */
15770 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
15771 {
15772 /* Ignore synthetic sections and empty .text, .data and .bss sections
15773 which are automatically generated by gas. Also ignore fake
15774 (s)common sections, since merely defining a common symbol does
15775 not affect compatibility. */
15776 if ((sec->flags & SEC_IS_COMMON) == 0
15777 && strcmp (sec->name, ".reginfo")
15778 && strcmp (sec->name, ".mdebug")
15779 && (sec->size != 0
15780 || (strcmp (sec->name, ".text")
15781 && strcmp (sec->name, ".data")
15782 && strcmp (sec->name, ".bss"))))
15783 {
15784 null_input_bfd = FALSE;
15785 break;
15786 }
15787 }
15788 if (null_input_bfd)
15789 return TRUE;
15790
15791 /* Populate abiflags using existing information. */
15792 if (in_tdata->abiflags_valid)
15793 {
15794 obj_attribute *in_attr = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
15795 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 in_abiflags;
15796 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 abiflags;
15797
15798 /* Set up the FP ABI attribute from the abiflags if it is not already
15799 set. */
15800 if (in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY)
15801 in_attr[Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP].i = in_tdata->abiflags.fp_abi;
15802
15803 infer_mips_abiflags (ibfd, &abiflags);
15804 in_abiflags = in_tdata->abiflags;
15805
15806 /* It is not possible to infer the correct ISA revision
15807 for R3 or R5 so drop down to R2 for the checks. */
15808 if (in_abiflags.isa_rev == 3 || in_abiflags.isa_rev == 5)
15809 in_abiflags.isa_rev = 2;
15810
15811 if (LEVEL_REV (in_abiflags.isa_level, in_abiflags.isa_rev)
15812 < LEVEL_REV (abiflags.isa_level, abiflags.isa_rev))
15813 _bfd_error_handler
15814 (_("%pB: warning: inconsistent ISA between e_flags and "
15815 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15816 if (abiflags.fp_abi != Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY
15817 && in_abiflags.fp_abi != abiflags.fp_abi)
15818 _bfd_error_handler
15819 (_("%pB: warning: inconsistent FP ABI between .gnu.attributes and "
15820 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15821 if ((in_abiflags.ases & abiflags.ases) != abiflags.ases)
15822 _bfd_error_handler
15823 (_("%pB: warning: inconsistent ASEs between e_flags and "
15824 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15825 /* The isa_ext is allowed to be an extension of what can be inferred
15826 from e_flags. */
15827 if (!mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (abiflags.isa_ext),
15828 bfd_mips_isa_ext_mach (in_abiflags.isa_ext)))
15829 _bfd_error_handler
15830 (_("%pB: warning: inconsistent ISA extensions between e_flags and "
15831 ".MIPS.abiflags"), ibfd);
15832 if (in_abiflags.flags2 != 0)
15833 _bfd_error_handler
15834 (_("%pB: warning: unexpected flag in the flags2 field of "
15835 ".MIPS.abiflags (0x%lx)"), ibfd,
15836 in_abiflags.flags2);
15837 }
15838 else
15839 {
15840 infer_mips_abiflags (ibfd, &in_tdata->abiflags);
15841 in_tdata->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
15842 }
15843
15844 if (!out_tdata->abiflags_valid)
15845 {
15846 /* Copy input abiflags if output abiflags are not already valid. */
15847 out_tdata->abiflags = in_tdata->abiflags;
15848 out_tdata->abiflags_valid = TRUE;
15849 }
15850
15851 if (! elf_flags_init (obfd))
15852 {
15853 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
15854 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
15855 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS]
15856 = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_ident[EI_CLASS];
15857
15858 if (bfd_get_arch (obfd) == bfd_get_arch (ibfd)
15859 && (bfd_get_arch_info (obfd)->the_default
15860 || mips_mach_extends_p (bfd_get_mach (obfd),
15861 bfd_get_mach (ibfd))))
15862 {
15863 if (! bfd_set_arch_mach (obfd, bfd_get_arch (ibfd),
15864 bfd_get_mach (ibfd)))
15865 return FALSE;
15866
15867 /* Update the ABI flags isa_level, isa_rev and isa_ext fields. */
15868 update_mips_abiflags_isa (obfd, &out_tdata->abiflags);
15869 }
15870
15871 ok = TRUE;
15872 }
15873 else
15874 ok = mips_elf_merge_obj_e_flags (ibfd, info);
15875
15876 ok = mips_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info) && ok;
15877
15878 ok = mips_elf_merge_obj_abiflags (ibfd, obfd) && ok;
15879
15880 if (!ok)
15881 {
15882 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
15883 return FALSE;
15884 }
15885
15886 return TRUE;
15887 }
15888
15889 /* Function to keep MIPS specific file flags like as EF_MIPS_PIC. */
15890
15891 bfd_boolean
15892 _bfd_mips_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
15893 {
15894 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
15895 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
15896
15897 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
15898 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
15899 return TRUE;
15900 }
15901
15902 char *
15903 _bfd_mips_elf_get_target_dtag (bfd_vma dtag)
15904 {
15905 switch (dtag)
15906 {
15907 default: return "";
15908 case DT_MIPS_RLD_VERSION:
15909 return "MIPS_RLD_VERSION";
15910 case DT_MIPS_TIME_STAMP:
15911 return "MIPS_TIME_STAMP";
15912 case DT_MIPS_ICHECKSUM:
15913 return "MIPS_ICHECKSUM";
15914 case DT_MIPS_IVERSION:
15915 return "MIPS_IVERSION";
15916 case DT_MIPS_FLAGS:
15917 return "MIPS_FLAGS";
15918 case DT_MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS:
15919 return "MIPS_BASE_ADDRESS";
15920 case DT_MIPS_MSYM:
15921 return "MIPS_MSYM";
15922 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICT:
15923 return "MIPS_CONFLICT";
15924 case DT_MIPS_LIBLIST:
15925 return "MIPS_LIBLIST";
15926 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO:
15927 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTNO";
15928 case DT_MIPS_CONFLICTNO:
15929 return "MIPS_CONFLICTNO";
15930 case DT_MIPS_LIBLISTNO:
15931 return "MIPS_LIBLISTNO";
15932 case DT_MIPS_SYMTABNO:
15933 return "MIPS_SYMTABNO";
15934 case DT_MIPS_UNREFEXTNO:
15935 return "MIPS_UNREFEXTNO";
15936 case DT_MIPS_GOTSYM:
15937 return "MIPS_GOTSYM";
15938 case DT_MIPS_HIPAGENO:
15939 return "MIPS_HIPAGENO";
15940 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP:
15941 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP";
15942 case DT_MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL:
15943 return "MIPS_RLD_MAP_REL";
15944 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS:
15945 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS";
15946 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO:
15947 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASS_NO";
15948 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE:
15949 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE";
15950 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO:
15951 return "MIPS_DELTA_INSTANCE_NO";
15952 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC:
15953 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC";
15954 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO:
15955 return "MIPS_DELTA_RELOC_NO";
15956 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM:
15957 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM";
15958 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO:
15959 return "MIPS_DELTA_SYM_NO";
15960 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM:
15961 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM";
15962 case DT_MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO:
15963 return "MIPS_DELTA_CLASSSYM_NO";
15964 case DT_MIPS_CXX_FLAGS:
15965 return "MIPS_CXX_FLAGS";
15966 case DT_MIPS_PIXIE_INIT:
15967 return "MIPS_PIXIE_INIT";
15968 case DT_MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB:
15969 return "MIPS_SYMBOL_LIB";
15970 case DT_MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX:
15971 return "MIPS_LOCALPAGE_GOTIDX";
15972 case DT_MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX:
15973 return "MIPS_LOCAL_GOTIDX";
15974 case DT_MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX:
15975 return "MIPS_HIDDEN_GOTIDX";
15976 case DT_MIPS_PROTECTED_GOTIDX:
15977 return "MIPS_PROTECTED_GOT_IDX";
15978 case DT_MIPS_OPTIONS:
15979 return "MIPS_OPTIONS";
15980 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE:
15981 return "MIPS_INTERFACE";
15982 case DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN:
15983 return "DT_MIPS_DYNSTR_ALIGN";
15984 case DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE:
15985 return "DT_MIPS_INTERFACE_SIZE";
15986 case DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR:
15987 return "DT_MIPS_RLD_TEXT_RESOLVE_ADDR";
15988 case DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX:
15989 return "DT_MIPS_PERF_SUFFIX";
15990 case DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE:
15991 return "DT_MIPS_COMPACT_SIZE";
15992 case DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE:
15993 return "DT_MIPS_GP_VALUE";
15994 case DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC:
15995 return "DT_MIPS_AUX_DYNAMIC";
15996 case DT_MIPS_PLTGOT:
15997 return "DT_MIPS_PLTGOT";
15998 case DT_MIPS_RWPLT:
15999 return "DT_MIPS_RWPLT";
16000 case DT_MIPS_XHASH:
16001 return "DT_MIPS_XHASH";
16002 }
16003 }
16004
16005 /* Return the meaning of Tag_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP value FP, or null if
16006 not known. */
16007
16008 const char *
16009 _bfd_mips_fp_abi_string (int fp)
16010 {
16011 switch (fp)
16012 {
16013 /* These strings aren't translated because they're simply
16014 option lists. */
16015 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE:
16016 return "-mdouble-float";
16017
16018 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SINGLE:
16019 return "-msingle-float";
16020
16021 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT:
16022 return "-msoft-float";
16023
16024 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_OLD_64:
16025 return _("-mips32r2 -mfp64 (12 callee-saved)");
16026
16027 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX:
16028 return "-mfpxx";
16029
16030 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64:
16031 return "-mgp32 -mfp64";
16032
16033 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A:
16034 return "-mgp32 -mfp64 -mno-odd-spreg";
16035
16036 default:
16037 return 0;
16038 }
16039 }
16040
16041 static void
16042 print_mips_ases (FILE *file, unsigned int mask)
16043 {
16044 if (mask & AFL_ASE_DSP)
16045 fputs ("\n\tDSP ASE", file);
16046 if (mask & AFL_ASE_DSPR2)
16047 fputs ("\n\tDSP R2 ASE", file);
16048 if (mask & AFL_ASE_DSPR3)
16049 fputs ("\n\tDSP R3 ASE", file);
16050 if (mask & AFL_ASE_EVA)
16051 fputs ("\n\tEnhanced VA Scheme", file);
16052 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MCU)
16053 fputs ("\n\tMCU (MicroController) ASE", file);
16054 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MDMX)
16055 fputs ("\n\tMDMX ASE", file);
16056 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MIPS3D)
16057 fputs ("\n\tMIPS-3D ASE", file);
16058 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MT)
16059 fputs ("\n\tMT ASE", file);
16060 if (mask & AFL_ASE_SMARTMIPS)
16061 fputs ("\n\tSmartMIPS ASE", file);
16062 if (mask & AFL_ASE_VIRT)
16063 fputs ("\n\tVZ ASE", file);
16064 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MSA)
16065 fputs ("\n\tMSA ASE", file);
16066 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MIPS16)
16067 fputs ("\n\tMIPS16 ASE", file);
16068 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MICROMIPS)
16069 fputs ("\n\tMICROMIPS ASE", file);
16070 if (mask & AFL_ASE_XPA)
16071 fputs ("\n\tXPA ASE", file);
16072 if (mask & AFL_ASE_MIPS16E2)
16073 fputs ("\n\tMIPS16e2 ASE", file);
16074 if (mask & AFL_ASE_CRC)
16075 fputs ("\n\tCRC ASE", file);
16076 if (mask & AFL_ASE_GINV)
16077 fputs ("\n\tGINV ASE", file);
16078 if (mask & AFL_ASE_LOONGSON_MMI)
16079 fputs ("\n\tLoongson MMI ASE", file);
16080 if (mask & AFL_ASE_LOONGSON_CAM)
16081 fputs ("\n\tLoongson CAM ASE", file);
16082 if (mask & AFL_ASE_LOONGSON_EXT)
16083 fputs ("\n\tLoongson EXT ASE", file);
16084 if (mask & AFL_ASE_LOONGSON_EXT2)
16085 fputs ("\n\tLoongson EXT2 ASE", file);
16086 if (mask == 0)
16087 fprintf (file, "\n\t%s", _("None"));
16088 else if ((mask & ~AFL_ASE_MASK) != 0)
16089 fprintf (stdout, "\n\t%s (%x)", _("Unknown"), mask & ~AFL_ASE_MASK);
16090 }
16091
16092 static void
16093 print_mips_isa_ext (FILE *file, unsigned int isa_ext)
16094 {
16095 switch (isa_ext)
16096 {
16097 case 0:
16098 fputs (_("None"), file);
16099 break;
16100 case AFL_EXT_XLR:
16101 fputs ("RMI XLR", file);
16102 break;
16103 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON3:
16104 fputs ("Cavium Networks Octeon3", file);
16105 break;
16106 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON2:
16107 fputs ("Cavium Networks Octeon2", file);
16108 break;
16109 case AFL_EXT_OCTEONP:
16110 fputs ("Cavium Networks OcteonP", file);
16111 break;
16112 case AFL_EXT_OCTEON:
16113 fputs ("Cavium Networks Octeon", file);
16114 break;
16115 case AFL_EXT_5900:
16116 fputs ("Toshiba R5900", file);
16117 break;
16118 case AFL_EXT_4650:
16119 fputs ("MIPS R4650", file);
16120 break;
16121 case AFL_EXT_4010:
16122 fputs ("LSI R4010", file);
16123 break;
16124 case AFL_EXT_4100:
16125 fputs ("NEC VR4100", file);
16126 break;
16127 case AFL_EXT_3900:
16128 fputs ("Toshiba R3900", file);
16129 break;
16130 case AFL_EXT_10000:
16131 fputs ("MIPS R10000", file);
16132 break;
16133 case AFL_EXT_SB1:
16134 fputs ("Broadcom SB-1", file);
16135 break;
16136 case AFL_EXT_4111:
16137 fputs ("NEC VR4111/VR4181", file);
16138 break;
16139 case AFL_EXT_4120:
16140 fputs ("NEC VR4120", file);
16141 break;
16142 case AFL_EXT_5400:
16143 fputs ("NEC VR5400", file);
16144 break;
16145 case AFL_EXT_5500:
16146 fputs ("NEC VR5500", file);
16147 break;
16148 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2E:
16149 fputs ("ST Microelectronics Loongson 2E", file);
16150 break;
16151 case AFL_EXT_LOONGSON_2F:
16152 fputs ("ST Microelectronics Loongson 2F", file);
16153 break;
16154 case AFL_EXT_INTERAPTIV_MR2:
16155 fputs ("Imagination interAptiv MR2", file);
16156 break;
16157 default:
16158 fprintf (file, "%s (%d)", _("Unknown"), isa_ext);
16159 break;
16160 }
16161 }
16162
16163 static void
16164 print_mips_fp_abi_value (FILE *file, int val)
16165 {
16166 switch (val)
16167 {
16168 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_ANY:
16169 fprintf (file, _("Hard or soft float\n"));
16170 break;
16171 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_DOUBLE:
16172 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (double precision)\n"));
16173 break;
16174 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SINGLE:
16175 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (single precision)\n"));
16176 break;
16177 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_SOFT:
16178 fprintf (file, _("Soft float\n"));
16179 break;
16180 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_OLD_64:
16181 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (MIPS32r2 64-bit FPU 12 callee-saved)\n"));
16182 break;
16183 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_XX:
16184 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (32-bit CPU, Any FPU)\n"));
16185 break;
16186 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64:
16187 fprintf (file, _("Hard float (32-bit CPU, 64-bit FPU)\n"));
16188 break;
16189 case Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A:
16190 fprintf (file, _("Hard float compat (32-bit CPU, 64-bit FPU)\n"));
16191 break;
16192 default:
16193 fprintf (file, "??? (%d)\n", val);
16194 break;
16195 }
16196 }
16197
16198 static int
16199 get_mips_reg_size (int reg_size)
16200 {
16201 return (reg_size == AFL_REG_NONE) ? 0
16202 : (reg_size == AFL_REG_32) ? 32
16203 : (reg_size == AFL_REG_64) ? 64
16204 : (reg_size == AFL_REG_128) ? 128
16205 : -1;
16206 }
16207
16208 bfd_boolean
16209 _bfd_mips_elf_print_private_bfd_data (bfd *abfd, void *ptr)
16210 {
16211 FILE *file = ptr;
16212
16213 BFD_ASSERT (abfd != NULL && ptr != NULL);
16214
16215 /* Print normal ELF private data. */
16216 _bfd_elf_print_private_bfd_data (abfd, ptr);
16217
16218 /* xgettext:c-format */
16219 fprintf (file, _("private flags = %lx:"), elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags);
16220
16221 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O32)
16222 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O32]"));
16223 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_O64)
16224 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=O64]"));
16225 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI32)
16226 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI32]"));
16227 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI) == E_MIPS_ABI_EABI64)
16228 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=EABI64]"));
16229 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ABI))
16230 fprintf (file, _(" [abi unknown]"));
16231 else if (ABI_N32_P (abfd))
16232 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=N32]"));
16233 else if (ABI_64_P (abfd))
16234 fprintf (file, _(" [abi=64]"));
16235 else
16236 fprintf (file, _(" [no abi set]"));
16237
16238 if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_1)
16239 fprintf (file, " [mips1]");
16240 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_2)
16241 fprintf (file, " [mips2]");
16242 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_3)
16243 fprintf (file, " [mips3]");
16244 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_4)
16245 fprintf (file, " [mips4]");
16246 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_5)
16247 fprintf (file, " [mips5]");
16248 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32)
16249 fprintf (file, " [mips32]");
16250 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64)
16251 fprintf (file, " [mips64]");
16252 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R2)
16253 fprintf (file, " [mips32r2]");
16254 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R2)
16255 fprintf (file, " [mips64r2]");
16256 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_32R6)
16257 fprintf (file, " [mips32r6]");
16258 else if ((elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH) == E_MIPS_ARCH_64R6)
16259 fprintf (file, " [mips64r6]");
16260 else
16261 fprintf (file, _(" [unknown ISA]"));
16262
16263 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MDMX)
16264 fprintf (file, " [mdmx]");
16265
16266 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_M16)
16267 fprintf (file, " [mips16]");
16268
16269 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_ARCH_ASE_MICROMIPS)
16270 fprintf (file, " [micromips]");
16271
16272 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NAN2008)
16273 fprintf (file, " [nan2008]");
16274
16275 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_FP64)
16276 fprintf (file, " [old fp64]");
16277
16278 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_32BITMODE)
16279 fprintf (file, " [32bitmode]");
16280 else
16281 fprintf (file, _(" [not 32bitmode]"));
16282
16283 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_NOREORDER)
16284 fprintf (file, " [noreorder]");
16285
16286 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_PIC)
16287 fprintf (file, " [PIC]");
16288
16289 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_CPIC)
16290 fprintf (file, " [CPIC]");
16291
16292 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_XGOT)
16293 fprintf (file, " [XGOT]");
16294
16295 if (elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags & EF_MIPS_UCODE)
16296 fprintf (file, " [UCODE]");
16297
16298 fputc ('\n', file);
16299
16300 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags_valid)
16301 {
16302 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *abiflags = &mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags;
16303 fprintf (file, "\nMIPS ABI Flags Version: %d\n", abiflags->version);
16304 fprintf (file, "\nISA: MIPS%d", abiflags->isa_level);
16305 if (abiflags->isa_rev > 1)
16306 fprintf (file, "r%d", abiflags->isa_rev);
16307 fprintf (file, "\nGPR size: %d",
16308 get_mips_reg_size (abiflags->gpr_size));
16309 fprintf (file, "\nCPR1 size: %d",
16310 get_mips_reg_size (abiflags->cpr1_size));
16311 fprintf (file, "\nCPR2 size: %d",
16312 get_mips_reg_size (abiflags->cpr2_size));
16313 fputs ("\nFP ABI: ", file);
16314 print_mips_fp_abi_value (file, abiflags->fp_abi);
16315 fputs ("ISA Extension: ", file);
16316 print_mips_isa_ext (file, abiflags->isa_ext);
16317 fputs ("\nASEs:", file);
16318 print_mips_ases (file, abiflags->ases);
16319 fprintf (file, "\nFLAGS 1: %8.8lx", abiflags->flags1);
16320 fprintf (file, "\nFLAGS 2: %8.8lx", abiflags->flags2);
16321 fputc ('\n', file);
16322 }
16323
16324 return TRUE;
16325 }
16326
16327 const struct bfd_elf_special_section _bfd_mips_elf_special_sections[] =
16328 {
16329 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit4"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
16330 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".lit8"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
16331 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".mdebug"), 0, SHT_MIPS_DEBUG, 0 },
16332 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
16333 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE + SHF_MIPS_GPREL },
16334 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".ucode"), 0, SHT_MIPS_UCODE, 0 },
16335 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".MIPS.xhash"), 0, SHT_MIPS_XHASH, SHF_ALLOC },
16336 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
16337 };
16338
16339 /* Merge non visibility st_other attributes. Ensure that the
16340 STO_OPTIONAL flag is copied into h->other, even if this is not a
16341 definiton of the symbol. */
16342 void
16343 _bfd_mips_elf_merge_symbol_attribute (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
16344 const Elf_Internal_Sym *isym,
16345 bfd_boolean definition,
16346 bfd_boolean dynamic ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16347 {
16348 if ((isym->st_other & ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1)) != 0)
16349 {
16350 unsigned char other;
16351
16352 other = (definition ? isym->st_other : h->other);
16353 other &= ~ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (-1);
16354 h->other = other | ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other);
16355 }
16356
16357 if (!definition
16358 && ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (isym->st_other))
16359 h->other |= STO_OPTIONAL;
16360 }
16361
16362 /* Decide whether an undefined symbol is special and can be ignored.
16363 This is the case for OPTIONAL symbols on IRIX. */
16364 bfd_boolean
16365 _bfd_mips_elf_ignore_undef_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
16366 {
16367 return ELF_MIPS_IS_OPTIONAL (h->other) ? TRUE : FALSE;
16368 }
16369
16370 bfd_boolean
16371 _bfd_mips_elf_common_definition (Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
16372 {
16373 return (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
16374 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_ACOMMON
16375 || sym->st_shndx == SHN_MIPS_SCOMMON);
16376 }
16377
16378 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
16379 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
16380
16381 bfd_vma
16382 _bfd_mips_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i, const asection *plt,
16383 const arelent *rel ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16384 {
16385 return (plt->vma
16386 + 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry)
16387 + i * 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry));
16388 }
16389
16390 /* Build a table of synthetic symbols to represent the PLT. As with MIPS16
16391 and microMIPS PLT slots we may have a many-to-one mapping between .plt
16392 and .got.plt and also the slots may be of a different size each we walk
16393 the PLT manually fetching instructions and matching them against known
16394 patterns. To make things easier standard MIPS slots, if any, always come
16395 first. As we don't create proper ELF symbols we use the UDATA.I member
16396 of ASYMBOL to carry ISA annotation. The encoding used is the same as
16397 with the ST_OTHER member of the ELF symbol. */
16398
16399 long
16400 _bfd_mips_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd,
16401 long symcount ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
16402 asymbol **syms ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
16403 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
16404 asymbol **ret)
16405 {
16406 static const char pltname[] = "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_";
16407 static const char microsuffix[] = "@micromipsplt";
16408 static const char m16suffix[] = "@mips16plt";
16409 static const char mipssuffix[] = "@plt";
16410
16411 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
16412 const struct elf_backend_data *bed = get_elf_backend_data (abfd);
16413 bfd_boolean micromips_p = MICROMIPS_P (abfd);
16414 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr;
16415 bfd_byte *plt_data;
16416 bfd_vma plt_offset;
16417 unsigned int other;
16418 bfd_vma entry_size;
16419 bfd_vma plt0_size;
16420 asection *relplt;
16421 bfd_vma opcode;
16422 asection *plt;
16423 asymbol *send;
16424 size_t size;
16425 char *names;
16426 long counti;
16427 arelent *p;
16428 asymbol *s;
16429 char *nend;
16430 long count;
16431 long pi;
16432 long i;
16433 long n;
16434
16435 *ret = NULL;
16436
16437 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0 || dynsymcount <= 0)
16438 return 0;
16439
16440 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rel.plt");
16441 if (relplt == NULL)
16442 return 0;
16443
16444 hdr = &elf_section_data (relplt)->this_hdr;
16445 if (hdr->sh_link != elf_dynsymtab (abfd) || hdr->sh_type != SHT_REL)
16446 return 0;
16447
16448 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
16449 if (plt == NULL)
16450 return 0;
16451
16452 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
16453 if (!(*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
16454 return -1;
16455 p = relplt->relocation;
16456
16457 /* Calculating the exact amount of space required for symbols would
16458 require two passes over the PLT, so just pessimise assuming two
16459 PLT slots per relocation. */
16460 count = relplt->size / hdr->sh_entsize;
16461 counti = count * bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel;
16462 size = 2 * count * sizeof (asymbol);
16463 size += count * (sizeof (mipssuffix) +
16464 (micromips_p ? sizeof (microsuffix) : sizeof (m16suffix)));
16465 for (pi = 0; pi < counti; pi += bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel)
16466 size += 2 * strlen ((*p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
16467
16468 /* Add the size of "_PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_" too. */
16469 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof (pltname);
16470
16471 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, plt, &plt_data))
16472 return -1;
16473
16474 if (plt->size < 16)
16475 return -1;
16476
16477 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
16478 if (s == NULL)
16479 return -1;
16480 send = s + 2 * count + 1;
16481
16482 names = (char *) send;
16483 nend = (char *) s + size;
16484 n = 0;
16485
16486 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, plt_data + 12);
16487 if (opcode == 0x3302fffe)
16488 {
16489 if (!micromips_p)
16490 return -1;
16491 plt0_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
16492 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16493 }
16494 else if (opcode == 0x0398c1d0)
16495 {
16496 if (!micromips_p)
16497 return -1;
16498 plt0_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
16499 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16500 }
16501 else
16502 {
16503 plt0_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_o32_exec_plt0_entry);
16504 other = 0;
16505 }
16506
16507 s->the_bfd = abfd;
16508 s->flags = BSF_SYNTHETIC | BSF_FUNCTION | BSF_LOCAL;
16509 s->section = plt;
16510 s->value = 0;
16511 s->name = names;
16512 s->udata.i = other;
16513 memcpy (names, pltname, sizeof (pltname));
16514 names += sizeof (pltname);
16515 ++s, ++n;
16516
16517 pi = 0;
16518 for (plt_offset = plt0_size;
16519 plt_offset + 8 <= plt->size && s < send;
16520 plt_offset += entry_size)
16521 {
16522 bfd_vma gotplt_addr;
16523 const char *suffix;
16524 bfd_vma gotplt_hi;
16525 bfd_vma gotplt_lo;
16526 size_t suffixlen;
16527
16528 opcode = bfd_get_micromips_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 4);
16529
16530 /* Check if the second word matches the expected MIPS16 instruction. */
16531 if (opcode == 0x651aeb00)
16532 {
16533 if (micromips_p)
16534 return -1;
16535 /* Truncated table??? */
16536 if (plt_offset + 16 > plt->size)
16537 break;
16538 gotplt_addr = bfd_get_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 12);
16539 entry_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips16_o32_exec_plt_entry);
16540 suffixlen = sizeof (m16suffix);
16541 suffix = m16suffix;
16542 other = STO_MIPS16;
16543 }
16544 /* Likewise the expected microMIPS instruction (no insn32 mode). */
16545 else if (opcode == 0xff220000)
16546 {
16547 if (!micromips_p)
16548 return -1;
16549 gotplt_hi = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset) & 0x7f;
16550 gotplt_lo = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 2) & 0xffff;
16551 gotplt_hi = ((gotplt_hi ^ 0x40) - 0x40) << 18;
16552 gotplt_lo <<= 2;
16553 gotplt_addr = gotplt_hi + gotplt_lo;
16554 gotplt_addr += ((plt->vma + plt_offset) | 3) ^ 3;
16555 entry_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_o32_exec_plt_entry);
16556 suffixlen = sizeof (microsuffix);
16557 suffix = microsuffix;
16558 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16559 }
16560 /* Likewise the expected microMIPS instruction (insn32 mode). */
16561 else if ((opcode & 0xffff0000) == 0xff2f0000)
16562 {
16563 gotplt_hi = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 2) & 0xffff;
16564 gotplt_lo = bfd_get_16 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 6) & 0xffff;
16565 gotplt_hi = ((gotplt_hi ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000) << 16;
16566 gotplt_lo = (gotplt_lo ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
16567 gotplt_addr = gotplt_hi + gotplt_lo;
16568 entry_size = 2 * ARRAY_SIZE (micromips_insn32_o32_exec_plt_entry);
16569 suffixlen = sizeof (microsuffix);
16570 suffix = microsuffix;
16571 other = STO_MICROMIPS;
16572 }
16573 /* Otherwise assume standard MIPS code. */
16574 else
16575 {
16576 gotplt_hi = bfd_get_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset) & 0xffff;
16577 gotplt_lo = bfd_get_32 (abfd, plt_data + plt_offset + 4) & 0xffff;
16578 gotplt_hi = ((gotplt_hi ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000) << 16;
16579 gotplt_lo = (gotplt_lo ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
16580 gotplt_addr = gotplt_hi + gotplt_lo;
16581 entry_size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (mips_exec_plt_entry);
16582 suffixlen = sizeof (mipssuffix);
16583 suffix = mipssuffix;
16584 other = 0;
16585 }
16586 /* Truncated table??? */
16587 if (plt_offset + entry_size > plt->size)
16588 break;
16589
16590 for (i = 0;
16591 i < count && p[pi].address != gotplt_addr;
16592 i++, pi = (pi + bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel) % counti);
16593
16594 if (i < count)
16595 {
16596 size_t namelen;
16597 size_t len;
16598
16599 *s = **p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr;
16600 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
16601 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
16602 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
16603 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
16604 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
16605 s->section = plt;
16606 s->value = plt_offset;
16607 s->name = names;
16608 s->udata.i = other;
16609
16610 len = strlen ((*p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
16611 namelen = len + suffixlen;
16612 if (names + namelen > nend)
16613 break;
16614
16615 memcpy (names, (*p[pi].sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
16616 names += len;
16617 memcpy (names, suffix, suffixlen);
16618 names += suffixlen;
16619
16620 ++s, ++n;
16621 pi = (pi + bed->s->int_rels_per_ext_rel) % counti;
16622 }
16623 }
16624
16625 free (plt_data);
16626
16627 return n;
16628 }
16629
16630 /* Return the ABI flags associated with ABFD if available. */
16631
16632 Elf_Internal_ABIFlags_v0 *
16633 bfd_mips_elf_get_abiflags (bfd *abfd)
16634 {
16635 struct mips_elf_obj_tdata *tdata = mips_elf_tdata (abfd);
16636
16637 return tdata->abiflags_valid ? &tdata->abiflags : NULL;
16638 }
16639
16640 /* MIPS libc ABI versions, used with the EI_ABIVERSION ELF file header
16641 field. Taken from `libc-abis.h' generated at GNU libc build time.
16642 Using a MIPS_ prefix as other libc targets use different values. */
16643 enum
16644 {
16645 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_DEFAULT = 0,
16646 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_MIPS_PLT,
16647 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_UNIQUE,
16648 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_MIPS_O32_FP64,
16649 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_ABSOLUTE,
16650 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_XHASH,
16651 MIPS_LIBC_ABI_MAX
16652 };
16653
16654 void
16655 _bfd_mips_post_process_headers (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
16656 {
16657 struct mips_elf_link_hash_table *htab = NULL;
16658 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdrp;
16659
16660 i_ehdrp = elf_elfheader (abfd);
16661 if (link_info)
16662 {
16663 htab = mips_elf_hash_table (link_info);
16664 BFD_ASSERT (htab != NULL);
16665 }
16666
16667 if (htab != NULL && htab->use_plts_and_copy_relocs && !htab->is_vxworks)
16668 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = MIPS_LIBC_ABI_MIPS_PLT;
16669
16670 if (mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags.fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64
16671 || mips_elf_tdata (abfd)->abiflags.fp_abi == Val_GNU_MIPS_ABI_FP_64A)
16672 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = MIPS_LIBC_ABI_MIPS_O32_FP64;
16673
16674 /* Mark that we need support for absolute symbols in the dynamic loader. */
16675 if (htab != NULL && htab->use_absolute_zero && htab->gnu_target)
16676 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = MIPS_LIBC_ABI_ABSOLUTE;
16677
16678 /* Mark that we need support for .MIPS.xhash in the dynamic linker,
16679 if it is the only hash section that will be created. */
16680 if (link_info && link_info->emit_gnu_hash && !link_info->emit_hash)
16681 i_ehdrp->e_ident[EI_ABIVERSION] = MIPS_LIBC_ABI_XHASH;
16682
16683 _bfd_elf_post_process_headers (abfd, link_info);
16684 }
16685
16686 int
16687 _bfd_mips_elf_compact_eh_encoding
16688 (struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16689 {
16690 return DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4;
16691 }
16692
16693 /* Return the opcode for can't unwind. */
16694
16695 int
16696 _bfd_mips_elf_cant_unwind_opcode
16697 (struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
16698 {
16699 return COMPACT_EH_CANT_UNWIND_OPCODE;
16700 }
16701
16702 /* Record a position XLAT_LOC in the xlat translation table, associated with
16703 the hash entry H. The entry in the translation table will later be
16704 populated with the real symbol dynindx. */
16705
16706 void
16707 _bfd_mips_elf_record_xhash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
16708 bfd_vma xlat_loc)
16709 {
16710 struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *hmips;
16711
16712 hmips = (struct mips_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
16713 hmips->mipsxhash_loc = xlat_loc;
16714 }
This page took 0.552285 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.